11291 lines
500 KiB
C++
11291 lines
500 KiB
C++
// dear imgui, v1.53 WIP
|
|
// (main code and documentation)
|
|
|
|
// See ImGui::ShowTestWindow() in imgui_demo.cpp for demo code.
|
|
// Newcomers, read 'Programmer guide' below for notes on how to setup Dear ImGui in your codebase.
|
|
// Get latest version at https://github.com/ocornut/imgui
|
|
// Releases change-log at https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/releases
|
|
// Gallery (please post your screenshots/video there!): https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/issues/1269
|
|
// Developed by Omar Cornut and every direct or indirect contributors to the GitHub.
|
|
// This library is free but I need your support to sustain development and maintenance.
|
|
// If you work for a company, please consider financial support, e.g: https://www.patreon.com/imgui
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
|
|
Index
|
|
- MISSION STATEMENT
|
|
- END-USER GUIDE
|
|
- PROGRAMMER GUIDE (read me!)
|
|
- Read first
|
|
- How to update to a newer version of Dear ImGui
|
|
- Getting started with integrating Dear ImGui in your code/engine
|
|
- API BREAKING CHANGES (read me when you update!)
|
|
- ISSUES & TODO LIST
|
|
- FREQUENTLY ASKED QUESTIONS (FAQ), TIPS
|
|
- How can I help?
|
|
- What is ImTextureID and how do I display an image?
|
|
- I integrated Dear ImGui in my engine and the text or lines are blurry..
|
|
- I integrated Dear ImGui in my engine and some elements are clipping or disappearing when I move windows around..
|
|
- How can I have multiple widgets with the same label? Can I have widget without a label? (Yes). A primer on labels/IDs.
|
|
- How can I tell when Dear ImGui wants my mouse/keyboard inputs VS when I can pass them to my application?
|
|
- How can I load a different font than the default?
|
|
- How can I easily use icons in my application?
|
|
- How can I load multiple fonts?
|
|
- How can I display and input non-latin characters such as Chinese, Japanese, Korean, Cyrillic?
|
|
- How can I preserve my Dear ImGui context across reloading a DLL? (loss of the global/static variables)
|
|
- How can I use the drawing facilities without an ImGui window? (using ImDrawList API)
|
|
- ISSUES & TODO-LIST
|
|
- CODE
|
|
|
|
|
|
MISSION STATEMENT
|
|
=================
|
|
|
|
- Easy to use to create code-driven and data-driven tools
|
|
- Easy to use to create ad hoc short-lived tools and long-lived, more elaborate tools
|
|
- Easy to hack and improve
|
|
- Minimize screen real-estate usage
|
|
- Minimize setup and maintenance
|
|
- Minimize state storage on user side
|
|
- Portable, minimize dependencies, run on target (consoles, phones, etc.)
|
|
- Efficient runtime and memory consumption (NB- we do allocate when "growing" content e.g. creating a window, opening a tree node
|
|
for the first time, etc. but a typical frame won't allocate anything)
|
|
|
|
Designed for developers and content-creators, not the typical end-user! Some of the weaknesses includes:
|
|
- Doesn't look fancy, doesn't animate
|
|
- Limited layout features, intricate layouts are typically crafted in code
|
|
|
|
|
|
END-USER GUIDE
|
|
==============
|
|
|
|
- Double-click on title bar to collapse window.
|
|
- Click upper right corner to close a window, available when 'bool* p_open' is passed to ImGui::Begin().
|
|
- Click and drag on lower right corner to resize window (double-click to auto fit window to its contents).
|
|
- Click and drag on any empty space to move window.
|
|
- TAB/SHIFT+TAB to cycle through keyboard editable fields.
|
|
- CTRL+Click on a slider or drag box to input value as text.
|
|
- Use mouse wheel to scroll.
|
|
- Text editor:
|
|
- Hold SHIFT or use mouse to select text.
|
|
- CTRL+Left/Right to word jump.
|
|
- CTRL+Shift+Left/Right to select words.
|
|
- CTRL+A our Double-Click to select all.
|
|
- CTRL+X,CTRL+C,CTRL+V to use OS clipboard/
|
|
- CTRL+Z,CTRL+Y to undo/redo.
|
|
- ESCAPE to revert text to its original value.
|
|
- You can apply arithmetic operators +,*,/ on numerical values. Use +- to subtract (because - would set a negative value!)
|
|
- Controls are automatically adjusted for OSX to match standard OSX text editing operations.
|
|
|
|
|
|
PROGRAMMER GUIDE
|
|
================
|
|
|
|
READ FIRST
|
|
|
|
- Read the FAQ below this section!
|
|
- Your code creates the UI, if your code doesn't run the UI is gone! == very dynamic UI, no construction/destructions steps, less data retention
|
|
on your side, no state duplication, less sync, less bugs.
|
|
- Call and read ImGui::ShowTestWindow() for demo code demonstrating most features.
|
|
- You can learn about immediate-mode gui principles at http://www.johno.se/book/imgui.html or watch http://mollyrocket.com/861
|
|
|
|
HOW TO UPDATE TO A NEWER VERSION OF DEAR IMGUI
|
|
|
|
- Overwrite all the sources files except for imconfig.h (if you have made modification to your copy of imconfig.h)
|
|
- Read the "API BREAKING CHANGES" section (below). This is where we list occasional API breaking changes.
|
|
If a function/type has been renamed / or marked obsolete, try to fix the name in your code before it is permanently removed from the public API.
|
|
If you have a problem with a missing function/symbols, search for its name in the code, there will likely be a comment about it.
|
|
Please report any issue to the GitHub page!
|
|
- Try to keep your copy of dear imgui reasonably up to date.
|
|
|
|
GETTING STARTED WITH INTEGRATING DEAR IMGUI IN YOUR CODE/ENGINE
|
|
|
|
- Add the Dear ImGui source files to your projects, using your preferred build system.
|
|
It is recommended you build the .cpp files as part of your project and not as a library.
|
|
- You can later customize the imconfig.h file to tweak some compilation time behavior, such as integrating imgui types with your own maths types.
|
|
- See examples/ folder for standalone sample applications.
|
|
- You may be able to grab and copy a ready made imgui_impl_*** file from the examples/.
|
|
- When using Dear ImGui, your programming IDE is your friend: follow the declaration of variables, functions and types to find comments about them.
|
|
|
|
- Init: retrieve the ImGuiIO structure with ImGui::GetIO() and fill the fields marked 'Settings': at minimum you need to set io.DisplaySize
|
|
(application resolution). Later on you will fill your keyboard mapping, clipboard handlers, and other advanced features but for a basic
|
|
integration you don't need to worry about it all.
|
|
- Init: call io.Fonts->GetTexDataAsRGBA32(...), it will build the font atlas texture, then load the texture pixels into graphics memory.
|
|
- Every frame:
|
|
- In your main loop as early a possible, fill the IO fields marked 'Input' (e.g. mouse position, buttons, keyboard info, etc.)
|
|
- Call ImGui::NewFrame() to begin the frame
|
|
- You can use any ImGui function you want between NewFrame() and Render()
|
|
- Call ImGui::Render() as late as you can to end the frame and finalize render data. it will call your io.RenderDrawListFn handler.
|
|
(Even if you don't render, call Render() and ignore the callback, or call EndFrame() instead. Otherwhise some features will break)
|
|
- All rendering information are stored into command-lists until ImGui::Render() is called.
|
|
- Dear ImGui never touches or knows about your GPU state. the only function that knows about GPU is the RenderDrawListFn handler that you provide.
|
|
- Effectively it means you can create widgets at any time in your code, regardless of considerations of being in "update" vs "render" phases
|
|
of your own application.
|
|
- Refer to the examples applications in the examples/ folder for instruction on how to setup your code.
|
|
- A minimal application skeleton may be:
|
|
|
|
// Application init
|
|
ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO();
|
|
io.DisplaySize.x = 1920.0f;
|
|
io.DisplaySize.y = 1280.0f;
|
|
io.RenderDrawListsFn = MyRenderFunction; // Setup a render function, or set to NULL and call GetDrawData() after Render() to access render data.
|
|
// TODO: Fill others settings of the io structure later.
|
|
|
|
// Load texture atlas (there is a default font so you don't need to care about choosing a font yet)
|
|
unsigned char* pixels;
|
|
int width, height;
|
|
io.Fonts->GetTexDataAsRGBA32(pixels, &width, &height);
|
|
// TODO: At this points you've got the texture data and you need to upload that your your graphic system:
|
|
MyTexture* texture = MyEngine::CreateTextureFromMemoryPixels(pixels, width, height, TEXTURE_TYPE_RGBA)
|
|
// TODO: Store your texture pointer/identifier (whatever your engine uses) in 'io.Fonts->TexID'. This will be passed back to your via the renderer.
|
|
io.Fonts->TexID = (void*)texture;
|
|
|
|
// Application main loop
|
|
while (true)
|
|
{
|
|
// Setup low-level inputs (e.g. on Win32, GetKeyboardState(), or write to those fields from your Windows message loop handlers, etc.)
|
|
ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO();
|
|
io.DeltaTime = 1.0f/60.0f;
|
|
io.MousePos = mouse_pos;
|
|
io.MouseDown[0] = mouse_button_0;
|
|
io.MouseDown[1] = mouse_button_1;
|
|
|
|
// Call NewFrame(), after this point you can use ImGui::* functions anytime
|
|
ImGui::NewFrame();
|
|
|
|
// Most of your application code here
|
|
MyGameUpdate(); // may use any ImGui functions, e.g. ImGui::Begin("My window"); ImGui::Text("Hello, world!"); ImGui::End();
|
|
MyGameRender(); // may use any ImGui functions as well!
|
|
|
|
// Render & swap video buffers
|
|
ImGui::Render();
|
|
SwapBuffers();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
- A minimal render function skeleton may be:
|
|
|
|
void void MyRenderFunction(ImDrawData* draw_data)(ImDrawData* draw_data)
|
|
{
|
|
// TODO: Setup render state: alpha-blending enabled, no face culling, no depth testing, scissor enabled
|
|
// TODO: Setup viewport, orthographic projection matrix
|
|
// TODO: Setup shader: vertex { float2 pos, float2 uv, u32 color }, fragment shader sample color from 1 texture, multiply by vertex color.
|
|
for (int n = 0; n < draw_data->CmdListsCount; n++)
|
|
{
|
|
const ImDrawVert* vtx_buffer = cmd_list->VtxBuffer.Data; // vertex buffer generated by ImGui
|
|
const ImDrawIdx* idx_buffer = cmd_list->IdxBuffer.Data; // index buffer generated by ImGui
|
|
for (int cmd_i = 0; cmd_i < cmd_list->CmdBuffer.Size; cmd_i++)
|
|
{
|
|
const ImDrawCmd* pcmd = &cmd_list->CmdBuffer[cmd_i];
|
|
if (pcmd->UserCallback)
|
|
{
|
|
pcmd->UserCallback(cmd_list, pcmd);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// The texture for the draw call is specified by pcmd->TextureId.
|
|
// The vast majority of draw calls with use the imgui texture atlas, which value you have set yourself during initialization.
|
|
MyEngineBindTexture(pcmd->TextureId);
|
|
|
|
// We are using scissoring to clip some objects. All low-level graphics API supports it.
|
|
// If your engine doesn't support scissoring yet, you will get some small glitches (some elements outside their bounds) which you can fix later.
|
|
MyEngineScissor((int)pcmd->ClipRect.x, (int)pcmd->ClipRect.y, (int)(pcmd->ClipRect.z - pcmd->ClipRect.x), (int)(pcmd->ClipRect.w - pcmd->ClipRect.y));
|
|
|
|
// Render 'pcmd->ElemCount/3' indexed triangles.
|
|
// By default the indices ImDrawIdx are 16-bits, you can change them to 32-bits if your engine doesn't support 16-bits indices.
|
|
MyEngineDrawIndexedTriangles(pcmd->ElemCount, sizeof(ImDrawIdx) == 2 ? GL_UNSIGNED_SHORT : GL_UNSIGNED_INT, idx_buffer, vtx_buffer);
|
|
}
|
|
idx_buffer += pcmd->ElemCount;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
- The examples/ folders contains many functional implementation of the pseudo-code above.
|
|
- When calling NewFrame(), the 'io.WantCaptureMouse'/'io.WantCaptureKeyboard'/'io.WantTextInput' flags are updated.
|
|
They tell you if ImGui intends to use your inputs. So for example, if 'io.WantCaptureMouse' is set you would typically want to hide
|
|
mouse inputs from the rest of your application. Read the FAQ below for more information about those flags.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
API BREAKING CHANGES
|
|
====================
|
|
|
|
Occasionally introducing changes that are breaking the API. The breakage are generally minor and easy to fix.
|
|
Here is a change-log of API breaking changes, if you are using one of the functions listed, expect to have to fix some code.
|
|
Also read releases logs https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/releases for more details.
|
|
|
|
- 2017/11/27 (1.53) - renamed ImGuiTextBuffer::append() helper to appendf(), appendv() to appendfv(). If you copied the 'Log' demo in your code, it uses appendv() so that needs to be renamed.
|
|
- 2017/11/18 (1.53) - Style, Begin: removed ImGuiWindowFlags_ShowBorders window flag. Borders are now fully set up in the ImGuiStyle structure (see e.g. style.FrameBorderSize, style.WindowBorderSize). Use ImGui::ShowStyleEditor() to look them up.
|
|
Please note that the style system will keep evolving (hopefully stabilizing in Q1 2018), and so custom styles will probably subtly break over time. It is recommended you use the StyleColorsClassic(), StyleColorsDark(), StyleColorsLight() functions.
|
|
- 2017/11/18 (1.53) - Style: removed ImGuiCol_ComboBg in favor of combo boxes using ImGuiCol_PopupBg for consistency.
|
|
- 2017/11/18 (1.53) - Style: renamed ImGuiCol_ChildWindowBg to ImGuiCol_ChildBg.
|
|
- 2017/11/18 (1.53) - Style: renamed style.ChildWindowRounding to style.ChildRounding, ImGuiStyleVar_ChildWindowRounding to ImGuiStyleVar_ChildRounding.
|
|
- 2017/11/02 (1.53) - marked IsRootWindowOrAnyChildHovered() as obsolete is favor of using IsWindowHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_FlattenChilds);
|
|
- 2017/10/24 (1.52) - renamed IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_CLIPBOARD_FUNCS/IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_IME_FUNCS to IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_CLIPBOARD_FUNCTIONS/IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_IME_FUNCTIONS for consistency.
|
|
- 2017/10/20 (1.52) - changed IsWindowHovered() default parameters behavior to return false if an item is active in another window (e.g. click-dragging item from another window to this window). You can use the newly introduced IsWindowHovered() flags to requests this specific behavior if you need it.
|
|
- 2017/10/20 (1.52) - marked IsItemHoveredRect()/IsMouseHoveringWindow() as obsolete, in favor of using the newly introduced flags for IsItemHovered() and IsWindowHovered(). See https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/issues/1382 for details.
|
|
removed the IsItemRectHovered()/IsWindowRectHovered() names introduced in 1.51 since they were merely more consistent names for the two functions we are now obsoleting.
|
|
- 2017/10/17 (1.52) - marked the old 5-parameters version of Begin() as obsolete (still available). Use SetNextWindowSize()+Begin() instead!
|
|
- 2017/10/11 (1.52) - renamed AlignFirstTextHeightToWidgets() to AlignTextToFramePadding(). Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete).
|
|
- 2017/09/25 (1.52) - removed SetNextWindowPosCenter() because SetNextWindowPos() now has the optional pivot information to do the same and more. Kept redirection function (will obsolete).
|
|
- 2017/08/25 (1.52) - io.MousePos needs to be set to ImVec2(-FLT_MAX,-FLT_MAX) when mouse is unavailable/missing. Previously ImVec2(-1,-1) was enough but we now accept negative mouse coordinates. In your binding if you need to support unavailable mouse, make sure to replace "io.MousePos = ImVec2(-1,-1)" with "io.MousePos = ImVec2(-FLT_MAX,-FLT_MAX)".
|
|
- 2017/08/22 (1.51) - renamed IsItemHoveredRect() to IsItemRectHovered(). Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete). -> (1.52) use IsItemHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_RectOnly)!
|
|
- renamed IsMouseHoveringAnyWindow() to IsAnyWindowHovered() for consistency. Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete).
|
|
- renamed IsMouseHoveringWindow() to IsWindowRectHovered() for consistency. Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete).
|
|
- 2017/08/20 (1.51) - renamed GetStyleColName() to GetStyleColorName() for consistency.
|
|
- 2017/08/20 (1.51) - added PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol idx, ImU32 col) overload, which _might_ cause an "ambiguous call" compilation error if you are using ImColor() with implicit cast. Cast to ImU32 or ImVec4 explicily to fix.
|
|
- 2017/08/15 (1.51) - marked the weird IMGUI_ONCE_UPON_A_FRAME helper macro as obsolete. prefer using the more explicit ImGuiOnceUponAFrame.
|
|
- 2017/08/15 (1.51) - changed parameter order for BeginPopupContextWindow() from (const char*,int buttons,bool also_over_items) to (const char*,int buttons,bool also_over_items). Note that most calls relied on default parameters completely.
|
|
- 2017/08/13 (1.51) - renamed ImGuiCol_Columns*** to ImGuiCol_Separator***. Kept redirection enums (will obsolete).
|
|
- 2017/08/11 (1.51) - renamed ImGuiSetCond_*** types and flags to ImGuiCond_***. Kept redirection enums (will obsolete).
|
|
- 2017/08/09 (1.51) - removed ValueColor() helpers, they are equivalent to calling Text(label) + SameLine() + ColorButton().
|
|
- 2017/08/08 (1.51) - removed ColorEditMode() and ImGuiColorEditMode in favor of ImGuiColorEditFlags and parameters to the various Color*() functions. The SetColorEditOptions() allows to initialize default but the user can still change them with right-click context menu.
|
|
- changed prototype of 'ColorEdit4(const char* label, float col[4], bool show_alpha = true)' to 'ColorEdit4(const char* label, float col[4], ImGuiColorEditFlags flags = 0)', where passing flags = 0x01 is a safe no-op (hello dodgy backward compatibility!). - check and run the demo window, under "Color/Picker Widgets", to understand the various new options.
|
|
- changed prototype of rarely used 'ColorButton(ImVec4 col, bool small_height = false, bool outline_border = true)' to 'ColorButton(const char* desc_id, ImVec4 col, ImGuiColorEditFlags flags = 0, ImVec2 size = ImVec2(0,0))'
|
|
- 2017/07/20 (1.51) - removed IsPosHoveringAnyWindow(ImVec2), which was partly broken and misleading. ASSERT + redirect user to io.WantCaptureMouse
|
|
- 2017/05/26 (1.50) - removed ImFontConfig::MergeGlyphCenterV in favor of a more multipurpose ImFontConfig::GlyphOffset.
|
|
- 2017/05/01 (1.50) - renamed ImDrawList::PathFill() (rarely used directly) to ImDrawList::PathFillConvex() for clarity.
|
|
- 2016/11/06 (1.50) - BeginChild(const char*) now applies the stack id to the provided label, consistently with other functions as it should always have been. It shouldn't affect you unless (extremely unlikely) you were appending multiple times to a same child from different locations of the stack id. If that's the case, generate an id with GetId() and use it instead of passing string to BeginChild().
|
|
- 2016/10/15 (1.50) - avoid 'void* user_data' parameter to io.SetClipboardTextFn/io.GetClipboardTextFn pointers. We pass io.ClipboardUserData to it.
|
|
- 2016/09/25 (1.50) - style.WindowTitleAlign is now a ImVec2 (ImGuiAlign enum was removed). set to (0.5f,0.5f) for horizontal+vertical centering, (0.0f,0.0f) for upper-left, etc.
|
|
- 2016/07/30 (1.50) - SameLine(x) with x>0.0f is now relative to left of column/group if any, and not always to left of window. This was sort of always the intent and hopefully breakage should be minimal.
|
|
- 2016/05/12 (1.49) - title bar (using ImGuiCol_TitleBg/ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive colors) isn't rendered over a window background (ImGuiCol_WindowBg color) anymore.
|
|
If your TitleBg/TitleBgActive alpha was 1.0f or you are using the default theme it will not affect you.
|
|
However if your TitleBg/TitleBgActive alpha was <1.0f you need to tweak your custom theme to readjust for the fact that we don't draw a WindowBg background behind the title bar.
|
|
This helper function will convert an old TitleBg/TitleBgActive color into a new one with the same visual output, given the OLD color and the OLD WindowBg color.
|
|
ImVec4 ConvertTitleBgCol(const ImVec4& win_bg_col, const ImVec4& title_bg_col)
|
|
{
|
|
float new_a = 1.0f - ((1.0f - win_bg_col.w) * (1.0f - title_bg_col.w)), k = title_bg_col.w / new_a;
|
|
return ImVec4((win_bg_col.x * win_bg_col.w + title_bg_col.x) * k, (win_bg_col.y * win_bg_col.w + title_bg_col.y) * k, (win_bg_col.z * win_bg_col.w + title_bg_col.z) * k, new_a);
|
|
}
|
|
If this is confusing, pick the RGB value from title bar from an old screenshot and apply this as TitleBg/TitleBgActive. Or you may just create TitleBgActive from a tweaked TitleBg color.
|
|
- 2016/05/07 (1.49) - removed confusing set of GetInternalState(), GetInternalStateSize(), SetInternalState() functions. Now using CreateContext(), DestroyContext(), GetCurrentContext(), SetCurrentContext().
|
|
- 2016/05/02 (1.49) - renamed SetNextTreeNodeOpened() to SetNextTreeNodeOpen(), no redirection.
|
|
- 2016/05/01 (1.49) - obsoleted old signature of CollapsingHeader(const char* label, const char* str_id = NULL, bool display_frame = true, bool default_open = false) as extra parameters were badly designed and rarely used. You can replace the "default_open = true" flag in new API with CollapsingHeader(label, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_DefaultOpen).
|
|
- 2016/04/26 (1.49) - changed ImDrawList::PushClipRect(ImVec4 rect) to ImDraw::PushClipRect(Imvec2 min,ImVec2 max,bool intersect_with_current_clip_rect=false). Note that higher-level ImGui::PushClipRect() is preferable because it will clip at logic/widget level, whereas ImDrawList::PushClipRect() only affect your renderer.
|
|
- 2016/04/03 (1.48) - removed style.WindowFillAlphaDefault setting which was redundant. Bake default BG alpha inside style.Colors[ImGuiCol_WindowBg] and all other Bg color values. (ref github issue #337).
|
|
- 2016/04/03 (1.48) - renamed ImGuiCol_TooltipBg to ImGuiCol_PopupBg, used by popups/menus and tooltips. popups/menus were previously using ImGuiCol_WindowBg. (ref github issue #337)
|
|
- 2016/03/21 (1.48) - renamed GetWindowFont() to GetFont(), GetWindowFontSize() to GetFontSize(). Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete).
|
|
- 2016/03/02 (1.48) - InputText() completion/history/always callbacks: if you modify the text buffer manually (without using DeleteChars()/InsertChars() helper) you need to maintain the BufTextLen field. added an assert.
|
|
- 2016/01/23 (1.48) - fixed not honoring exact width passed to PushItemWidth(), previously it would add extra FramePadding.x*2 over that width. if you had manual pixel-perfect alignment in place it might affect you.
|
|
- 2015/12/27 (1.48) - fixed ImDrawList::AddRect() which used to render a rectangle 1 px too large on each axis.
|
|
- 2015/12/04 (1.47) - renamed Color() helpers to ValueColor() - dangerously named, rarely used and probably to be made obsolete.
|
|
- 2015/08/29 (1.45) - with the addition of horizontal scrollbar we made various fixes to inconsistencies with dealing with cursor position.
|
|
GetCursorPos()/SetCursorPos() functions now include the scrolled amount. It shouldn't affect the majority of users, but take note that SetCursorPosX(100.0f) puts you at +100 from the starting x position which may include scrolling, not at +100 from the window left side.
|
|
GetContentRegionMax()/GetWindowContentRegionMin()/GetWindowContentRegionMax() functions allow include the scrolled amount. Typically those were used in cases where no scrolling would happen so it may not be a problem, but watch out!
|
|
- 2015/08/29 (1.45) - renamed style.ScrollbarWidth to style.ScrollbarSize
|
|
- 2015/08/05 (1.44) - split imgui.cpp into extra files: imgui_demo.cpp imgui_draw.cpp imgui_internal.h that you need to add to your project.
|
|
- 2015/07/18 (1.44) - fixed angles in ImDrawList::PathArcTo(), PathArcToFast() (introduced in 1.43) being off by an extra PI for no justifiable reason
|
|
- 2015/07/14 (1.43) - add new ImFontAtlas::AddFont() API. For the old AddFont***, moved the 'font_no' parameter of ImFontAtlas::AddFont** functions to the ImFontConfig structure.
|
|
you need to render your textured triangles with bilinear filtering to benefit from sub-pixel positioning of text.
|
|
- 2015/07/08 (1.43) - switched rendering data to use indexed rendering. this is saving a fair amount of CPU/GPU and enables us to get anti-aliasing for a marginal cost.
|
|
this necessary change will break your rendering function! the fix should be very easy. sorry for that :(
|
|
- if you are using a vanilla copy of one of the imgui_impl_XXXX.cpp provided in the example, you just need to update your copy and you can ignore the rest.
|
|
- the signature of the io.RenderDrawListsFn handler has changed!
|
|
ImGui_XXXX_RenderDrawLists(ImDrawList** const cmd_lists, int cmd_lists_count)
|
|
became:
|
|
ImGui_XXXX_RenderDrawLists(ImDrawData* draw_data).
|
|
argument 'cmd_lists' -> 'draw_data->CmdLists'
|
|
argument 'cmd_lists_count' -> 'draw_data->CmdListsCount'
|
|
ImDrawList 'commands' -> 'CmdBuffer'
|
|
ImDrawList 'vtx_buffer' -> 'VtxBuffer'
|
|
ImDrawList n/a -> 'IdxBuffer' (new)
|
|
ImDrawCmd 'vtx_count' -> 'ElemCount'
|
|
ImDrawCmd 'clip_rect' -> 'ClipRect'
|
|
ImDrawCmd 'user_callback' -> 'UserCallback'
|
|
ImDrawCmd 'texture_id' -> 'TextureId'
|
|
- each ImDrawList now contains both a vertex buffer and an index buffer. For each command, render ElemCount/3 triangles using indices from the index buffer.
|
|
- if you REALLY cannot render indexed primitives, you can call the draw_data->DeIndexAllBuffers() method to de-index the buffers. This is slow and a waste of CPU/GPU. Prefer using indexed rendering!
|
|
- refer to code in the examples/ folder or ask on the GitHub if you are unsure of how to upgrade. please upgrade!
|
|
- 2015/07/10 (1.43) - changed SameLine() parameters from int to float.
|
|
- 2015/07/02 (1.42) - renamed SetScrollPosHere() to SetScrollFromCursorPos(). Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete).
|
|
- 2015/07/02 (1.42) - renamed GetScrollPosY() to GetScrollY(). Necessary to reduce confusion along with other scrolling functions, because positions (e.g. cursor position) are not equivalent to scrolling amount.
|
|
- 2015/06/14 (1.41) - changed ImageButton() default bg_col parameter from (0,0,0,1) (black) to (0,0,0,0) (transparent) - makes a difference when texture have transparence
|
|
- 2015/06/14 (1.41) - changed Selectable() API from (label, selected, size) to (label, selected, flags, size). Size override should have been rarely be used. Sorry!
|
|
- 2015/05/31 (1.40) - renamed GetWindowCollapsed() to IsWindowCollapsed() for consistency. Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete).
|
|
- 2015/05/31 (1.40) - renamed IsRectClipped() to IsRectVisible() for consistency. Note that return value is opposite! Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete).
|
|
- 2015/05/27 (1.40) - removed the third 'repeat_if_held' parameter from Button() - sorry! it was rarely used and inconsistent. Use PushButtonRepeat(true) / PopButtonRepeat() to enable repeat on desired buttons.
|
|
- 2015/05/11 (1.40) - changed BeginPopup() API, takes a string identifier instead of a bool. ImGui needs to manage the open/closed state of popups. Call OpenPopup() to actually set the "open" state of a popup. BeginPopup() returns true if the popup is opened.
|
|
- 2015/05/03 (1.40) - removed style.AutoFitPadding, using style.WindowPadding makes more sense (the default values were already the same).
|
|
- 2015/04/13 (1.38) - renamed IsClipped() to IsRectClipped(). Kept inline redirection function until 1.50.
|
|
- 2015/04/09 (1.38) - renamed ImDrawList::AddArc() to ImDrawList::AddArcFast() for compatibility with future API
|
|
- 2015/04/03 (1.38) - removed ImGuiCol_CheckHovered, ImGuiCol_CheckActive, replaced with the more general ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered, ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive.
|
|
- 2014/04/03 (1.38) - removed support for passing -FLT_MAX..+FLT_MAX as the range for a SliderFloat(). Use DragFloat() or Inputfloat() instead.
|
|
- 2015/03/17 (1.36) - renamed GetItemBoxMin()/GetItemBoxMax()/IsMouseHoveringBox() to GetItemRectMin()/GetItemRectMax()/IsMouseHoveringRect(). Kept inline redirection function until 1.50.
|
|
- 2015/03/15 (1.36) - renamed style.TreeNodeSpacing to style.IndentSpacing, ImGuiStyleVar_TreeNodeSpacing to ImGuiStyleVar_IndentSpacing
|
|
- 2015/03/13 (1.36) - renamed GetWindowIsFocused() to IsWindowFocused(). Kept inline redirection function until 1.50.
|
|
- 2015/03/08 (1.35) - renamed style.ScrollBarWidth to style.ScrollbarWidth (casing)
|
|
- 2015/02/27 (1.34) - renamed OpenNextNode(bool) to SetNextTreeNodeOpened(bool, ImGuiSetCond). Kept inline redirection function until 1.50.
|
|
- 2015/02/27 (1.34) - renamed ImGuiSetCondition_*** to ImGuiSetCond_***, and _FirstUseThisSession becomes _Once.
|
|
- 2015/02/11 (1.32) - changed text input callback ImGuiTextEditCallback return type from void-->int. reserved for future use, return 0 for now.
|
|
- 2015/02/10 (1.32) - renamed GetItemWidth() to CalcItemWidth() to clarify its evolving behavior
|
|
- 2015/02/08 (1.31) - renamed GetTextLineSpacing() to GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing()
|
|
- 2015/02/01 (1.31) - removed IO.MemReallocFn (unused)
|
|
- 2015/01/19 (1.30) - renamed ImGuiStorage::GetIntPtr()/GetFloatPtr() to GetIntRef()/GetIntRef() because Ptr was conflicting with actual pointer storage functions.
|
|
- 2015/01/11 (1.30) - big font/image API change! now loads TTF file. allow for multiple fonts. no need for a PNG loader.
|
|
(1.30) - removed GetDefaultFontData(). uses io.Fonts->GetTextureData*() API to retrieve uncompressed pixels.
|
|
this sequence:
|
|
const void* png_data;
|
|
unsigned int png_size;
|
|
ImGui::GetDefaultFontData(NULL, NULL, &png_data, &png_size);
|
|
// <Copy to GPU>
|
|
became:
|
|
unsigned char* pixels;
|
|
int width, height;
|
|
io.Fonts->GetTexDataAsRGBA32(&pixels, &width, &height);
|
|
// <Copy to GPU>
|
|
io.Fonts->TexID = (your_texture_identifier);
|
|
you now have much more flexibility to load multiple TTF fonts and manage the texture buffer for internal needs.
|
|
it is now recommended that you sample the font texture with bilinear interpolation.
|
|
(1.30) - added texture identifier in ImDrawCmd passed to your render function (we can now render images). make sure to set io.Fonts->TexID.
|
|
(1.30) - removed IO.PixelCenterOffset (unnecessary, can be handled in user projection matrix)
|
|
(1.30) - removed ImGui::IsItemFocused() in favor of ImGui::IsItemActive() which handles all widgets
|
|
- 2014/12/10 (1.18) - removed SetNewWindowDefaultPos() in favor of new generic API SetNextWindowPos(pos, ImGuiSetCondition_FirstUseEver)
|
|
- 2014/11/28 (1.17) - moved IO.Font*** options to inside the IO.Font-> structure (FontYOffset, FontTexUvForWhite, FontBaseScale, FontFallbackGlyph)
|
|
- 2014/11/26 (1.17) - reworked syntax of IMGUI_ONCE_UPON_A_FRAME helper macro to increase compiler compatibility
|
|
- 2014/11/07 (1.15) - renamed IsHovered() to IsItemHovered()
|
|
- 2014/10/02 (1.14) - renamed IMGUI_INCLUDE_IMGUI_USER_CPP to IMGUI_INCLUDE_IMGUI_USER_INL and imgui_user.cpp to imgui_user.inl (more IDE friendly)
|
|
- 2014/09/25 (1.13) - removed 'text_end' parameter from IO.SetClipboardTextFn (the string is now always zero-terminated for simplicity)
|
|
- 2014/09/24 (1.12) - renamed SetFontScale() to SetWindowFontScale()
|
|
- 2014/09/24 (1.12) - moved IM_MALLOC/IM_REALLOC/IM_FREE preprocessor defines to IO.MemAllocFn/IO.MemReallocFn/IO.MemFreeFn
|
|
- 2014/08/30 (1.09) - removed IO.FontHeight (now computed automatically)
|
|
- 2014/08/30 (1.09) - moved IMGUI_FONT_TEX_UV_FOR_WHITE preprocessor define to IO.FontTexUvForWhite
|
|
- 2014/08/28 (1.09) - changed the behavior of IO.PixelCenterOffset following various rendering fixes
|
|
|
|
|
|
ISSUES & TODO-LIST
|
|
==================
|
|
See TODO.txt
|
|
|
|
|
|
FREQUENTLY ASKED QUESTIONS (FAQ), TIPS
|
|
======================================
|
|
|
|
Q: How can I help?
|
|
A: - If you are experienced enough with Dear ImGui and with C/C++, look at the todo list and see how you want/can help!
|
|
- Become a Patron/donate! Convince your company to become a Patron or provide serious funding for development time! See http://www.patreon.com/imgui
|
|
|
|
Q: What is ImTextureID and how do I display an image?
|
|
A: ImTextureID is a void* used to pass renderer-agnostic texture references around until it hits your render function.
|
|
Dear ImGui knows nothing about what those bits represent, it just passes them around. It is up to you to decide what you want the void* to carry!
|
|
It could be an identifier to your OpenGL texture (cast GLuint to void*), a pointer to your custom engine material (cast MyMaterial* to void*), etc.
|
|
At the end of the chain, your renderer takes this void* to cast it back into whatever it needs to select a current texture to render.
|
|
Refer to examples applications, where each renderer (in a imgui_impl_xxxx.cpp file) is treating ImTextureID as a different thing.
|
|
(c++ tip: OpenGL uses integers to identify textures. You can safely store an integer into a void*, just cast it to void*, don't take it's address!)
|
|
To display a custom image/texture within an ImGui window, you may use ImGui::Image(), ImGui::ImageButton(), ImDrawList::AddImage() functions.
|
|
Dear ImGui will generate the geometry and draw calls using the ImTextureID that you passed and which your renderer can use.
|
|
It is your responsibility to get textures uploaded to your GPU.
|
|
|
|
Q: I integrated Dear ImGui in my engine and the text or lines are blurry..
|
|
A: In your Render function, try translating your projection matrix by (0.5f,0.5f) or (0.375f,0.375f).
|
|
Also make sure your orthographic projection matrix and io.DisplaySize matches your actual framebuffer dimension.
|
|
|
|
Q: I integrated Dear ImGui in my engine and some elements are clipping or disappearing when I move windows around..
|
|
A: You are probably mishandling the clipping rectangles in your render function.
|
|
Rectangles provided by ImGui are defined as (x1=left,y1=top,x2=right,y2=bottom) and NOT as (x1,y1,width,height).
|
|
|
|
Q: Can I have multiple widgets with the same label? Can I have widget without a label?
|
|
A: Yes. A primer on the use of labels/IDs in Dear ImGui..
|
|
|
|
- Elements that are not clickable, such as Text() items don't need an ID.
|
|
|
|
- Interactive widgets require state to be carried over multiple frames (most typically Dear ImGui often needs to remember what is
|
|
the "active" widget). to do so they need a unique ID. unique ID are typically derived from a string label, an integer index or a pointer.
|
|
|
|
Button("OK"); // Label = "OK", ID = hash of "OK"
|
|
Button("Cancel"); // Label = "Cancel", ID = hash of "Cancel"
|
|
|
|
- ID are uniquely scoped within windows, tree nodes, etc. so no conflict can happen if you have two buttons called "OK"
|
|
in two different windows or in two different locations of a tree.
|
|
|
|
- If you have a same ID twice in the same location, you'll have a conflict:
|
|
|
|
Button("OK");
|
|
Button("OK"); // ID collision! Both buttons will be treated as the same.
|
|
|
|
Fear not! this is easy to solve and there are many ways to solve it!
|
|
|
|
- When passing a label you can optionally specify extra unique ID information within string itself.
|
|
This helps solving the simpler collision cases. Use "##" to pass a complement to the ID that won't be visible to the end-user:
|
|
|
|
Button("Play"); // Label = "Play", ID = hash of "Play"
|
|
Button("Play##foo1"); // Label = "Play", ID = hash of "Play##foo1" (different from above)
|
|
Button("Play##foo2"); // Label = "Play", ID = hash of "Play##foo2" (different from above)
|
|
|
|
- If you want to completely hide the label, but still need an ID:
|
|
|
|
Checkbox("##On", &b); // Label = "", ID = hash of "##On" (no label!)
|
|
|
|
- Occasionally/rarely you might want change a label while preserving a constant ID. This allows you to animate labels.
|
|
For example you may want to include varying information in a window title bar (and windows are uniquely identified by their ID.. obviously)
|
|
Use "###" to pass a label that isn't part of ID:
|
|
|
|
Button("Hello###ID"; // Label = "Hello", ID = hash of "ID"
|
|
Button("World###ID"; // Label = "World", ID = hash of "ID" (same as above)
|
|
|
|
sprintf(buf, "My game (%f FPS)###MyGame");
|
|
Begin(buf); // Variable label, ID = hash of "MyGame"
|
|
|
|
- Use PushID() / PopID() to create scopes and avoid ID conflicts within the same Window.
|
|
This is the most convenient way of distinguishing ID if you are iterating and creating many UI elements.
|
|
You can push a pointer, a string or an integer value. Remember that ID are formed from the concatenation of everything in the ID stack!
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < 100; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
PushID(i);
|
|
Button("Click"); // Label = "Click", ID = hash of integer + "label" (unique)
|
|
PopID();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < 100; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
MyObject* obj = Objects[i];
|
|
PushID(obj);
|
|
Button("Click"); // Label = "Click", ID = hash of pointer + "label" (unique)
|
|
PopID();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < 100; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
MyObject* obj = Objects[i];
|
|
PushID(obj->Name);
|
|
Button("Click"); // Label = "Click", ID = hash of string + "label" (unique)
|
|
PopID();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
- More example showing that you can stack multiple prefixes into the ID stack:
|
|
|
|
Button("Click"); // Label = "Click", ID = hash of "Click"
|
|
PushID("node");
|
|
Button("Click"); // Label = "Click", ID = hash of "node" + "Click"
|
|
PushID(my_ptr);
|
|
Button("Click"); // Label = "Click", ID = hash of "node" + ptr + "Click"
|
|
PopID();
|
|
PopID();
|
|
|
|
- Tree nodes implicitly creates a scope for you by calling PushID().
|
|
|
|
Button("Click"); // Label = "Click", ID = hash of "Click"
|
|
if (TreeNode("node"))
|
|
{
|
|
Button("Click"); // Label = "Click", ID = hash of "node" + "Click"
|
|
TreePop();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
- When working with trees, ID are used to preserve the open/close state of each tree node.
|
|
Depending on your use cases you may want to use strings, indices or pointers as ID.
|
|
e.g. when displaying a single object that may change over time (dynamic 1-1 relationship), using a static string as ID will preserve your
|
|
node open/closed state when the targeted object change.
|
|
e.g. when displaying a list of objects, using indices or pointers as ID will preserve the node open/closed state differently.
|
|
experiment and see what makes more sense!
|
|
|
|
Q: How can I tell when Dear ImGui wants my mouse/keyboard inputs VS when I can pass them to my application?
|
|
A: You can read the 'io.WantCaptureMouse'/'io.WantCaptureKeyboard'/'ioWantTextInput' flags from the ImGuiIO structure.
|
|
- When 'io.WantCaptureMouse' or 'io.WantCaptureKeyboard' flags are set you may want to discard/hide the inputs from the rest of your application.
|
|
- When 'io.WantTextInput' is set to may want to notify your OS to popup an on-screen keyboard, if available (e.g. on a mobile phone, or console OS).
|
|
Preferably read the flags after calling ImGui::NewFrame() to avoid them lagging by one frame. But reading those flags before calling NewFrame() is
|
|
also generally ok, as the bool toggles fairly rarely and you don't generally expect to interact with either Dear ImGui or your application during
|
|
the same frame when that transition occurs. Dear ImGui is tracking dragging and widget activity that may occur outside the boundary of a window,
|
|
so 'io.WantCaptureMouse' is more accurate and correct than checking if a window is hovered.
|
|
(Advanced note: text input releases focus on Return 'KeyDown', so the following Return 'KeyUp' event that your application receive will typically
|
|
have 'io.WantCaptureKeyboard=false'. Depending on your application logic it may or not be inconvenient. You might want to track which key-downs
|
|
were for Dear ImGui, e.g. with an array of bool, and filter out the corresponding key-ups.)
|
|
|
|
Q: How can I load a different font than the default? (default is an embedded version of ProggyClean.ttf, rendered at size 13)
|
|
A: Use the font atlas to load the TTF/OTF file you want:
|
|
|
|
ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO();
|
|
io.Fonts->AddFontFromFileTTF("myfontfile.ttf", size_in_pixels);
|
|
io.Fonts->GetTexDataAsRGBA32() or GetTexDataAsAlpha8()
|
|
|
|
Q: How can I easily use icons in my application?
|
|
A: The most convenient and practical way is to merge an icon font such as FontAwesome inside you main font. Then you can refer to icons within your
|
|
strings. Read 'How can I load multiple fonts?' and the file 'extra_fonts/README.txt' for instructions and useful header files.
|
|
|
|
Q: How can I load multiple fonts?
|
|
A: Use the font atlas to pack them into a single texture:
|
|
(Read extra_fonts/README.txt and the code in ImFontAtlas for more details.)
|
|
|
|
ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO();
|
|
ImFont* font0 = io.Fonts->AddFontDefault();
|
|
ImFont* font1 = io.Fonts->AddFontFromFileTTF("myfontfile.ttf", size_in_pixels);
|
|
ImFont* font2 = io.Fonts->AddFontFromFileTTF("myfontfile2.ttf", size_in_pixels);
|
|
io.Fonts->GetTexDataAsRGBA32() or GetTexDataAsAlpha8()
|
|
// the first loaded font gets used by default
|
|
// use ImGui::PushFont()/ImGui::PopFont() to change the font at runtime
|
|
|
|
// Options
|
|
ImFontConfig config;
|
|
config.OversampleH = 3;
|
|
config.OversampleV = 1;
|
|
config.GlyphOffset.y -= 2.0f; // Move everything by 2 pixels up
|
|
config.GlyphExtraSpacing.x = 1.0f; // Increase spacing between characters
|
|
io.Fonts->LoadFromFileTTF("myfontfile.ttf", size_pixels, &config);
|
|
|
|
// Combine multiple fonts into one (e.g. for icon fonts)
|
|
ImWchar ranges[] = { 0xf000, 0xf3ff, 0 };
|
|
ImFontConfig config;
|
|
config.MergeMode = true;
|
|
io.Fonts->AddFontDefault();
|
|
io.Fonts->LoadFromFileTTF("fontawesome-webfont.ttf", 16.0f, &config, ranges); // Merge icon font
|
|
io.Fonts->LoadFromFileTTF("myfontfile.ttf", size_pixels, NULL, &config, io.Fonts->GetGlyphRangesJapanese()); // Merge japanese glyphs
|
|
|
|
Q: How can I display and input non-Latin characters such as Chinese, Japanese, Korean, Cyrillic?
|
|
A: When loading a font, pass custom Unicode ranges to specify the glyphs to load.
|
|
|
|
// Add default Japanese ranges
|
|
io.Fonts->AddFontFromFileTTF("myfontfile.ttf", size_in_pixels, NULL, io.Fonts->GetGlyphRangesJapanese());
|
|
|
|
// Or create your own custom ranges (e.g. for a game you can feed your entire game script and only build the characters the game need)
|
|
ImVector<ImWchar> ranges;
|
|
ImFontAtlas::GlyphRangesBuilder builder;
|
|
builder.AddText("Hello world"); // Add a string (here "Hello world" contains 7 unique characters)
|
|
builder.AddChar(0x7262); // Add a specific character
|
|
builder.AddRanges(io.Fonts->GetGlyphRangesJapanese()); // Add one of the default ranges
|
|
builder.BuildRanges(&ranges); // Build the final result (ordered ranges with all the unique characters submitted)
|
|
io.Fonts->AddFontFromFileTTF("myfontfile.ttf", size_in_pixels, NULL, ranges.Data);
|
|
|
|
All your strings needs to use UTF-8 encoding. In C++11 you can encode a string literal in UTF-8 by using the u8"hello" syntax.
|
|
Specifying literal in your source code using a local code page (such as CP-923 for Japanese or CP-1251 for Cyrillic) will NOT work!
|
|
Otherwise you can convert yourself to UTF-8 or load text data from file already saved as UTF-8.
|
|
|
|
Text input: it is up to your application to pass the right character code to io.AddInputCharacter(). The applications in examples/ are doing that.
|
|
For languages using IME, on Windows you can copy the Hwnd of your application to io.ImeWindowHandle.
|
|
The default implementation of io.ImeSetInputScreenPosFn() on Windows will set your IME position correctly.
|
|
|
|
Q: How can I preserve my Dear ImGui context across reloading a DLL? (loss of the global/static variables)
|
|
A: Create your own context 'ctx = CreateContext()' + 'SetCurrentContext(ctx)' and your own font atlas 'ctx->GetIO().Fonts = new ImFontAtlas()'
|
|
so you don't rely on the default globals.
|
|
|
|
Q: How can I use the drawing facilities without an ImGui window? (using ImDrawList API)
|
|
A: The easiest way is to create a dummy window. Call Begin() with NoTitleBar|NoResize|NoMove|NoScrollbar|NoSavedSettings|NoInputs flag,
|
|
zero background alpha, then retrieve the ImDrawList* via GetWindowDrawList() and draw to it in any way you like.
|
|
You can also perfectly create a standalone ImDrawList instance _but_ you need ImGui to be initialized because ImDrawList pulls from ImGui
|
|
data to retrieve the coordinates of the white pixel.
|
|
|
|
- tip: you can call Begin() multiple times with the same name during the same frame, it will keep appending to the same window.
|
|
this is also useful to set yourself in the context of another window (to get/set other settings)
|
|
- tip: you can create widgets without a Begin()/End() block, they will go in an implicit window called "Debug".
|
|
- tip: the ImGuiOnceUponAFrame helper will allow run the block of code only once a frame. You can use it to quickly add custom UI in the middle
|
|
of a deep nested inner loop in your code.
|
|
- tip: you can call Render() multiple times (e.g for VR renders).
|
|
- tip: call and read the ShowTestWindow() code in imgui_demo.cpp for more example of how to use ImGui!
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
#if defined(_MSC_VER) && !defined(_CRT_SECURE_NO_WARNINGS)
|
|
#define _CRT_SECURE_NO_WARNINGS
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#include "imgui.h"
|
|
#define IMGUI_DEFINE_MATH_OPERATORS
|
|
#define IMGUI_DEFINE_PLACEMENT_NEW
|
|
#include "imgui_internal.h"
|
|
|
|
#include <ctype.h> // toupper, isprint
|
|
#include <stdlib.h> // NULL, malloc, free, qsort, atoi
|
|
#include <stdio.h> // vsnprintf, sscanf, printf
|
|
#include <limits.h> // INT_MIN, INT_MAX
|
|
#if defined(_MSC_VER) && _MSC_VER <= 1500 // MSVC 2008 or earlier
|
|
#include <stddef.h> // intptr_t
|
|
#else
|
|
#include <stdint.h> // intptr_t
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#ifdef _MSC_VER
|
|
#pragma warning (disable: 4127) // condition expression is constant
|
|
#pragma warning (disable: 4505) // unreferenced local function has been removed (stb stuff)
|
|
#pragma warning (disable: 4996) // 'This function or variable may be unsafe': strcpy, strdup, sprintf, vsnprintf, sscanf, fopen
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
// Clang warnings with -Weverything
|
|
#ifdef __clang__
|
|
#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wunknown-pragmas" // warning : unknown warning group '-Wformat-pedantic *' // not all warnings are known by all clang versions.. so ignoring warnings triggers new warnings on some configuration. great!
|
|
#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wold-style-cast" // warning : use of old-style cast // yes, they are more terse.
|
|
#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wfloat-equal" // warning : comparing floating point with == or != is unsafe // storing and comparing against same constants (typically 0.0f) is ok.
|
|
#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wformat-nonliteral" // warning : format string is not a string literal // passing non-literal to vsnformat(). yes, user passing incorrect format strings can crash the code.
|
|
#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wexit-time-destructors" // warning : declaration requires an exit-time destructor // exit-time destruction order is undefined. if MemFree() leads to users code that has been disabled before exit it might cause problems. ImGui coding style welcomes static/globals.
|
|
#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wglobal-constructors" // warning : declaration requires a global destructor // similar to above, not sure what the exact difference it.
|
|
#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wsign-conversion" // warning : implicit conversion changes signedness //
|
|
#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wformat-pedantic" // warning : format specifies type 'void *' but the argument has type 'xxxx *' // unreasonable, would lead to casting every %p arg to void*. probably enabled by -pedantic.
|
|
#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wint-to-void-pointer-cast" // warning : cast to 'void *' from smaller integer type 'int' //
|
|
#elif defined(__GNUC__)
|
|
#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wunused-function" // warning: 'xxxx' defined but not used
|
|
#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wint-to-pointer-cast" // warning: cast to pointer from integer of different size
|
|
#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wformat" // warning: format '%p' expects argument of type 'void*', but argument 6 has type 'ImGuiWindow*'
|
|
#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wdouble-promotion" // warning: implicit conversion from 'float' to 'double' when passing argument to function
|
|
#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wconversion" // warning: conversion to 'xxxx' from 'xxxx' may alter its value
|
|
#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wcast-qual" // warning: cast from type 'xxxx' to type 'xxxx' casts away qualifiers
|
|
#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wformat-nonliteral" // warning: format not a string literal, format string not checked
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
// Forward Declarations
|
|
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
static float GetDraggedColumnOffset(int column_index);
|
|
|
|
static bool IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey key, bool repeat = true);
|
|
|
|
static ImFont* GetDefaultFont();
|
|
static void SetCurrentFont(ImFont* font);
|
|
static void SetCurrentWindow(ImGuiWindow* window);
|
|
static void SetWindowScrollY(ImGuiWindow* window, float new_scroll_y);
|
|
static void SetWindowPos(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImVec2& pos, ImGuiCond cond);
|
|
static void SetWindowSize(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiCond cond);
|
|
static void SetWindowCollapsed(ImGuiWindow* window, bool collapsed, ImGuiCond cond);
|
|
static ImGuiWindow* FindHoveredWindow(ImVec2 pos);
|
|
static ImGuiWindow* CreateNewWindow(const char* name, ImVec2 size, ImGuiWindowFlags flags);
|
|
static void ClearSetNextWindowData();
|
|
static void CheckStacksSize(ImGuiWindow* window, bool write);
|
|
static ImVec2 CalcNextScrollFromScrollTargetAndClamp(ImGuiWindow* window);
|
|
|
|
static void AddDrawListToRenderList(ImVector<ImDrawList*>& out_render_list, ImDrawList* draw_list);
|
|
static void AddWindowToRenderList(ImVector<ImDrawList*>& out_render_list, ImGuiWindow* window);
|
|
static void AddWindowToSortedBuffer(ImVector<ImGuiWindow*>& out_sorted_windows, ImGuiWindow* window);
|
|
|
|
static ImGuiWindowSettings* AddWindowSettings(const char* name);
|
|
|
|
static void LoadIniSettingsFromDisk(const char* ini_filename);
|
|
static void LoadIniSettingsFromMemory(const char* buf);
|
|
static void SaveIniSettingsToDisk(const char* ini_filename);
|
|
static void SaveIniSettingsToMemory(ImVector<char>& out_buf);
|
|
static void MarkIniSettingsDirty(ImGuiWindow* window);
|
|
|
|
static ImRect GetVisibleRect();
|
|
|
|
static void CloseInactivePopups(ImGuiWindow* ref_window);
|
|
static void ClosePopupToLevel(int remaining);
|
|
static ImGuiWindow* GetFrontMostModalRootWindow();
|
|
static ImVec2 FindBestWindowPosForPopup(const ImVec2& base_pos, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiDir* last_dir, const ImRect& rect_to_avoid);
|
|
|
|
static bool InputTextFilterCharacter(unsigned int* p_char, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags, ImGuiTextEditCallback callback, void* user_data);
|
|
static int InputTextCalcTextLenAndLineCount(const char* text_begin, const char** out_text_end);
|
|
static ImVec2 InputTextCalcTextSizeW(const ImWchar* text_begin, const ImWchar* text_end, const ImWchar** remaining = NULL, ImVec2* out_offset = NULL, bool stop_on_new_line = false);
|
|
|
|
static inline void DataTypeFormatString(ImGuiDataType data_type, void* data_ptr, const char* display_format, char* buf, int buf_size);
|
|
static inline void DataTypeFormatString(ImGuiDataType data_type, void* data_ptr, int decimal_precision, char* buf, int buf_size);
|
|
static void DataTypeApplyOp(ImGuiDataType data_type, int op, void* value1, const void* value2);
|
|
static bool DataTypeApplyOpFromText(const char* buf, const char* initial_value_buf, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* data_ptr, const char* scalar_format);
|
|
|
|
namespace ImGui
|
|
{
|
|
static void FocusPreviousWindow();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
// Platform dependent default implementations
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
static const char* GetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl(void* user_data);
|
|
static void SetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl(void* user_data, const char* text);
|
|
static void ImeSetInputScreenPosFn_DefaultImpl(int x, int y);
|
|
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
// Context
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// Default font atlas storage.
|
|
// New contexts always point by default to this font atlas. It can be changed by reassigning the GetIO().Fonts variable.
|
|
static ImFontAtlas GImDefaultFontAtlas;
|
|
|
|
// Default context storage + current context pointer.
|
|
// Implicitely used by all ImGui functions. Always assumed to be != NULL. Change to a different context by calling ImGui::SetCurrentContext()
|
|
// If you are hot-reloading this code in a DLL you will lose the static/global variables. Create your own context+font atlas instead of relying on those default (see FAQ entry "How can I preserve my ImGui context across reloading a DLL?").
|
|
// ImGui is currently not thread-safe because of this variable. If you want thread-safety to allow N threads to access N different contexts, you might work around it by:
|
|
// - Having multiple instances of the ImGui code compiled inside different namespace (easiest/safest, if you have a finite number of contexts)
|
|
// - or: Changing this variable to be TLS. You may #define GImGui in imconfig.h for further custom hackery. Future development aim to make this context pointer explicit to all calls. Also read https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/issues/586
|
|
#ifndef GImGui
|
|
static ImGuiContext GImDefaultContext;
|
|
ImGuiContext* GImGui = &GImDefaultContext;
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
// User facing structures
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
ImGuiStyle::ImGuiStyle()
|
|
{
|
|
Alpha = 1.0f; // Global alpha applies to everything in ImGui
|
|
WindowPadding = ImVec2(8,8); // Padding within a window
|
|
WindowRounding = 7.0f; // Radius of window corners rounding. Set to 0.0f to have rectangular windows
|
|
WindowBorderSize = 0.0f; // Thickness of border around windows. Generally set to 0.0f or 1.0f. Other values not well tested.
|
|
WindowMinSize = ImVec2(32,32); // Minimum window size
|
|
WindowTitleAlign = ImVec2(0.0f,0.5f);// Alignment for title bar text
|
|
ChildRounding = 0.0f; // Radius of child window corners rounding. Set to 0.0f to have rectangular child windows
|
|
ChildBorderSize = 1.0f; // Thickness of border around child windows. Generally set to 0.0f or 1.0f. Other values not well tested.
|
|
PopupRounding = 0.0f; // Radius of popup window corners rounding. Set to 0.0f to have rectangular child windows
|
|
PopupBorderSize = 1.0f; // Thickness of border around popup or tooltip windows. Generally set to 0.0f or 1.0f. Other values not well tested.
|
|
FramePadding = ImVec2(4,3); // Padding within a framed rectangle (used by most widgets)
|
|
FrameRounding = 0.0f; // Radius of frame corners rounding. Set to 0.0f to have rectangular frames (used by most widgets).
|
|
FrameBorderSize = 0.0f; // Thickness of border around frames. Generally set to 0.0f or 1.0f. Other values not well tested.
|
|
ItemSpacing = ImVec2(8,4); // Horizontal and vertical spacing between widgets/lines
|
|
ItemInnerSpacing = ImVec2(4,4); // Horizontal and vertical spacing between within elements of a composed widget (e.g. a slider and its label)
|
|
TouchExtraPadding = ImVec2(0,0); // Expand reactive bounding box for touch-based system where touch position is not accurate enough. Unfortunately we don't sort widgets so priority on overlap will always be given to the first widget. So don't grow this too much!
|
|
IndentSpacing = 21.0f; // Horizontal spacing when e.g. entering a tree node. Generally == (FontSize + FramePadding.x*2).
|
|
ColumnsMinSpacing = 6.0f; // Minimum horizontal spacing between two columns
|
|
ScrollbarSize = 16.0f; // Width of the vertical scrollbar, Height of the horizontal scrollbar
|
|
ScrollbarRounding = 9.0f; // Radius of grab corners rounding for scrollbar
|
|
GrabMinSize = 10.0f; // Minimum width/height of a grab box for slider/scrollbar
|
|
GrabRounding = 0.0f; // Radius of grabs corners rounding. Set to 0.0f to have rectangular slider grabs.
|
|
ButtonTextAlign = ImVec2(0.5f,0.5f);// Alignment of button text when button is larger than text.
|
|
DisplayWindowPadding = ImVec2(22,22); // Window positions are clamped to be visible within the display area by at least this amount. Only covers regular windows.
|
|
DisplaySafeAreaPadding = ImVec2(4,4); // If you cannot see the edge of your screen (e.g. on a TV) increase the safe area padding. Covers popups/tooltips as well regular windows.
|
|
AntiAliasedLines = true; // Enable anti-aliasing on lines/borders. Disable if you are really short on CPU/GPU.
|
|
AntiAliasedShapes = true; // Enable anti-aliasing on filled shapes (rounded rectangles, circles, etc.)
|
|
CurveTessellationTol = 1.25f; // Tessellation tolerance. Decrease for highly tessellated curves (higher quality, more polygons), increase to reduce quality.
|
|
|
|
ImGui::StyleColorsClassic(this);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// To scale your entire UI (e.g. if you want your app to use High DPI or generally be DPI aware) you may use this helper function. Scaling the fonts is done separately and is up to you.
|
|
// Important: This operation is lossy because we round all sizes to integer. If you need to change your scale multiples, call this over a freshly initialized ImGuiStyle structure rather than scaling multiple times.
|
|
void ImGuiStyle::ScaleAllSizes(float scale_factor)
|
|
{
|
|
WindowPadding = ImFloor(WindowPadding * scale_factor);
|
|
WindowRounding = ImFloor(WindowRounding * scale_factor);
|
|
WindowMinSize = ImFloor(WindowMinSize * scale_factor);
|
|
ChildRounding = ImFloor(ChildRounding * scale_factor);
|
|
PopupRounding = ImFloor(PopupRounding * scale_factor);
|
|
FramePadding = ImFloor(FramePadding * scale_factor);
|
|
FrameRounding = ImFloor(FrameRounding * scale_factor);
|
|
ItemSpacing = ImFloor(ItemSpacing * scale_factor);
|
|
ItemInnerSpacing = ImFloor(ItemInnerSpacing * scale_factor);
|
|
TouchExtraPadding = ImFloor(TouchExtraPadding * scale_factor);
|
|
IndentSpacing = ImFloor(IndentSpacing * scale_factor);
|
|
ColumnsMinSpacing = ImFloor(ColumnsMinSpacing * scale_factor);
|
|
ScrollbarSize = ImFloor(ScrollbarSize * scale_factor);
|
|
ScrollbarRounding = ImFloor(ScrollbarRounding * scale_factor);
|
|
GrabMinSize = ImFloor(GrabMinSize * scale_factor);
|
|
GrabRounding = ImFloor(GrabRounding * scale_factor);
|
|
DisplayWindowPadding = ImFloor(DisplayWindowPadding * scale_factor);
|
|
DisplaySafeAreaPadding = ImFloor(DisplaySafeAreaPadding * scale_factor);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImGuiIO::ImGuiIO()
|
|
{
|
|
// Most fields are initialized with zero
|
|
memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this));
|
|
|
|
// Settings
|
|
DisplaySize = ImVec2(-1.0f, -1.0f);
|
|
DeltaTime = 1.0f/60.0f;
|
|
IniSavingRate = 5.0f;
|
|
IniFilename = "imgui.ini";
|
|
LogFilename = "imgui_log.txt";
|
|
MouseDoubleClickTime = 0.30f;
|
|
MouseDoubleClickMaxDist = 6.0f;
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < ImGuiKey_COUNT; i++)
|
|
KeyMap[i] = -1;
|
|
KeyRepeatDelay = 0.250f;
|
|
KeyRepeatRate = 0.050f;
|
|
UserData = NULL;
|
|
|
|
Fonts = &GImDefaultFontAtlas;
|
|
FontGlobalScale = 1.0f;
|
|
FontDefault = NULL;
|
|
FontAllowUserScaling = false;
|
|
DisplayFramebufferScale = ImVec2(1.0f, 1.0f);
|
|
DisplayVisibleMin = DisplayVisibleMax = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f);
|
|
|
|
// Advanced/subtle behaviors
|
|
#ifdef __APPLE__
|
|
OptMacOSXBehaviors = true; // Set Mac OS X style defaults based on __APPLE__ compile time flag
|
|
#else
|
|
OptMacOSXBehaviors = false;
|
|
#endif
|
|
OptCursorBlink = true;
|
|
|
|
// Settings (User Functions)
|
|
RenderDrawListsFn = NULL;
|
|
MemAllocFn = malloc;
|
|
MemFreeFn = free;
|
|
GetClipboardTextFn = GetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl; // Platform dependent default implementations
|
|
SetClipboardTextFn = SetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl;
|
|
ClipboardUserData = NULL;
|
|
ImeSetInputScreenPosFn = ImeSetInputScreenPosFn_DefaultImpl;
|
|
ImeWindowHandle = NULL;
|
|
|
|
// Input (NB: we already have memset zero the entire structure)
|
|
MousePos = ImVec2(-FLT_MAX, -FLT_MAX);
|
|
MousePosPrev = ImVec2(-FLT_MAX, -FLT_MAX);
|
|
MouseDragThreshold = 6.0f;
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(MouseDownDuration); i++) MouseDownDuration[i] = MouseDownDurationPrev[i] = -1.0f;
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(KeysDownDuration); i++) KeysDownDuration[i] = KeysDownDurationPrev[i] = -1.0f;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Pass in translated ASCII characters for text input.
|
|
// - with glfw you can get those from the callback set in glfwSetCharCallback()
|
|
// - on Windows you can get those using ToAscii+keyboard state, or via the WM_CHAR message
|
|
void ImGuiIO::AddInputCharacter(ImWchar c)
|
|
{
|
|
const int n = ImStrlenW(InputCharacters);
|
|
if (n + 1 < IM_ARRAYSIZE(InputCharacters))
|
|
{
|
|
InputCharacters[n] = c;
|
|
InputCharacters[n+1] = '\0';
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGuiIO::AddInputCharactersUTF8(const char* utf8_chars)
|
|
{
|
|
// We can't pass more wchars than ImGuiIO::InputCharacters[] can hold so don't convert more
|
|
const int wchars_buf_len = sizeof(ImGuiIO::InputCharacters) / sizeof(ImWchar);
|
|
ImWchar wchars[wchars_buf_len];
|
|
ImTextStrFromUtf8(wchars, wchars_buf_len, utf8_chars, NULL);
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < wchars_buf_len && wchars[i] != 0; i++)
|
|
AddInputCharacter(wchars[i]);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
// HELPERS
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
#define IM_F32_TO_INT8_UNBOUND(_VAL) ((int)((_VAL) * 255.0f + ((_VAL)>=0 ? 0.5f : -0.5f))) // Unsaturated, for display purpose
|
|
#define IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(_VAL) ((int)(ImSaturate(_VAL) * 255.0f + 0.5f)) // Saturated, always output 0..255
|
|
|
|
// Play it nice with Windows users. Notepad in 2015 still doesn't display text data with Unix-style \n.
|
|
#ifdef _WIN32
|
|
#define IM_NEWLINE "\r\n"
|
|
#else
|
|
#define IM_NEWLINE "\n"
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
ImVec2 ImLineClosestPoint(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& p)
|
|
{
|
|
ImVec2 ap = p - a;
|
|
ImVec2 ab_dir = b - a;
|
|
float ab_len = sqrtf(ab_dir.x * ab_dir.x + ab_dir.y * ab_dir.y);
|
|
ab_dir *= 1.0f / ab_len;
|
|
float dot = ap.x * ab_dir.x + ap.y * ab_dir.y;
|
|
if (dot < 0.0f)
|
|
return a;
|
|
if (dot > ab_len)
|
|
return b;
|
|
return a + ab_dir * dot;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImTriangleContainsPoint(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c, const ImVec2& p)
|
|
{
|
|
bool b1 = ((p.x - b.x) * (a.y - b.y) - (p.y - b.y) * (a.x - b.x)) < 0.0f;
|
|
bool b2 = ((p.x - c.x) * (b.y - c.y) - (p.y - c.y) * (b.x - c.x)) < 0.0f;
|
|
bool b3 = ((p.x - a.x) * (c.y - a.y) - (p.y - a.y) * (c.x - a.x)) < 0.0f;
|
|
return ((b1 == b2) && (b2 == b3));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImTriangleBarycentricCoords(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c, const ImVec2& p, float& out_u, float& out_v, float& out_w)
|
|
{
|
|
ImVec2 v0 = b - a;
|
|
ImVec2 v1 = c - a;
|
|
ImVec2 v2 = p - a;
|
|
const float denom = v0.x * v1.y - v1.x * v0.y;
|
|
out_v = (v2.x * v1.y - v1.x * v2.y) / denom;
|
|
out_w = (v0.x * v2.y - v2.x * v0.y) / denom;
|
|
out_u = 1.0f - out_v - out_w;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImVec2 ImTriangleClosestPoint(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c, const ImVec2& p)
|
|
{
|
|
ImVec2 proj_ab = ImLineClosestPoint(a, b, p);
|
|
ImVec2 proj_bc = ImLineClosestPoint(b, c, p);
|
|
ImVec2 proj_ca = ImLineClosestPoint(c, a, p);
|
|
float dist2_ab = ImLengthSqr(p - proj_ab);
|
|
float dist2_bc = ImLengthSqr(p - proj_bc);
|
|
float dist2_ca = ImLengthSqr(p - proj_ca);
|
|
float m = ImMin(dist2_ab, ImMin(dist2_bc, dist2_ca));
|
|
if (m == dist2_ab)
|
|
return proj_ab;
|
|
if (m == dist2_bc)
|
|
return proj_bc;
|
|
return proj_ca;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
int ImStricmp(const char* str1, const char* str2)
|
|
{
|
|
int d;
|
|
while ((d = toupper(*str2) - toupper(*str1)) == 0 && *str1) { str1++; str2++; }
|
|
return d;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
int ImStrnicmp(const char* str1, const char* str2, int count)
|
|
{
|
|
int d = 0;
|
|
while (count > 0 && (d = toupper(*str2) - toupper(*str1)) == 0 && *str1) { str1++; str2++; count--; }
|
|
return d;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImStrncpy(char* dst, const char* src, int count)
|
|
{
|
|
if (count < 1) return;
|
|
strncpy(dst, src, (size_t)count);
|
|
dst[count-1] = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
char* ImStrdup(const char *str)
|
|
{
|
|
size_t len = strlen(str) + 1;
|
|
void* buf = ImGui::MemAlloc(len);
|
|
return (char*)memcpy(buf, (const void*)str, len);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
char* ImStrchrRange(const char* str, const char* str_end, char c)
|
|
{
|
|
for ( ; str < str_end; str++)
|
|
if (*str == c)
|
|
return (char*)str;
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
int ImStrlenW(const ImWchar* str)
|
|
{
|
|
int n = 0;
|
|
while (*str++) n++;
|
|
return n;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const ImWchar* ImStrbolW(const ImWchar* buf_mid_line, const ImWchar* buf_begin) // find beginning-of-line
|
|
{
|
|
while (buf_mid_line > buf_begin && buf_mid_line[-1] != '\n')
|
|
buf_mid_line--;
|
|
return buf_mid_line;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const char* ImStristr(const char* haystack, const char* haystack_end, const char* needle, const char* needle_end)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!needle_end)
|
|
needle_end = needle + strlen(needle);
|
|
|
|
const char un0 = (char)toupper(*needle);
|
|
while ((!haystack_end && *haystack) || (haystack_end && haystack < haystack_end))
|
|
{
|
|
if (toupper(*haystack) == un0)
|
|
{
|
|
const char* b = needle + 1;
|
|
for (const char* a = haystack + 1; b < needle_end; a++, b++)
|
|
if (toupper(*a) != toupper(*b))
|
|
break;
|
|
if (b == needle_end)
|
|
return haystack;
|
|
}
|
|
haystack++;
|
|
}
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static const char* ImAtoi(const char* src, int* output)
|
|
{
|
|
int negative = 0;
|
|
if (*src == '-') { negative = 1; src++; }
|
|
if (*src == '+') { src++; }
|
|
int v = 0;
|
|
while (*src >= '0' && *src <= '9')
|
|
v = (v * 10) + (*src++ - '0');
|
|
*output = negative ? -v : v;
|
|
return src;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A) MSVC version appears to return -1 on overflow, whereas glibc appears to return total count (which may be >= buf_size).
|
|
// Ideally we would test for only one of those limits at runtime depending on the behavior the vsnprintf(), but trying to deduct it at compile time sounds like a pandora can of worm.
|
|
// B) When buf==NULL vsnprintf() will return the output size.
|
|
#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_FORMAT_STRING_FUNCTIONS
|
|
int ImFormatString(char* buf, int buf_size, const char* fmt, ...)
|
|
{
|
|
va_list args;
|
|
va_start(args, fmt);
|
|
int w = vsnprintf(buf, buf_size, fmt, args);
|
|
va_end(args);
|
|
if (buf == NULL)
|
|
return w;
|
|
if (w == -1 || w >= buf_size)
|
|
w = buf_size - 1;
|
|
buf[w] = 0;
|
|
return w;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
int ImFormatStringV(char* buf, int buf_size, const char* fmt, va_list args)
|
|
{
|
|
int w = vsnprintf(buf, buf_size, fmt, args);
|
|
if (buf == NULL)
|
|
return w;
|
|
if (w == -1 || w >= buf_size)
|
|
w = buf_size - 1;
|
|
buf[w] = 0;
|
|
return w;
|
|
}
|
|
#endif // #ifdef IMGUI_DISABLE_FORMAT_STRING_FUNCTIONS
|
|
|
|
// Pass data_size==0 for zero-terminated strings
|
|
// FIXME-OPT: Replace with e.g. FNV1a hash? CRC32 pretty much randomly access 1KB. Need to do proper measurements.
|
|
ImU32 ImHash(const void* data, int data_size, ImU32 seed)
|
|
{
|
|
static ImU32 crc32_lut[256] = { 0 };
|
|
if (!crc32_lut[1])
|
|
{
|
|
const ImU32 polynomial = 0xEDB88320;
|
|
for (ImU32 i = 0; i < 256; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
ImU32 crc = i;
|
|
for (ImU32 j = 0; j < 8; j++)
|
|
crc = (crc >> 1) ^ (ImU32(-int(crc & 1)) & polynomial);
|
|
crc32_lut[i] = crc;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
seed = ~seed;
|
|
ImU32 crc = seed;
|
|
const unsigned char* current = (const unsigned char*)data;
|
|
|
|
if (data_size > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
// Known size
|
|
while (data_size--)
|
|
crc = (crc >> 8) ^ crc32_lut[(crc & 0xFF) ^ *current++];
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// Zero-terminated string
|
|
while (unsigned char c = *current++)
|
|
{
|
|
// We support a syntax of "label###id" where only "###id" is included in the hash, and only "label" gets displayed.
|
|
// Because this syntax is rarely used we are optimizing for the common case.
|
|
// - If we reach ### in the string we discard the hash so far and reset to the seed.
|
|
// - We don't do 'current += 2; continue;' after handling ### to keep the code smaller.
|
|
if (c == '#' && current[0] == '#' && current[1] == '#')
|
|
crc = seed;
|
|
crc = (crc >> 8) ^ crc32_lut[(crc & 0xFF) ^ c];
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
return ~crc;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
// ImText* helpers
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// Convert UTF-8 to 32-bits character, process single character input.
|
|
// Based on stb_from_utf8() from github.com/nothings/stb/
|
|
// We handle UTF-8 decoding error by skipping forward.
|
|
int ImTextCharFromUtf8(unsigned int* out_char, const char* in_text, const char* in_text_end)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int c = (unsigned int)-1;
|
|
const unsigned char* str = (const unsigned char*)in_text;
|
|
if (!(*str & 0x80))
|
|
{
|
|
c = (unsigned int)(*str++);
|
|
*out_char = c;
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
if ((*str & 0xe0) == 0xc0)
|
|
{
|
|
*out_char = 0xFFFD; // will be invalid but not end of string
|
|
if (in_text_end && in_text_end - (const char*)str < 2) return 1;
|
|
if (*str < 0xc2) return 2;
|
|
c = (unsigned int)((*str++ & 0x1f) << 6);
|
|
if ((*str & 0xc0) != 0x80) return 2;
|
|
c += (*str++ & 0x3f);
|
|
*out_char = c;
|
|
return 2;
|
|
}
|
|
if ((*str & 0xf0) == 0xe0)
|
|
{
|
|
*out_char = 0xFFFD; // will be invalid but not end of string
|
|
if (in_text_end && in_text_end - (const char*)str < 3) return 1;
|
|
if (*str == 0xe0 && (str[1] < 0xa0 || str[1] > 0xbf)) return 3;
|
|
if (*str == 0xed && str[1] > 0x9f) return 3; // str[1] < 0x80 is checked below
|
|
c = (unsigned int)((*str++ & 0x0f) << 12);
|
|
if ((*str & 0xc0) != 0x80) return 3;
|
|
c += (unsigned int)((*str++ & 0x3f) << 6);
|
|
if ((*str & 0xc0) != 0x80) return 3;
|
|
c += (*str++ & 0x3f);
|
|
*out_char = c;
|
|
return 3;
|
|
}
|
|
if ((*str & 0xf8) == 0xf0)
|
|
{
|
|
*out_char = 0xFFFD; // will be invalid but not end of string
|
|
if (in_text_end && in_text_end - (const char*)str < 4) return 1;
|
|
if (*str > 0xf4) return 4;
|
|
if (*str == 0xf0 && (str[1] < 0x90 || str[1] > 0xbf)) return 4;
|
|
if (*str == 0xf4 && str[1] > 0x8f) return 4; // str[1] < 0x80 is checked below
|
|
c = (unsigned int)((*str++ & 0x07) << 18);
|
|
if ((*str & 0xc0) != 0x80) return 4;
|
|
c += (unsigned int)((*str++ & 0x3f) << 12);
|
|
if ((*str & 0xc0) != 0x80) return 4;
|
|
c += (unsigned int)((*str++ & 0x3f) << 6);
|
|
if ((*str & 0xc0) != 0x80) return 4;
|
|
c += (*str++ & 0x3f);
|
|
// utf-8 encodings of values used in surrogate pairs are invalid
|
|
if ((c & 0xFFFFF800) == 0xD800) return 4;
|
|
*out_char = c;
|
|
return 4;
|
|
}
|
|
*out_char = 0;
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
int ImTextStrFromUtf8(ImWchar* buf, int buf_size, const char* in_text, const char* in_text_end, const char** in_text_remaining)
|
|
{
|
|
ImWchar* buf_out = buf;
|
|
ImWchar* buf_end = buf + buf_size;
|
|
while (buf_out < buf_end-1 && (!in_text_end || in_text < in_text_end) && *in_text)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int c;
|
|
in_text += ImTextCharFromUtf8(&c, in_text, in_text_end);
|
|
if (c == 0)
|
|
break;
|
|
if (c < 0x10000) // FIXME: Losing characters that don't fit in 2 bytes
|
|
*buf_out++ = (ImWchar)c;
|
|
}
|
|
*buf_out = 0;
|
|
if (in_text_remaining)
|
|
*in_text_remaining = in_text;
|
|
return (int)(buf_out - buf);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
int ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8(const char* in_text, const char* in_text_end)
|
|
{
|
|
int char_count = 0;
|
|
while ((!in_text_end || in_text < in_text_end) && *in_text)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int c;
|
|
in_text += ImTextCharFromUtf8(&c, in_text, in_text_end);
|
|
if (c == 0)
|
|
break;
|
|
if (c < 0x10000)
|
|
char_count++;
|
|
}
|
|
return char_count;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Based on stb_to_utf8() from github.com/nothings/stb/
|
|
static inline int ImTextCharToUtf8(char* buf, int buf_size, unsigned int c)
|
|
{
|
|
if (c < 0x80)
|
|
{
|
|
buf[0] = (char)c;
|
|
return 1;
|
|
}
|
|
if (c < 0x800)
|
|
{
|
|
if (buf_size < 2) return 0;
|
|
buf[0] = (char)(0xc0 + (c >> 6));
|
|
buf[1] = (char)(0x80 + (c & 0x3f));
|
|
return 2;
|
|
}
|
|
if (c >= 0xdc00 && c < 0xe000)
|
|
{
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
if (c >= 0xd800 && c < 0xdc00)
|
|
{
|
|
if (buf_size < 4) return 0;
|
|
buf[0] = (char)(0xf0 + (c >> 18));
|
|
buf[1] = (char)(0x80 + ((c >> 12) & 0x3f));
|
|
buf[2] = (char)(0x80 + ((c >> 6) & 0x3f));
|
|
buf[3] = (char)(0x80 + ((c ) & 0x3f));
|
|
return 4;
|
|
}
|
|
//else if (c < 0x10000)
|
|
{
|
|
if (buf_size < 3) return 0;
|
|
buf[0] = (char)(0xe0 + (c >> 12));
|
|
buf[1] = (char)(0x80 + ((c>> 6) & 0x3f));
|
|
buf[2] = (char)(0x80 + ((c ) & 0x3f));
|
|
return 3;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static inline int ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromChar(unsigned int c)
|
|
{
|
|
if (c < 0x80) return 1;
|
|
if (c < 0x800) return 2;
|
|
if (c >= 0xdc00 && c < 0xe000) return 0;
|
|
if (c >= 0xd800 && c < 0xdc00) return 4;
|
|
return 3;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
int ImTextStrToUtf8(char* buf, int buf_size, const ImWchar* in_text, const ImWchar* in_text_end)
|
|
{
|
|
char* buf_out = buf;
|
|
const char* buf_end = buf + buf_size;
|
|
while (buf_out < buf_end-1 && (!in_text_end || in_text < in_text_end) && *in_text)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int c = (unsigned int)(*in_text++);
|
|
if (c < 0x80)
|
|
*buf_out++ = (char)c;
|
|
else
|
|
buf_out += ImTextCharToUtf8(buf_out, (int)(buf_end-buf_out-1), c);
|
|
}
|
|
*buf_out = 0;
|
|
return (int)(buf_out - buf);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
int ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(const ImWchar* in_text, const ImWchar* in_text_end)
|
|
{
|
|
int bytes_count = 0;
|
|
while ((!in_text_end || in_text < in_text_end) && *in_text)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int c = (unsigned int)(*in_text++);
|
|
if (c < 0x80)
|
|
bytes_count++;
|
|
else
|
|
bytes_count += ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromChar(c);
|
|
}
|
|
return bytes_count;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImVec4 ImGui::ColorConvertU32ToFloat4(ImU32 in)
|
|
{
|
|
float s = 1.0f/255.0f;
|
|
return ImVec4(
|
|
((in >> IM_COL32_R_SHIFT) & 0xFF) * s,
|
|
((in >> IM_COL32_G_SHIFT) & 0xFF) * s,
|
|
((in >> IM_COL32_B_SHIFT) & 0xFF) * s,
|
|
((in >> IM_COL32_A_SHIFT) & 0xFF) * s);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImU32 ImGui::ColorConvertFloat4ToU32(const ImVec4& in)
|
|
{
|
|
ImU32 out;
|
|
out = ((ImU32)IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(in.x)) << IM_COL32_R_SHIFT;
|
|
out |= ((ImU32)IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(in.y)) << IM_COL32_G_SHIFT;
|
|
out |= ((ImU32)IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(in.z)) << IM_COL32_B_SHIFT;
|
|
out |= ((ImU32)IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(in.w)) << IM_COL32_A_SHIFT;
|
|
return out;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImU32 ImGui::GetColorU32(ImGuiCol idx, float alpha_mul)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiStyle& style = GImGui->Style;
|
|
ImVec4 c = style.Colors[idx];
|
|
c.w *= style.Alpha * alpha_mul;
|
|
return ColorConvertFloat4ToU32(c);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImU32 ImGui::GetColorU32(const ImVec4& col)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiStyle& style = GImGui->Style;
|
|
ImVec4 c = col;
|
|
c.w *= style.Alpha;
|
|
return ColorConvertFloat4ToU32(c);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const ImVec4& ImGui::GetStyleColorVec4(ImGuiCol idx)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiStyle& style = GImGui->Style;
|
|
return style.Colors[idx];
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImU32 ImGui::GetColorU32(ImU32 col)
|
|
{
|
|
float style_alpha = GImGui->Style.Alpha;
|
|
if (style_alpha >= 1.0f)
|
|
return col;
|
|
int a = (col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) >> IM_COL32_A_SHIFT;
|
|
a = (int)(a * style_alpha); // We don't need to clamp 0..255 because Style.Alpha is in 0..1 range.
|
|
return (col & ~IM_COL32_A_MASK) | (a << IM_COL32_A_SHIFT);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Convert rgb floats ([0-1],[0-1],[0-1]) to hsv floats ([0-1],[0-1],[0-1]), from Foley & van Dam p592
|
|
// Optimized http://lolengine.net/blog/2013/01/13/fast-rgb-to-hsv
|
|
void ImGui::ColorConvertRGBtoHSV(float r, float g, float b, float& out_h, float& out_s, float& out_v)
|
|
{
|
|
float K = 0.f;
|
|
if (g < b)
|
|
{
|
|
ImSwap(g, b);
|
|
K = -1.f;
|
|
}
|
|
if (r < g)
|
|
{
|
|
ImSwap(r, g);
|
|
K = -2.f / 6.f - K;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const float chroma = r - (g < b ? g : b);
|
|
out_h = fabsf(K + (g - b) / (6.f * chroma + 1e-20f));
|
|
out_s = chroma / (r + 1e-20f);
|
|
out_v = r;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Convert hsv floats ([0-1],[0-1],[0-1]) to rgb floats ([0-1],[0-1],[0-1]), from Foley & van Dam p593
|
|
// also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/HSL_and_HSV
|
|
void ImGui::ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(float h, float s, float v, float& out_r, float& out_g, float& out_b)
|
|
{
|
|
if (s == 0.0f)
|
|
{
|
|
// gray
|
|
out_r = out_g = out_b = v;
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
h = fmodf(h, 1.0f) / (60.0f/360.0f);
|
|
int i = (int)h;
|
|
float f = h - (float)i;
|
|
float p = v * (1.0f - s);
|
|
float q = v * (1.0f - s * f);
|
|
float t = v * (1.0f - s * (1.0f - f));
|
|
|
|
switch (i)
|
|
{
|
|
case 0: out_r = v; out_g = t; out_b = p; break;
|
|
case 1: out_r = q; out_g = v; out_b = p; break;
|
|
case 2: out_r = p; out_g = v; out_b = t; break;
|
|
case 3: out_r = p; out_g = q; out_b = v; break;
|
|
case 4: out_r = t; out_g = p; out_b = v; break;
|
|
case 5: default: out_r = v; out_g = p; out_b = q; break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
FILE* ImFileOpen(const char* filename, const char* mode)
|
|
{
|
|
#if defined(_WIN32) && !defined(__CYGWIN__)
|
|
// We need a fopen() wrapper because MSVC/Windows fopen doesn't handle UTF-8 filenames. Converting both strings from UTF-8 to wchar format (using a single allocation, because we can)
|
|
const int filename_wsize = ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8(filename, NULL) + 1;
|
|
const int mode_wsize = ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8(mode, NULL) + 1;
|
|
ImVector<ImWchar> buf;
|
|
buf.resize(filename_wsize + mode_wsize);
|
|
ImTextStrFromUtf8(&buf[0], filename_wsize, filename, NULL);
|
|
ImTextStrFromUtf8(&buf[filename_wsize], mode_wsize, mode, NULL);
|
|
return _wfopen((wchar_t*)&buf[0], (wchar_t*)&buf[filename_wsize]);
|
|
#else
|
|
return fopen(filename, mode);
|
|
#endif
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Load file content into memory
|
|
// Memory allocated with ImGui::MemAlloc(), must be freed by user using ImGui::MemFree()
|
|
void* ImFileLoadToMemory(const char* filename, const char* file_open_mode, int* out_file_size, int padding_bytes)
|
|
{
|
|
IM_ASSERT(filename && file_open_mode);
|
|
if (out_file_size)
|
|
*out_file_size = 0;
|
|
|
|
FILE* f;
|
|
if ((f = ImFileOpen(filename, file_open_mode)) == NULL)
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
|
|
long file_size_signed;
|
|
if (fseek(f, 0, SEEK_END) || (file_size_signed = ftell(f)) == -1 || fseek(f, 0, SEEK_SET))
|
|
{
|
|
fclose(f);
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
int file_size = (int)file_size_signed;
|
|
void* file_data = ImGui::MemAlloc(file_size + padding_bytes);
|
|
if (file_data == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
fclose(f);
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
if (fread(file_data, 1, (size_t)file_size, f) != (size_t)file_size)
|
|
{
|
|
fclose(f);
|
|
ImGui::MemFree(file_data);
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
if (padding_bytes > 0)
|
|
memset((void *)(((char*)file_data) + file_size), 0, padding_bytes);
|
|
|
|
fclose(f);
|
|
if (out_file_size)
|
|
*out_file_size = file_size;
|
|
|
|
return file_data;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
// ImGuiStorage
|
|
// Helper: Key->value storage
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// std::lower_bound but without the bullshit
|
|
static ImVector<ImGuiStorage::Pair>::iterator LowerBound(ImVector<ImGuiStorage::Pair>& data, ImGuiID key)
|
|
{
|
|
ImVector<ImGuiStorage::Pair>::iterator first = data.begin();
|
|
ImVector<ImGuiStorage::Pair>::iterator last = data.end();
|
|
size_t count = (size_t)(last - first);
|
|
while (count > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
size_t count2 = count >> 1;
|
|
ImVector<ImGuiStorage::Pair>::iterator mid = first + count2;
|
|
if (mid->key < key)
|
|
{
|
|
first = ++mid;
|
|
count -= count2 + 1;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
count = count2;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
return first;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// For quicker full rebuild of a storage (instead of an incremental one), you may add all your contents and then sort once.
|
|
void ImGuiStorage::BuildSortByKey()
|
|
{
|
|
struct StaticFunc
|
|
{
|
|
static int PairCompareByID(const void* lhs, const void* rhs)
|
|
{
|
|
// We can't just do a subtraction because qsort uses signed integers and subtracting our ID doesn't play well with that.
|
|
if (((const Pair*)lhs)->key > ((const Pair*)rhs)->key) return +1;
|
|
if (((const Pair*)lhs)->key < ((const Pair*)rhs)->key) return -1;
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
};
|
|
if (Data.Size > 1)
|
|
qsort(Data.Data, (size_t)Data.Size, sizeof(Pair), StaticFunc::PairCompareByID);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
int ImGuiStorage::GetInt(ImGuiID key, int default_val) const
|
|
{
|
|
ImVector<Pair>::iterator it = LowerBound(const_cast<ImVector<ImGuiStorage::Pair>&>(Data), key);
|
|
if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key)
|
|
return default_val;
|
|
return it->val_i;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGuiStorage::GetBool(ImGuiID key, bool default_val) const
|
|
{
|
|
return GetInt(key, default_val ? 1 : 0) != 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
float ImGuiStorage::GetFloat(ImGuiID key, float default_val) const
|
|
{
|
|
ImVector<Pair>::iterator it = LowerBound(const_cast<ImVector<ImGuiStorage::Pair>&>(Data), key);
|
|
if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key)
|
|
return default_val;
|
|
return it->val_f;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void* ImGuiStorage::GetVoidPtr(ImGuiID key) const
|
|
{
|
|
ImVector<Pair>::iterator it = LowerBound(const_cast<ImVector<ImGuiStorage::Pair>&>(Data), key);
|
|
if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key)
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
return it->val_p;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// References are only valid until a new value is added to the storage. Calling a Set***() function or a Get***Ref() function invalidates the pointer.
|
|
int* ImGuiStorage::GetIntRef(ImGuiID key, int default_val)
|
|
{
|
|
ImVector<Pair>::iterator it = LowerBound(Data, key);
|
|
if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key)
|
|
it = Data.insert(it, Pair(key, default_val));
|
|
return &it->val_i;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool* ImGuiStorage::GetBoolRef(ImGuiID key, bool default_val)
|
|
{
|
|
return (bool*)GetIntRef(key, default_val ? 1 : 0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
float* ImGuiStorage::GetFloatRef(ImGuiID key, float default_val)
|
|
{
|
|
ImVector<Pair>::iterator it = LowerBound(Data, key);
|
|
if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key)
|
|
it = Data.insert(it, Pair(key, default_val));
|
|
return &it->val_f;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void** ImGuiStorage::GetVoidPtrRef(ImGuiID key, void* default_val)
|
|
{
|
|
ImVector<Pair>::iterator it = LowerBound(Data, key);
|
|
if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key)
|
|
it = Data.insert(it, Pair(key, default_val));
|
|
return &it->val_p;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// FIXME-OPT: Need a way to reuse the result of lower_bound when doing GetInt()/SetInt() - not too bad because it only happens on explicit interaction (maximum one a frame)
|
|
void ImGuiStorage::SetInt(ImGuiID key, int val)
|
|
{
|
|
ImVector<Pair>::iterator it = LowerBound(Data, key);
|
|
if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key)
|
|
{
|
|
Data.insert(it, Pair(key, val));
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
it->val_i = val;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGuiStorage::SetBool(ImGuiID key, bool val)
|
|
{
|
|
SetInt(key, val ? 1 : 0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGuiStorage::SetFloat(ImGuiID key, float val)
|
|
{
|
|
ImVector<Pair>::iterator it = LowerBound(Data, key);
|
|
if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key)
|
|
{
|
|
Data.insert(it, Pair(key, val));
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
it->val_f = val;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGuiStorage::SetVoidPtr(ImGuiID key, void* val)
|
|
{
|
|
ImVector<Pair>::iterator it = LowerBound(Data, key);
|
|
if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key)
|
|
{
|
|
Data.insert(it, Pair(key, val));
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
it->val_p = val;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGuiStorage::SetAllInt(int v)
|
|
{
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < Data.Size; i++)
|
|
Data[i].val_i = v;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
// ImGuiTextFilter
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// Helper: Parse and apply text filters. In format "aaaaa[,bbbb][,ccccc]"
|
|
ImGuiTextFilter::ImGuiTextFilter(const char* default_filter)
|
|
{
|
|
if (default_filter)
|
|
{
|
|
ImStrncpy(InputBuf, default_filter, IM_ARRAYSIZE(InputBuf));
|
|
Build();
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
InputBuf[0] = 0;
|
|
CountGrep = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGuiTextFilter::Draw(const char* label, float width)
|
|
{
|
|
if (width != 0.0f)
|
|
ImGui::PushItemWidth(width);
|
|
bool value_changed = ImGui::InputText(label, InputBuf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(InputBuf));
|
|
if (width != 0.0f)
|
|
ImGui::PopItemWidth();
|
|
if (value_changed)
|
|
Build();
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGuiTextFilter::TextRange::split(char separator, ImVector<TextRange>& out)
|
|
{
|
|
out.resize(0);
|
|
const char* wb = b;
|
|
const char* we = wb;
|
|
while (we < e)
|
|
{
|
|
if (*we == separator)
|
|
{
|
|
out.push_back(TextRange(wb, we));
|
|
wb = we + 1;
|
|
}
|
|
we++;
|
|
}
|
|
if (wb != we)
|
|
out.push_back(TextRange(wb, we));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGuiTextFilter::Build()
|
|
{
|
|
Filters.resize(0);
|
|
TextRange input_range(InputBuf, InputBuf+strlen(InputBuf));
|
|
input_range.split(',', Filters);
|
|
|
|
CountGrep = 0;
|
|
for (int i = 0; i != Filters.Size; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
Filters[i].trim_blanks();
|
|
if (Filters[i].empty())
|
|
continue;
|
|
if (Filters[i].front() != '-')
|
|
CountGrep += 1;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGuiTextFilter::PassFilter(const char* text, const char* text_end) const
|
|
{
|
|
if (Filters.empty())
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
if (text == NULL)
|
|
text = "";
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i != Filters.Size; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
const TextRange& f = Filters[i];
|
|
if (f.empty())
|
|
continue;
|
|
if (f.front() == '-')
|
|
{
|
|
// Subtract
|
|
if (ImStristr(text, text_end, f.begin()+1, f.end()) != NULL)
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// Grep
|
|
if (ImStristr(text, text_end, f.begin(), f.end()) != NULL)
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Implicit * grep
|
|
if (CountGrep == 0)
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
// ImGuiTextBuffer
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// On some platform vsnprintf() takes va_list by reference and modifies it.
|
|
// va_copy is the 'correct' way to copy a va_list but Visual Studio prior to 2013 doesn't have it.
|
|
#ifndef va_copy
|
|
#define va_copy(dest, src) (dest = src)
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
// Helper: Text buffer for logging/accumulating text
|
|
void ImGuiTextBuffer::appendfv(const char* fmt, va_list args)
|
|
{
|
|
va_list args_copy;
|
|
va_copy(args_copy, args);
|
|
|
|
int len = ImFormatStringV(NULL, 0, fmt, args); // FIXME-OPT: could do a first pass write attempt, likely successful on first pass.
|
|
if (len <= 0)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
const int write_off = Buf.Size;
|
|
const int needed_sz = write_off + len;
|
|
if (write_off + len >= Buf.Capacity)
|
|
{
|
|
int double_capacity = Buf.Capacity * 2;
|
|
Buf.reserve(needed_sz > double_capacity ? needed_sz : double_capacity);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Buf.resize(needed_sz);
|
|
ImFormatStringV(&Buf[write_off - 1], len + 1, fmt, args_copy);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGuiTextBuffer::appendf(const char* fmt, ...)
|
|
{
|
|
va_list args;
|
|
va_start(args, fmt);
|
|
appendfv(fmt, args);
|
|
va_end(args);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
// ImGuiSimpleColumns (internal use only)
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
ImGuiSimpleColumns::ImGuiSimpleColumns()
|
|
{
|
|
Count = 0;
|
|
Spacing = Width = NextWidth = 0.0f;
|
|
memset(Pos, 0, sizeof(Pos));
|
|
memset(NextWidths, 0, sizeof(NextWidths));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGuiSimpleColumns::Update(int count, float spacing, bool clear)
|
|
{
|
|
IM_ASSERT(Count <= IM_ARRAYSIZE(Pos));
|
|
Count = count;
|
|
Width = NextWidth = 0.0f;
|
|
Spacing = spacing;
|
|
if (clear) memset(NextWidths, 0, sizeof(NextWidths));
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < Count; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
if (i > 0 && NextWidths[i] > 0.0f)
|
|
Width += Spacing;
|
|
Pos[i] = (float)(int)Width;
|
|
Width += NextWidths[i];
|
|
NextWidths[i] = 0.0f;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
float ImGuiSimpleColumns::DeclColumns(float w0, float w1, float w2) // not using va_arg because they promote float to double
|
|
{
|
|
NextWidth = 0.0f;
|
|
NextWidths[0] = ImMax(NextWidths[0], w0);
|
|
NextWidths[1] = ImMax(NextWidths[1], w1);
|
|
NextWidths[2] = ImMax(NextWidths[2], w2);
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < 3; i++)
|
|
NextWidth += NextWidths[i] + ((i > 0 && NextWidths[i] > 0.0f) ? Spacing : 0.0f);
|
|
return ImMax(Width, NextWidth);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
float ImGuiSimpleColumns::CalcExtraSpace(float avail_w)
|
|
{
|
|
return ImMax(0.0f, avail_w - Width);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
// ImGuiListClipper
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
static void SetCursorPosYAndSetupDummyPrevLine(float pos_y, float line_height)
|
|
{
|
|
// Set cursor position and a few other things so that SetScrollHere() and Columns() can work when seeking cursor.
|
|
// FIXME: It is problematic that we have to do that here, because custom/equivalent end-user code would stumble on the same issue. Consider moving within SetCursorXXX functions?
|
|
ImGui::SetCursorPosY(pos_y);
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = ImGui::GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine.y = window->DC.CursorPos.y - line_height; // Setting those fields so that SetScrollHere() can properly function after the end of our clipper usage.
|
|
window->DC.PrevLineHeight = (line_height - GImGui->Style.ItemSpacing.y); // If we end up needing more accurate data (to e.g. use SameLine) we may as well make the clipper have a fourth step to let user process and display the last item in their list.
|
|
if (window->DC.ColumnsCount > 1)
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsCellMinY = window->DC.CursorPos.y; // Setting this so that cell Y position are set properly
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Use case A: Begin() called from constructor with items_height<0, then called again from Sync() in StepNo 1
|
|
// Use case B: Begin() called from constructor with items_height>0
|
|
// FIXME-LEGACY: Ideally we should remove the Begin/End functions but they are part of the legacy API we still support. This is why some of the code in Step() calling Begin() and reassign some fields, spaghetti style.
|
|
void ImGuiListClipper::Begin(int count, float items_height)
|
|
{
|
|
StartPosY = ImGui::GetCursorPosY();
|
|
ItemsHeight = items_height;
|
|
ItemsCount = count;
|
|
StepNo = 0;
|
|
DisplayEnd = DisplayStart = -1;
|
|
if (ItemsHeight > 0.0f)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGui::CalcListClipping(ItemsCount, ItemsHeight, &DisplayStart, &DisplayEnd); // calculate how many to clip/display
|
|
if (DisplayStart > 0)
|
|
SetCursorPosYAndSetupDummyPrevLine(StartPosY + DisplayStart * ItemsHeight, ItemsHeight); // advance cursor
|
|
StepNo = 2;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGuiListClipper::End()
|
|
{
|
|
if (ItemsCount < 0)
|
|
return;
|
|
// In theory here we should assert that ImGui::GetCursorPosY() == StartPosY + DisplayEnd * ItemsHeight, but it feels saner to just seek at the end and not assert/crash the user.
|
|
if (ItemsCount < INT_MAX)
|
|
SetCursorPosYAndSetupDummyPrevLine(StartPosY + ItemsCount * ItemsHeight, ItemsHeight); // advance cursor
|
|
ItemsCount = -1;
|
|
StepNo = 3;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGuiListClipper::Step()
|
|
{
|
|
if (ItemsCount == 0 || ImGui::GetCurrentWindowRead()->SkipItems)
|
|
{
|
|
ItemsCount = -1;
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
if (StepNo == 0) // Step 0: the clipper let you process the first element, regardless of it being visible or not, so we can measure the element height.
|
|
{
|
|
DisplayStart = 0;
|
|
DisplayEnd = 1;
|
|
StartPosY = ImGui::GetCursorPosY();
|
|
StepNo = 1;
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
if (StepNo == 1) // Step 1: the clipper infer height from first element, calculate the actual range of elements to display, and position the cursor before the first element.
|
|
{
|
|
if (ItemsCount == 1) { ItemsCount = -1; return false; }
|
|
float items_height = ImGui::GetCursorPosY() - StartPosY;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(items_height > 0.0f); // If this triggers, it means Item 0 hasn't moved the cursor vertically
|
|
Begin(ItemsCount-1, items_height);
|
|
DisplayStart++;
|
|
DisplayEnd++;
|
|
StepNo = 3;
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
if (StepNo == 2) // Step 2: dummy step only required if an explicit items_height was passed to constructor or Begin() and user still call Step(). Does nothing and switch to Step 3.
|
|
{
|
|
IM_ASSERT(DisplayStart >= 0 && DisplayEnd >= 0);
|
|
StepNo = 3;
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
if (StepNo == 3) // Step 3: the clipper validate that we have reached the expected Y position (corresponding to element DisplayEnd), advance the cursor to the end of the list and then returns 'false' to end the loop.
|
|
End();
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
// ImGuiWindow
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
ImGuiWindow::ImGuiWindow(const char* name)
|
|
{
|
|
Name = ImStrdup(name);
|
|
ID = ImHash(name, 0);
|
|
IDStack.push_back(ID);
|
|
Flags = 0;
|
|
OrderWithinParent = 0;
|
|
PosFloat = Pos = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f);
|
|
Size = SizeFull = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f);
|
|
SizeContents = SizeContentsExplicit = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f);
|
|
WindowPadding = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f);
|
|
WindowRounding = 0.0f;
|
|
WindowBorderSize = 0.0f;
|
|
MoveId = GetID("#MOVE");
|
|
Scroll = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f);
|
|
ScrollTarget = ImVec2(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX);
|
|
ScrollTargetCenterRatio = ImVec2(0.5f, 0.5f);
|
|
ScrollbarX = ScrollbarY = false;
|
|
ScrollbarSizes = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f);
|
|
Active = WasActive = false;
|
|
WriteAccessed = false;
|
|
Collapsed = false;
|
|
SkipItems = false;
|
|
Appearing = false;
|
|
CloseButton = false;
|
|
BeginCount = 0;
|
|
PopupId = 0;
|
|
AutoFitFramesX = AutoFitFramesY = -1;
|
|
AutoFitOnlyGrows = false;
|
|
AutoFitChildAxises = 0x00;
|
|
AutoPosLastDirection = ImGuiDir_None;
|
|
HiddenFrames = 0;
|
|
SetWindowPosAllowFlags = SetWindowSizeAllowFlags = SetWindowCollapsedAllowFlags = ImGuiCond_Always | ImGuiCond_Once | ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver | ImGuiCond_Appearing;
|
|
SetWindowPosVal = SetWindowPosPivot = ImVec2(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX);
|
|
|
|
LastFrameActive = -1;
|
|
ItemWidthDefault = 0.0f;
|
|
FontWindowScale = 1.0f;
|
|
|
|
DrawList = (ImDrawList*)ImGui::MemAlloc(sizeof(ImDrawList));
|
|
IM_PLACEMENT_NEW(DrawList) ImDrawList();
|
|
DrawList->_OwnerName = Name;
|
|
ParentWindow = NULL;
|
|
RootWindow = NULL;
|
|
RootNonPopupWindow = NULL;
|
|
|
|
FocusIdxAllCounter = FocusIdxTabCounter = -1;
|
|
FocusIdxAllRequestCurrent = FocusIdxTabRequestCurrent = INT_MAX;
|
|
FocusIdxAllRequestNext = FocusIdxTabRequestNext = INT_MAX;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImGuiWindow::~ImGuiWindow()
|
|
{
|
|
DrawList->~ImDrawList();
|
|
ImGui::MemFree(DrawList);
|
|
DrawList = NULL;
|
|
ImGui::MemFree(Name);
|
|
Name = NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImGuiID ImGuiWindow::GetID(const char* str, const char* str_end)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiID seed = IDStack.back();
|
|
ImGuiID id = ImHash(str, str_end ? (int)(str_end - str) : 0, seed);
|
|
ImGui::KeepAliveID(id);
|
|
return id;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImGuiID ImGuiWindow::GetID(const void* ptr)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiID seed = IDStack.back();
|
|
ImGuiID id = ImHash(&ptr, sizeof(void*), seed);
|
|
ImGui::KeepAliveID(id);
|
|
return id;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImGuiID ImGuiWindow::GetIDNoKeepAlive(const char* str, const char* str_end)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiID seed = IDStack.back();
|
|
return ImHash(str, str_end ? (int)(str_end - str) : 0, seed);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
// Internal API exposed in imgui_internal.h
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
static void SetCurrentWindow(ImGuiWindow* window)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
g.CurrentWindow = window;
|
|
if (window)
|
|
g.FontSize = window->CalcFontSize();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImGuiWindow* ImGui::GetParentWindow()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(g.CurrentWindowStack.Size >= 2);
|
|
return g.CurrentWindowStack[(unsigned int)g.CurrentWindowStack.Size - 2];
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetActiveID(ImGuiID id, ImGuiWindow* window)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated = (g.ActiveId != id);
|
|
if (g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated)
|
|
g.ActiveIdTimer = 0.0f;
|
|
g.ActiveId = id;
|
|
g.ActiveIdAllowOverlap = false;
|
|
g.ActiveIdIsAlive |= (id != 0);
|
|
g.ActiveIdWindow = window;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::ClearActiveID()
|
|
{
|
|
SetActiveID(0, NULL);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetHoveredID(ImGuiID id)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
g.HoveredId = id;
|
|
g.HoveredIdAllowOverlap = false;
|
|
g.HoveredIdTimer = (id != 0 && g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame == id) ? (g.HoveredIdTimer + g.IO.DeltaTime) : 0.0f;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::KeepAliveID(ImGuiID id)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (g.ActiveId == id)
|
|
g.ActiveIdIsAlive = true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static inline bool IsWindowContentHoverable(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiHoveredFlags flags)
|
|
{
|
|
// An active popup disable hovering on other windows (apart from its own children)
|
|
// FIXME-OPT: This could be cached/stored within the window.
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (g.NavWindow)
|
|
if (ImGuiWindow* focused_root_window = g.NavWindow->RootWindow)
|
|
if (focused_root_window->WasActive && focused_root_window != window->RootWindow)
|
|
{
|
|
// For the purpose of those flags we differentiate "standard popup" from "modal popup"
|
|
// NB: The order of those two tests is important because Modal windows are also Popups.
|
|
if (focused_root_window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal)
|
|
return false;
|
|
if ((focused_root_window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) && !(flags & ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByPopup))
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Advance cursor given item size for layout.
|
|
void ImGui::ItemSize(const ImVec2& size, float text_offset_y)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
// Always align ourselves on pixel boundaries
|
|
const float line_height = ImMax(window->DC.CurrentLineHeight, size.y);
|
|
const float text_base_offset = ImMax(window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset, text_offset_y);
|
|
//if (g.IO.KeyAlt) window->DrawList->AddRect(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(size.x, line_height), IM_COL32(255,0,0,200)); // [DEBUG]
|
|
window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine = ImVec2(window->DC.CursorPos.x + size.x, window->DC.CursorPos.y);
|
|
window->DC.CursorPos = ImVec2((float)(int)(window->Pos.x + window->DC.IndentX + window->DC.ColumnsOffsetX), (float)(int)(window->DC.CursorPos.y + line_height + g.Style.ItemSpacing.y));
|
|
window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x = ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x, window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine.x);
|
|
window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y = ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y, window->DC.CursorPos.y - g.Style.ItemSpacing.y);
|
|
//if (g.IO.KeyAlt) window->DrawList->AddCircle(window->DC.CursorMaxPos, 3.0f, IM_COL32(255,0,0,255), 4); // [DEBUG]
|
|
|
|
window->DC.PrevLineHeight = line_height;
|
|
window->DC.PrevLineTextBaseOffset = text_base_offset;
|
|
window->DC.CurrentLineHeight = window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset = 0.0f;
|
|
|
|
// Horizontal layout mode
|
|
if (window->DC.LayoutType == ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal)
|
|
SameLine();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::ItemSize(const ImRect& bb, float text_offset_y)
|
|
{
|
|
ItemSize(bb.GetSize(), text_offset_y);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Declare item bounding box for clipping and interaction.
|
|
// Note that the size can be different than the one provided to ItemSize(). Typically, widgets that spread over available surface
|
|
// declares their minimum size requirement to ItemSize() and then use a larger region for drawing/interaction, which is passed to ItemAdd().
|
|
bool ImGui::ItemAdd(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
const bool is_clipped = IsClippedEx(bb, id, false);
|
|
window->DC.LastItemId = id;
|
|
window->DC.LastItemRect = bb;
|
|
window->DC.LastItemRectHoveredRect = false;
|
|
if (is_clipped)
|
|
return false;
|
|
//if (g.IO.KeyAlt) window->DrawList->AddRect(bb.Min, bb.Max, IM_COL32(255,255,0,120)); // [DEBUG]
|
|
|
|
// We need to calculate this now to take account of the current clipping rectangle (as items like Selectable may change them)
|
|
window->DC.LastItemRectHoveredRect = IsMouseHoveringRect(bb.Min, bb.Max);
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// This is roughly matching the behavior of internal-facing ItemHoverable()
|
|
// - we allow hovering to be true when ActiveId==window->MoveID, so that clicking on non-interactive items such as a Text() item still returns true with IsItemHovered()
|
|
// - this should work even for non-interactive items that have no ID, so we cannot use LastItemId
|
|
bool ImGui::IsItemHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags flags)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
|
|
// Test for bounding box overlap, as updated as ItemAdd()
|
|
if (!window->DC.LastItemRectHoveredRect)
|
|
return false;
|
|
IM_ASSERT((flags & ImGuiHoveredFlags_FlattenChilds) == 0); // Flags not supported by this function
|
|
|
|
// Test if we are hovering the right window (our window could be behind another window)
|
|
// [2017/10/16] Reverted commit 344d48be3 and testing RootWindow instead. I believe it is correct to NOT test for RootWindow but this leaves us unable to use IsItemHovered() after EndChild() itself.
|
|
// Until a solution is found I believe reverting to the test from 2017/09/27 is safe since this was the test that has been running for a long while.
|
|
//if (g.HoveredWindow != window)
|
|
// return false;
|
|
if (g.HoveredRootWindow != window->RootWindow && !(flags & ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenOverlapped))
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
// Test if another item is active (e.g. being dragged)
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByActiveItem))
|
|
if (g.ActiveId != 0 && g.ActiveId != window->DC.LastItemId && !g.ActiveIdAllowOverlap && g.ActiveId != window->MoveId)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
// Test if interactions on this window are blocked by an active popup or modal
|
|
if (!IsWindowContentHoverable(window, flags))
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
// Test if the item is disabled
|
|
if (window->DC.ItemFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
// Special handling for the 1st item after Begin() which represent the title bar. When the window is collapsed (SkipItems==true) that last item will never be overwritten so we need to detect tht case.
|
|
if (window->DC.LastItemId == window->MoveId && window->WriteAccessed)
|
|
return false;
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Internal facing ItemHoverable() used when submitting widgets. Differs slightly from IsItemHovered().
|
|
bool ImGui::ItemHoverable(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (g.HoveredId != 0 && g.HoveredId != id && !g.HoveredIdAllowOverlap)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
if (g.HoveredWindow != window)
|
|
return false;
|
|
if (g.ActiveId != 0 && g.ActiveId != id && !g.ActiveIdAllowOverlap)
|
|
return false;
|
|
if (!IsMouseHoveringRect(bb.Min, bb.Max))
|
|
return false;
|
|
if (!IsWindowContentHoverable(window, ImGuiHoveredFlags_Default))
|
|
return false;
|
|
if (window->DC.ItemFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
SetHoveredID(id);
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::IsClippedEx(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, bool clip_even_when_logged)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
if (!bb.Overlaps(window->ClipRect))
|
|
if (id == 0 || id != g.ActiveId)
|
|
if (clip_even_when_logged || !g.LogEnabled)
|
|
return true;
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::FocusableItemRegister(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiID id, bool tab_stop)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
|
|
const bool allow_keyboard_focus = (window->DC.ItemFlags & (ImGuiItemFlags_AllowKeyboardFocus | ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled)) == ImGuiItemFlags_AllowKeyboardFocus;
|
|
window->FocusIdxAllCounter++;
|
|
if (allow_keyboard_focus)
|
|
window->FocusIdxTabCounter++;
|
|
|
|
// Process keyboard input at this point: TAB/Shift-TAB to tab out of the currently focused item.
|
|
// Note that we can always TAB out of a widget that doesn't allow tabbing in.
|
|
if (tab_stop && (g.ActiveId == id) && window->FocusIdxAllRequestNext == INT_MAX && window->FocusIdxTabRequestNext == INT_MAX && !g.IO.KeyCtrl && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Tab))
|
|
window->FocusIdxTabRequestNext = window->FocusIdxTabCounter + (g.IO.KeyShift ? (allow_keyboard_focus ? -1 : 0) : +1); // Modulo on index will be applied at the end of frame once we've got the total counter of items.
|
|
|
|
if (window->FocusIdxAllCounter == window->FocusIdxAllRequestCurrent)
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
if (allow_keyboard_focus)
|
|
if (window->FocusIdxTabCounter == window->FocusIdxTabRequestCurrent)
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::FocusableItemUnregister(ImGuiWindow* window)
|
|
{
|
|
window->FocusIdxAllCounter--;
|
|
window->FocusIdxTabCounter--;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImVec2 ImGui::CalcItemSize(ImVec2 size, float default_x, float default_y)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImVec2 content_max;
|
|
if (size.x < 0.0f || size.y < 0.0f)
|
|
content_max = g.CurrentWindow->Pos + GetContentRegionMax();
|
|
if (size.x <= 0.0f)
|
|
size.x = (size.x == 0.0f) ? default_x : ImMax(content_max.x - g.CurrentWindow->DC.CursorPos.x, 4.0f) + size.x;
|
|
if (size.y <= 0.0f)
|
|
size.y = (size.y == 0.0f) ? default_y : ImMax(content_max.y - g.CurrentWindow->DC.CursorPos.y, 4.0f) + size.y;
|
|
return size;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
float ImGui::CalcWrapWidthForPos(const ImVec2& pos, float wrap_pos_x)
|
|
{
|
|
if (wrap_pos_x < 0.0f)
|
|
return 0.0f;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
if (wrap_pos_x == 0.0f)
|
|
wrap_pos_x = GetContentRegionMax().x + window->Pos.x;
|
|
else if (wrap_pos_x > 0.0f)
|
|
wrap_pos_x += window->Pos.x - window->Scroll.x; // wrap_pos_x is provided is window local space
|
|
|
|
return ImMax(wrap_pos_x - pos.x, 1.0f);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
void* ImGui::MemAlloc(size_t sz)
|
|
{
|
|
GImGui->IO.MetricsAllocs++;
|
|
return GImGui->IO.MemAllocFn(sz);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::MemFree(void* ptr)
|
|
{
|
|
if (ptr) GImGui->IO.MetricsAllocs--;
|
|
return GImGui->IO.MemFreeFn(ptr);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const char* ImGui::GetClipboardText()
|
|
{
|
|
return GImGui->IO.GetClipboardTextFn ? GImGui->IO.GetClipboardTextFn(GImGui->IO.ClipboardUserData) : "";
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetClipboardText(const char* text)
|
|
{
|
|
if (GImGui->IO.SetClipboardTextFn)
|
|
GImGui->IO.SetClipboardTextFn(GImGui->IO.ClipboardUserData, text);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const char* ImGui::GetVersion()
|
|
{
|
|
return IMGUI_VERSION;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Internal state access - if you want to share ImGui state between modules (e.g. DLL) or allocate it yourself
|
|
// Note that we still point to some static data and members (such as GFontAtlas), so the state instance you end up using will point to the static data within its module
|
|
ImGuiContext* ImGui::GetCurrentContext()
|
|
{
|
|
return GImGui;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetCurrentContext(ImGuiContext* ctx)
|
|
{
|
|
#ifdef IMGUI_SET_CURRENT_CONTEXT_FUNC
|
|
IMGUI_SET_CURRENT_CONTEXT_FUNC(ctx); // For custom thread-based hackery you may want to have control over this.
|
|
#else
|
|
GImGui = ctx;
|
|
#endif
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext* ImGui::CreateContext(void* (*malloc_fn)(size_t), void (*free_fn)(void*))
|
|
{
|
|
if (!malloc_fn) malloc_fn = malloc;
|
|
ImGuiContext* ctx = (ImGuiContext*)malloc_fn(sizeof(ImGuiContext));
|
|
IM_PLACEMENT_NEW(ctx) ImGuiContext();
|
|
ctx->IO.MemAllocFn = malloc_fn;
|
|
ctx->IO.MemFreeFn = free_fn ? free_fn : free;
|
|
return ctx;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::DestroyContext(ImGuiContext* ctx)
|
|
{
|
|
void (*free_fn)(void*) = ctx->IO.MemFreeFn;
|
|
ctx->~ImGuiContext();
|
|
free_fn(ctx);
|
|
if (GImGui == ctx)
|
|
SetCurrentContext(NULL);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImGuiIO& ImGui::GetIO()
|
|
{
|
|
return GImGui->IO;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImGuiStyle& ImGui::GetStyle()
|
|
{
|
|
return GImGui->Style;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Same value as passed to your RenderDrawListsFn() function. valid after Render() and until the next call to NewFrame()
|
|
ImDrawData* ImGui::GetDrawData()
|
|
{
|
|
return GImGui->RenderDrawData.Valid ? &GImGui->RenderDrawData : NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
float ImGui::GetTime()
|
|
{
|
|
return GImGui->Time;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
int ImGui::GetFrameCount()
|
|
{
|
|
return GImGui->FrameCount;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImDrawList* ImGui::GetOverlayDrawList()
|
|
{
|
|
return &GImGui->OverlayDrawList;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::NewFrame()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
|
|
// Check user data
|
|
// (We pass an error message in the assert expression as a trick to get it visible to programmers who are not using a debugger, as most assert handlers display their argument)
|
|
IM_ASSERT(g.IO.DeltaTime >= 0.0f && "Need a positive DeltaTime (zero is tolerated but will cause some timing issues)");
|
|
IM_ASSERT(g.IO.DisplaySize.x >= 0.0f && g.IO.DisplaySize.y >= 0.0f && "Invalid DisplaySize value");
|
|
IM_ASSERT(g.IO.Fonts->Fonts.Size > 0 && "Font Atlas not created. Did you call io.Fonts->GetTexDataAsRGBA32 / GetTexDataAsAlpha8 ?");
|
|
IM_ASSERT(g.IO.Fonts->Fonts[0]->IsLoaded() && "Font Atlas not created. Did you call io.Fonts->GetTexDataAsRGBA32 / GetTexDataAsAlpha8 ?");
|
|
IM_ASSERT(g.Style.CurveTessellationTol > 0.0f && "Invalid style setting");
|
|
IM_ASSERT(g.Style.Alpha >= 0.0f && g.Style.Alpha <= 1.0f && "Invalid style setting. Alpha cannot be negative (allows us to avoid a few clamps in color computations)");
|
|
IM_ASSERT((g.FrameCount == 0 || g.FrameCountEnded == g.FrameCount) && "Forgot to call Render() or EndFrame() at the end of the previous frame?");
|
|
|
|
// Initialize on first frame
|
|
if (!g.Initialized)
|
|
ImGui::Initialize();
|
|
|
|
SetCurrentFont(GetDefaultFont());
|
|
IM_ASSERT(g.Font->IsLoaded());
|
|
|
|
g.Time += g.IO.DeltaTime;
|
|
g.FrameCount += 1;
|
|
g.TooltipOverrideCount = 0;
|
|
g.OverlayDrawList.Clear();
|
|
g.OverlayDrawList.PushTextureID(g.IO.Fonts->TexID);
|
|
g.OverlayDrawList.PushClipRectFullScreen();
|
|
|
|
// Mark rendering data as invalid to prevent user who may have a handle on it to use it
|
|
g.RenderDrawData.Valid = false;
|
|
g.RenderDrawData.CmdLists = NULL;
|
|
g.RenderDrawData.CmdListsCount = g.RenderDrawData.TotalVtxCount = g.RenderDrawData.TotalIdxCount = 0;
|
|
|
|
// Clear reference to active widget if the widget isn't alive anymore
|
|
if (!g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame)
|
|
g.HoveredIdTimer = 0.0f;
|
|
g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame = g.HoveredId;
|
|
g.HoveredId = 0;
|
|
g.HoveredIdAllowOverlap = false;
|
|
if (!g.ActiveIdIsAlive && g.ActiveIdPreviousFrame == g.ActiveId && g.ActiveId != 0)
|
|
ClearActiveID();
|
|
if (g.ActiveId)
|
|
g.ActiveIdTimer += g.IO.DeltaTime;
|
|
g.ActiveIdPreviousFrame = g.ActiveId;
|
|
g.ActiveIdIsAlive = false;
|
|
g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated = false;
|
|
if (g.ScalarAsInputTextId && g.ActiveId != g.ScalarAsInputTextId)
|
|
g.ScalarAsInputTextId = 0;
|
|
|
|
// Update keyboard input state
|
|
memcpy(g.IO.KeysDownDurationPrev, g.IO.KeysDownDuration, sizeof(g.IO.KeysDownDuration));
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.KeysDown); i++)
|
|
g.IO.KeysDownDuration[i] = g.IO.KeysDown[i] ? (g.IO.KeysDownDuration[i] < 0.0f ? 0.0f : g.IO.KeysDownDuration[i] + g.IO.DeltaTime) : -1.0f;
|
|
|
|
// Update mouse input state
|
|
// If mouse just appeared or disappeared (usually denoted by -FLT_MAX component, but in reality we test for -256000.0f) we cancel out movement in MouseDelta
|
|
if (IsMousePosValid(&g.IO.MousePos) && IsMousePosValid(&g.IO.MousePosPrev))
|
|
g.IO.MouseDelta = g.IO.MousePos - g.IO.MousePosPrev;
|
|
else
|
|
g.IO.MouseDelta = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f);
|
|
g.IO.MousePosPrev = g.IO.MousePos;
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown); i++)
|
|
{
|
|
g.IO.MouseClicked[i] = g.IO.MouseDown[i] && g.IO.MouseDownDuration[i] < 0.0f;
|
|
g.IO.MouseReleased[i] = !g.IO.MouseDown[i] && g.IO.MouseDownDuration[i] >= 0.0f;
|
|
g.IO.MouseDownDurationPrev[i] = g.IO.MouseDownDuration[i];
|
|
g.IO.MouseDownDuration[i] = g.IO.MouseDown[i] ? (g.IO.MouseDownDuration[i] < 0.0f ? 0.0f : g.IO.MouseDownDuration[i] + g.IO.DeltaTime) : -1.0f;
|
|
g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[i] = false;
|
|
if (g.IO.MouseClicked[i])
|
|
{
|
|
if (g.Time - g.IO.MouseClickedTime[i] < g.IO.MouseDoubleClickTime)
|
|
{
|
|
if (ImLengthSqr(g.IO.MousePos - g.IO.MouseClickedPos[i]) < g.IO.MouseDoubleClickMaxDist * g.IO.MouseDoubleClickMaxDist)
|
|
g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[i] = true;
|
|
g.IO.MouseClickedTime[i] = -FLT_MAX; // so the third click isn't turned into a double-click
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
g.IO.MouseClickedTime[i] = g.Time;
|
|
}
|
|
g.IO.MouseClickedPos[i] = g.IO.MousePos;
|
|
g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceAbs[i] = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f);
|
|
g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceSqr[i] = 0.0f;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (g.IO.MouseDown[i])
|
|
{
|
|
ImVec2 mouse_delta = g.IO.MousePos - g.IO.MouseClickedPos[i];
|
|
g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceAbs[i].x = ImMax(g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceAbs[i].x, mouse_delta.x < 0.0f ? -mouse_delta.x : mouse_delta.x);
|
|
g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceAbs[i].y = ImMax(g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceAbs[i].y, mouse_delta.y < 0.0f ? -mouse_delta.y : mouse_delta.y);
|
|
g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceSqr[i] = ImMax(g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceSqr[i], ImLengthSqr(mouse_delta));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Calculate frame-rate for the user, as a purely luxurious feature
|
|
g.FramerateSecPerFrameAccum += g.IO.DeltaTime - g.FramerateSecPerFrame[g.FramerateSecPerFrameIdx];
|
|
g.FramerateSecPerFrame[g.FramerateSecPerFrameIdx] = g.IO.DeltaTime;
|
|
g.FramerateSecPerFrameIdx = (g.FramerateSecPerFrameIdx + 1) % IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.FramerateSecPerFrame);
|
|
g.IO.Framerate = 1.0f / (g.FramerateSecPerFrameAccum / (float)IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.FramerateSecPerFrame));
|
|
|
|
// Handle user moving window with mouse (at the beginning of the frame to avoid input lag or sheering). Only valid for root windows.
|
|
if (g.MovingWindowMoveId && g.MovingWindowMoveId == g.ActiveId)
|
|
{
|
|
KeepAliveID(g.MovingWindowMoveId);
|
|
IM_ASSERT(g.MovingWindow && g.MovingWindow->RootWindow);
|
|
IM_ASSERT(g.MovingWindow->MoveId == g.MovingWindowMoveId);
|
|
if (g.IO.MouseDown[0])
|
|
{
|
|
g.MovingWindow->RootWindow->PosFloat += g.IO.MouseDelta;
|
|
if (g.IO.MouseDelta.x != 0.0f || g.IO.MouseDelta.y != 0.0f)
|
|
MarkIniSettingsDirty(g.MovingWindow->RootWindow);
|
|
FocusWindow(g.MovingWindow);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
ClearActiveID();
|
|
g.MovingWindow = NULL;
|
|
g.MovingWindowMoveId = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
g.MovingWindow = NULL;
|
|
g.MovingWindowMoveId = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Delay saving settings so we don't spam disk too much
|
|
if (g.SettingsDirtyTimer > 0.0f)
|
|
{
|
|
g.SettingsDirtyTimer -= g.IO.DeltaTime;
|
|
if (g.SettingsDirtyTimer <= 0.0f)
|
|
SaveIniSettingsToDisk(g.IO.IniFilename);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Find the window we are hovering
|
|
// - Child windows can extend beyond the limit of their parent so we need to derive HoveredRootWindow from HoveredWindow.
|
|
// - When moving a window we can skip the search, which also conveniently bypasses the fact that window->WindowRectClipped is lagging as this point.
|
|
// - We also support the moved window toggling the NoInputs flag after moving has started in order to be able to detect windows below it, which is useful for e.g. docking mechanisms.
|
|
g.HoveredWindow = (g.MovingWindow && !(g.MovingWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoInputs)) ? g.MovingWindow : FindHoveredWindow(g.IO.MousePos);
|
|
g.HoveredRootWindow = g.HoveredWindow ? g.HoveredWindow->RootWindow : NULL;
|
|
|
|
if (ImGuiWindow* modal_window = GetFrontMostModalRootWindow())
|
|
{
|
|
g.ModalWindowDarkeningRatio = ImMin(g.ModalWindowDarkeningRatio + g.IO.DeltaTime * 6.0f, 1.0f);
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.HoveredRootWindow;
|
|
while (window && window != modal_window)
|
|
window = window->ParentWindow;
|
|
if (!window)
|
|
g.HoveredRootWindow = g.HoveredWindow = NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
g.ModalWindowDarkeningRatio = 0.0f;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Update the WantCaptureMouse/WantCAptureKeyboard flags, so user can capture/discard the inputs away from the rest of their application.
|
|
// When clicking outside of a window we assume the click is owned by the application and won't request capture. We need to track click ownership.
|
|
int mouse_earliest_button_down = -1;
|
|
bool mouse_any_down = false;
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown); i++)
|
|
{
|
|
if (g.IO.MouseClicked[i])
|
|
g.IO.MouseDownOwned[i] = (g.HoveredWindow != NULL) || (!g.OpenPopupStack.empty());
|
|
mouse_any_down |= g.IO.MouseDown[i];
|
|
if (g.IO.MouseDown[i])
|
|
if (mouse_earliest_button_down == -1 || g.IO.MouseClickedTime[i] < g.IO.MouseClickedTime[mouse_earliest_button_down])
|
|
mouse_earliest_button_down = i;
|
|
}
|
|
bool mouse_avail_to_imgui = (mouse_earliest_button_down == -1) || g.IO.MouseDownOwned[mouse_earliest_button_down];
|
|
if (g.WantCaptureMouseNextFrame != -1)
|
|
g.IO.WantCaptureMouse = (g.WantCaptureMouseNextFrame != 0);
|
|
else
|
|
g.IO.WantCaptureMouse = (mouse_avail_to_imgui && (g.HoveredWindow != NULL || mouse_any_down)) || (!g.OpenPopupStack.empty());
|
|
g.IO.WantCaptureKeyboard = (g.WantCaptureKeyboardNextFrame != -1) ? (g.WantCaptureKeyboardNextFrame != 0) : (g.ActiveId != 0);
|
|
g.IO.WantTextInput = (g.WantTextInputNextFrame != -1) ? (g.WantTextInputNextFrame != 0) : 0;
|
|
g.MouseCursor = ImGuiMouseCursor_Arrow;
|
|
g.WantCaptureMouseNextFrame = g.WantCaptureKeyboardNextFrame = g.WantTextInputNextFrame = -1;
|
|
g.OsImePosRequest = ImVec2(1.0f, 1.0f); // OS Input Method Editor showing on top-left of our window by default
|
|
|
|
// If mouse was first clicked outside of ImGui bounds we also cancel out hovering.
|
|
// FIXME: For patterns of drag and drop between "application" and "imgui" we may need to rework/remove this test (first committed 311c0ca9 on 2015/02)
|
|
if (!mouse_avail_to_imgui)
|
|
g.HoveredWindow = g.HoveredRootWindow = NULL;
|
|
|
|
// Scale & Scrolling
|
|
if (g.HoveredWindow && g.IO.MouseWheel != 0.0f && !g.HoveredWindow->Collapsed)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.HoveredWindow;
|
|
if (g.IO.KeyCtrl && g.IO.FontAllowUserScaling)
|
|
{
|
|
// Zoom / Scale window
|
|
const float new_font_scale = ImClamp(window->FontWindowScale + g.IO.MouseWheel * 0.10f, 0.50f, 2.50f);
|
|
const float scale = new_font_scale / window->FontWindowScale;
|
|
window->FontWindowScale = new_font_scale;
|
|
|
|
const ImVec2 offset = window->Size * (1.0f - scale) * (g.IO.MousePos - window->Pos) / window->Size;
|
|
window->Pos += offset;
|
|
window->PosFloat += offset;
|
|
window->Size *= scale;
|
|
window->SizeFull *= scale;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (!g.IO.KeyCtrl && !(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollWithMouse))
|
|
{
|
|
// Scroll
|
|
const int scroll_lines = (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ComboBox) ? 3 : 5;
|
|
SetWindowScrollY(window, window->Scroll.y - g.IO.MouseWheel * window->CalcFontSize() * scroll_lines);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Pressing TAB activate widget focus
|
|
if (g.ActiveId == 0 && g.NavWindow != NULL && g.NavWindow->Active && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Tab, false))
|
|
g.NavWindow->FocusIdxTabRequestNext = 0;
|
|
|
|
// Mark all windows as not visible
|
|
for (int i = 0; i != g.Windows.Size; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.Windows[i];
|
|
window->WasActive = window->Active;
|
|
window->Active = false;
|
|
window->WriteAccessed = false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Closing the focused window restore focus to the first active root window in descending z-order
|
|
if (g.NavWindow && !g.NavWindow->WasActive)
|
|
FocusPreviousWindow();
|
|
|
|
// No window should be open at the beginning of the frame.
|
|
// But in order to allow the user to call NewFrame() multiple times without calling Render(), we are doing an explicit clear.
|
|
g.CurrentWindowStack.resize(0);
|
|
g.CurrentPopupStack.resize(0);
|
|
CloseInactivePopups(g.NavWindow);
|
|
|
|
// Create implicit window - we will only render it if the user has added something to it.
|
|
// We don't use "Debug" to avoid colliding with user trying to create a "Debug" window with custom flags.
|
|
ImGui::SetNextWindowSize(ImVec2(400,400), ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver);
|
|
ImGui::Begin("Debug##Default");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void* SettingsHandlerWindow_ReadOpen(ImGuiContext&, const char* name)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindowSettings* settings = ImGui::FindWindowSettings(ImHash(name, 0));
|
|
if (!settings)
|
|
settings = AddWindowSettings(name);
|
|
return (void*)settings;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void SettingsHandlerWindow_ReadLine(ImGuiContext&, void* entry, const char* line)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindowSettings* settings = (ImGuiWindowSettings*)entry;
|
|
float x, y;
|
|
int i;
|
|
if (sscanf(line, "Pos=%f,%f", &x, &y) == 2) settings->Pos = ImVec2(x, y);
|
|
else if (sscanf(line, "Size=%f,%f", &x, &y) == 2) settings->Size = ImMax(ImVec2(x, y), GImGui->Style.WindowMinSize);
|
|
else if (sscanf(line, "Collapsed=%d", &i) == 1) settings->Collapsed = (i != 0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void SettingsHandlerWindow_WriteAll(ImGuiContext& g, ImGuiTextBuffer* buf)
|
|
{
|
|
// Gather data from windows that were active during this session
|
|
for (int i = 0; i != g.Windows.Size; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.Windows[i];
|
|
if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings)
|
|
continue;
|
|
ImGuiWindowSettings* settings = ImGui::FindWindowSettings(window->ID);
|
|
if (!settings)
|
|
settings = AddWindowSettings(window->Name);
|
|
settings->Pos = window->Pos;
|
|
settings->Size = window->SizeFull;
|
|
settings->Collapsed = window->Collapsed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Write a buffer
|
|
// If a window wasn't opened in this session we preserve its settings
|
|
buf->reserve(buf->size() + g.SettingsWindows.Size * 96); // ballpark reserve
|
|
for (int i = 0; i != g.SettingsWindows.Size; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
const ImGuiWindowSettings* settings = &g.SettingsWindows[i];
|
|
if (settings->Pos.x == FLT_MAX)
|
|
continue;
|
|
const char* name = settings->Name;
|
|
if (const char* p = strstr(name, "###")) // Skip to the "###" marker if any. We don't skip past to match the behavior of GetID()
|
|
name = p;
|
|
buf->appendf("[Window][%s]\n", name);
|
|
buf->appendf("Pos=%d,%d\n", (int)settings->Pos.x, (int)settings->Pos.y);
|
|
buf->appendf("Size=%d,%d\n", (int)settings->Size.x, (int)settings->Size.y);
|
|
buf->appendf("Collapsed=%d\n", settings->Collapsed);
|
|
buf->appendf("\n");
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::Initialize()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
g.LogClipboard = (ImGuiTextBuffer*)ImGui::MemAlloc(sizeof(ImGuiTextBuffer));
|
|
IM_PLACEMENT_NEW(g.LogClipboard) ImGuiTextBuffer();
|
|
|
|
// Add .ini handle for ImGuiWindow type
|
|
ImGuiSettingsHandler ini_handler;
|
|
ini_handler.TypeName = "Window";
|
|
ini_handler.TypeHash = ImHash("Window", 0, 0);
|
|
ini_handler.ReadOpenFn = SettingsHandlerWindow_ReadOpen;
|
|
ini_handler.ReadLineFn = SettingsHandlerWindow_ReadLine;
|
|
ini_handler.WriteAllFn = SettingsHandlerWindow_WriteAll;
|
|
g.SettingsHandlers.push_front(ini_handler);
|
|
|
|
// Load .ini file
|
|
IM_ASSERT(g.SettingsWindows.empty());
|
|
LoadIniSettingsFromDisk(g.IO.IniFilename);
|
|
g.Initialized = true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// This function is merely here to free heap allocations.
|
|
void ImGui::Shutdown()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
|
|
// The fonts atlas can be used prior to calling NewFrame(), so we clear it even if g.Initialized is FALSE (which would happen if we never called NewFrame)
|
|
if (g.IO.Fonts) // Testing for NULL to allow user to NULLify in case of running Shutdown() on multiple contexts. Bit hacky.
|
|
g.IO.Fonts->Clear();
|
|
|
|
// Cleanup of other data are conditional on actually having initialize ImGui.
|
|
if (!g.Initialized)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
SaveIniSettingsToDisk(g.IO.IniFilename);
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < g.Windows.Size; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
g.Windows[i]->~ImGuiWindow();
|
|
ImGui::MemFree(g.Windows[i]);
|
|
}
|
|
g.Windows.clear();
|
|
g.WindowsSortBuffer.clear();
|
|
g.CurrentWindow = NULL;
|
|
g.CurrentWindowStack.clear();
|
|
g.WindowsById.Clear();
|
|
g.NavWindow = NULL;
|
|
g.HoveredWindow = NULL;
|
|
g.HoveredRootWindow = NULL;
|
|
g.ActiveIdWindow = NULL;
|
|
g.MovingWindow = NULL;
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < g.SettingsWindows.Size; i++)
|
|
ImGui::MemFree(g.SettingsWindows[i].Name);
|
|
g.ColorModifiers.clear();
|
|
g.StyleModifiers.clear();
|
|
g.FontStack.clear();
|
|
g.OpenPopupStack.clear();
|
|
g.CurrentPopupStack.clear();
|
|
g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraintCallback = NULL;
|
|
g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraintCallbackUserData = NULL;
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.RenderDrawLists); i++)
|
|
g.RenderDrawLists[i].clear();
|
|
g.OverlayDrawList.ClearFreeMemory();
|
|
g.PrivateClipboard.clear();
|
|
g.InputTextState.Text.clear();
|
|
g.InputTextState.InitialText.clear();
|
|
g.InputTextState.TempTextBuffer.clear();
|
|
|
|
g.SettingsWindows.clear();
|
|
g.SettingsHandlers.clear();
|
|
|
|
if (g.LogFile && g.LogFile != stdout)
|
|
{
|
|
fclose(g.LogFile);
|
|
g.LogFile = NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
if (g.LogClipboard)
|
|
{
|
|
g.LogClipboard->~ImGuiTextBuffer();
|
|
ImGui::MemFree(g.LogClipboard);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
g.Initialized = false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImGuiWindowSettings* ImGui::FindWindowSettings(ImGuiID id)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
for (int i = 0; i != g.SettingsWindows.Size; i++)
|
|
if (g.SettingsWindows[i].Id == id)
|
|
return &g.SettingsWindows[i];
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static ImGuiWindowSettings* AddWindowSettings(const char* name)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
g.SettingsWindows.push_back(ImGuiWindowSettings());
|
|
ImGuiWindowSettings* settings = &g.SettingsWindows.back();
|
|
settings->Name = ImStrdup(name);
|
|
settings->Id = ImHash(name, 0);
|
|
return settings;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void LoadIniSettingsFromDisk(const char* ini_filename)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!ini_filename)
|
|
return;
|
|
char* file_data = (char*)ImFileLoadToMemory(ini_filename, "rb", NULL, +1);
|
|
if (!file_data)
|
|
return;
|
|
LoadIniSettingsFromMemory(file_data);
|
|
ImGui::MemFree(file_data);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImGuiSettingsHandler* ImGui::FindSettingsHandler(ImGuiID type_hash)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
for (int handler_n = 0; handler_n < g.SettingsHandlers.Size; handler_n++)
|
|
if (g.SettingsHandlers[handler_n].TypeHash == type_hash)
|
|
return &g.SettingsHandlers[handler_n];
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Zero-tolerance, no error reporting, cheap .ini parsing
|
|
static void LoadIniSettingsFromMemory(const char* buf_readonly)
|
|
{
|
|
// For convenience and to make the code simpler, we'll write zero terminators inside the buffer. So let's create a writable copy.
|
|
char* buf = ImStrdup(buf_readonly);
|
|
char* buf_end = buf + strlen(buf);
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
void* entry_data = NULL;
|
|
const ImGuiSettingsHandler* entry_handler = NULL;
|
|
|
|
char* line_end = NULL;
|
|
for (char* line = buf; line < buf_end; line = line_end + 1)
|
|
{
|
|
// Skip new lines markers, then find end of the line
|
|
while (*line == '\n' || *line == '\r')
|
|
line++;
|
|
line_end = line;
|
|
while (line_end < buf_end && *line_end != '\n' && *line_end != '\r')
|
|
line_end++;
|
|
line_end[0] = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (line[0] == '[' && line_end > line && line_end[-1] == ']')
|
|
{
|
|
// Parse "[Type][Name]". Note that 'Name' can itself contains [] characters, which is acceptable with the current format and parsing code.
|
|
line_end[-1] = 0;
|
|
const char* name_end = line_end - 1;
|
|
const char* type_start = line + 1;
|
|
char* type_end = ImStrchrRange(type_start, name_end, ']');
|
|
const char* name_start = type_end ? ImStrchrRange(type_end + 1, name_end, '[') : NULL;
|
|
if (!type_end || !name_start)
|
|
{
|
|
name_start = type_start; // Import legacy entries that have no type
|
|
type_start = "Window";
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
*type_end = 0; // Overwrite first ']'
|
|
name_start++; // Skip second '['
|
|
}
|
|
const ImGuiID type_hash = ImHash(type_start, 0, 0);
|
|
entry_handler = ImGui::FindSettingsHandler(type_hash);
|
|
entry_data = entry_handler ? entry_handler->ReadOpenFn(g, name_start) : NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (entry_handler != NULL && entry_data != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
// Let type handler parse the line
|
|
entry_handler->ReadLineFn(g, entry_data, line);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
ImGui::MemFree(buf);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void SaveIniSettingsToDisk(const char* ini_filename)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
g.SettingsDirtyTimer = 0.0f;
|
|
if (!ini_filename)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
ImVector<char> buf;
|
|
SaveIniSettingsToMemory(buf);
|
|
|
|
FILE* f = ImFileOpen(ini_filename, "wt");
|
|
if (!f)
|
|
return;
|
|
fwrite(buf.Data, sizeof(char), (size_t)buf.Size, f);
|
|
fclose(f);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void SaveIniSettingsToMemory(ImVector<char>& out_buf)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
g.SettingsDirtyTimer = 0.0f;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiTextBuffer buf;
|
|
for (int handler_n = 0; handler_n < g.SettingsHandlers.Size; handler_n++)
|
|
g.SettingsHandlers[handler_n].WriteAllFn(g, &buf);
|
|
|
|
buf.Buf.pop_back(); // Remove extra zero-terminator used by ImGuiTextBuffer
|
|
out_buf.swap(buf.Buf);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::MarkIniSettingsDirty()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (g.SettingsDirtyTimer <= 0.0f)
|
|
g.SettingsDirtyTimer = g.IO.IniSavingRate;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void MarkIniSettingsDirty(ImGuiWindow* window)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (!(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings))
|
|
if (g.SettingsDirtyTimer <= 0.0f)
|
|
g.SettingsDirtyTimer = g.IO.IniSavingRate;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// FIXME: Add a more explicit sort order in the window structure.
|
|
static int ChildWindowComparer(const void* lhs, const void* rhs)
|
|
{
|
|
const ImGuiWindow* a = *(const ImGuiWindow**)lhs;
|
|
const ImGuiWindow* b = *(const ImGuiWindow**)rhs;
|
|
if (int d = (a->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) - (b->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup))
|
|
return d;
|
|
if (int d = (a->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip) - (b->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip))
|
|
return d;
|
|
if (int d = (a->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ComboBox) - (b->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ComboBox))
|
|
return d;
|
|
return (a->OrderWithinParent - b->OrderWithinParent);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void AddWindowToSortedBuffer(ImVector<ImGuiWindow*>& out_sorted_windows, ImGuiWindow* window)
|
|
{
|
|
out_sorted_windows.push_back(window);
|
|
if (window->Active)
|
|
{
|
|
int count = window->DC.ChildWindows.Size;
|
|
if (count > 1)
|
|
qsort(window->DC.ChildWindows.begin(), (size_t)count, sizeof(ImGuiWindow*), ChildWindowComparer);
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < count; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* child = window->DC.ChildWindows[i];
|
|
if (child->Active)
|
|
AddWindowToSortedBuffer(out_sorted_windows, child);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void AddDrawListToRenderList(ImVector<ImDrawList*>& out_render_list, ImDrawList* draw_list)
|
|
{
|
|
if (draw_list->CmdBuffer.empty())
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
// Remove trailing command if unused
|
|
ImDrawCmd& last_cmd = draw_list->CmdBuffer.back();
|
|
if (last_cmd.ElemCount == 0 && last_cmd.UserCallback == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
draw_list->CmdBuffer.pop_back();
|
|
if (draw_list->CmdBuffer.empty())
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Draw list sanity check. Detect mismatch between PrimReserve() calls and incrementing _VtxCurrentIdx, _VtxWritePtr etc. May trigger for you if you are using PrimXXX functions incorrectly.
|
|
IM_ASSERT(draw_list->VtxBuffer.Size == 0 || draw_list->_VtxWritePtr == draw_list->VtxBuffer.Data + draw_list->VtxBuffer.Size);
|
|
IM_ASSERT(draw_list->IdxBuffer.Size == 0 || draw_list->_IdxWritePtr == draw_list->IdxBuffer.Data + draw_list->IdxBuffer.Size);
|
|
IM_ASSERT((int)draw_list->_VtxCurrentIdx == draw_list->VtxBuffer.Size);
|
|
|
|
// Check that draw_list doesn't use more vertices than indexable in a single draw call (default ImDrawIdx = unsigned short = 2 bytes = 64K vertices per window)
|
|
// If this assert triggers because you are drawing lots of stuff manually, you can:
|
|
// A) Add '#define ImDrawIdx unsigned int' in imconfig.h to set the index size to 4 bytes. You'll need to handle the 4-bytes indices to your renderer.
|
|
// For example, the OpenGL example code detect index size at compile-time by doing:
|
|
// 'glDrawElements(GL_TRIANGLES, (GLsizei)pcmd->ElemCount, sizeof(ImDrawIdx) == 2 ? GL_UNSIGNED_SHORT : GL_UNSIGNED_INT, idx_buffer_offset);'
|
|
// Your own engine or render API may use different parameters or function calls to specify index sizes. 2 and 4 bytes indices are generally supported by most API.
|
|
// B) If for some reason you cannot use 4 bytes indices or don't want to, a workaround is to call BeginChild()/EndChild() before reaching the 64K limit to split your draw commands in multiple draw lists.
|
|
IM_ASSERT(((ImU64)draw_list->_VtxCurrentIdx >> (sizeof(ImDrawIdx)*8)) == 0); // Too many vertices in same ImDrawList. See comment above.
|
|
|
|
out_render_list.push_back(draw_list);
|
|
GImGui->IO.MetricsRenderVertices += draw_list->VtxBuffer.Size;
|
|
GImGui->IO.MetricsRenderIndices += draw_list->IdxBuffer.Size;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void AddWindowToRenderList(ImVector<ImDrawList*>& out_render_list, ImGuiWindow* window)
|
|
{
|
|
AddDrawListToRenderList(out_render_list, window->DrawList);
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < window->DC.ChildWindows.Size; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* child = window->DC.ChildWindows[i];
|
|
if (!child->Active) // clipped children may have been marked not active
|
|
continue;
|
|
if ((child->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) && child->HiddenFrames > 0)
|
|
continue;
|
|
AddWindowToRenderList(out_render_list, child);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void AddWindowToRenderListSelectLayer(ImGuiWindow* window)
|
|
{
|
|
// FIXME: Generalize this with a proper layering system so e.g. user can draw in specific layers, below text, ..
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
g.IO.MetricsActiveWindows++;
|
|
if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup)
|
|
AddWindowToRenderList(g.RenderDrawLists[1], window);
|
|
else if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip)
|
|
AddWindowToRenderList(g.RenderDrawLists[2], window);
|
|
else
|
|
AddWindowToRenderList(g.RenderDrawLists[0], window);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// When using this function it is sane to ensure that float are perfectly rounded to integer values, to that e.g. (int)(max.x-min.x) in user's render produce correct result.
|
|
void ImGui::PushClipRect(const ImVec2& clip_rect_min, const ImVec2& clip_rect_max, bool intersect_with_current_clip_rect)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
window->DrawList->PushClipRect(clip_rect_min, clip_rect_max, intersect_with_current_clip_rect);
|
|
window->ClipRect = window->DrawList->_ClipRectStack.back();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PopClipRect()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
window->DrawList->PopClipRect();
|
|
window->ClipRect = window->DrawList->_ClipRectStack.back();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// This is normally called by Render(). You may want to call it directly if you want to avoid calling Render() but the gain will be very minimal.
|
|
void ImGui::EndFrame()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(g.Initialized); // Forgot to call ImGui::NewFrame()
|
|
if (g.FrameCountEnded == g.FrameCount) // Don't process EndFrame() multiple times.
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
// Notify OS when our Input Method Editor cursor has moved (e.g. CJK inputs using Microsoft IME)
|
|
if (g.IO.ImeSetInputScreenPosFn && ImLengthSqr(g.OsImePosRequest - g.OsImePosSet) > 0.0001f)
|
|
{
|
|
g.IO.ImeSetInputScreenPosFn((int)g.OsImePosRequest.x, (int)g.OsImePosRequest.y);
|
|
g.OsImePosSet = g.OsImePosRequest;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Hide implicit "Debug" window if it hasn't been used
|
|
IM_ASSERT(g.CurrentWindowStack.Size == 1); // Mismatched Begin()/End() calls
|
|
if (g.CurrentWindow && !g.CurrentWindow->WriteAccessed)
|
|
g.CurrentWindow->Active = false;
|
|
ImGui::End();
|
|
|
|
if (g.ActiveId == 0 && g.HoveredId == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!g.NavWindow || !g.NavWindow->Appearing) // Unless we just made a window/popup appear
|
|
{
|
|
// Click to focus window and start moving (after we're done with all our widgets)
|
|
if (g.IO.MouseClicked[0])
|
|
{
|
|
if (g.HoveredRootWindow != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
FocusWindow(g.HoveredWindow);
|
|
if (!(g.HoveredWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove) && !(g.HoveredRootWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove))
|
|
{
|
|
g.MovingWindow = g.HoveredWindow;
|
|
g.MovingWindowMoveId = g.MovingWindow->MoveId;
|
|
SetActiveID(g.MovingWindowMoveId, g.HoveredRootWindow);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else if (g.NavWindow != NULL && GetFrontMostModalRootWindow() == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
// Clicking on void disable focus
|
|
FocusWindow(NULL);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// With right mouse button we close popups without changing focus
|
|
// (The left mouse button path calls FocusWindow which will lead NewFrame->CloseInactivePopups to trigger)
|
|
if (g.IO.MouseClicked[1])
|
|
{
|
|
// Find the top-most window between HoveredWindow and the front most Modal Window.
|
|
// This is where we can trim the popup stack.
|
|
ImGuiWindow* modal = GetFrontMostModalRootWindow();
|
|
bool hovered_window_above_modal = false;
|
|
if (modal == NULL)
|
|
hovered_window_above_modal = true;
|
|
for (int i = g.Windows.Size - 1; i >= 0 && hovered_window_above_modal == false; i--)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.Windows[i];
|
|
if (window == modal)
|
|
break;
|
|
if (window == g.HoveredWindow)
|
|
hovered_window_above_modal = true;
|
|
}
|
|
CloseInactivePopups(hovered_window_above_modal ? g.HoveredWindow : modal);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Sort the window list so that all child windows are after their parent
|
|
// We cannot do that on FocusWindow() because childs may not exist yet
|
|
g.WindowsSortBuffer.resize(0);
|
|
g.WindowsSortBuffer.reserve(g.Windows.Size);
|
|
for (int i = 0; i != g.Windows.Size; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.Windows[i];
|
|
if (window->Active && (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow)) // if a child is active its parent will add it
|
|
continue;
|
|
AddWindowToSortedBuffer(g.WindowsSortBuffer, window);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
IM_ASSERT(g.Windows.Size == g.WindowsSortBuffer.Size); // we done something wrong
|
|
g.Windows.swap(g.WindowsSortBuffer);
|
|
|
|
// Clear Input data for next frame
|
|
g.IO.MouseWheel = 0.0f;
|
|
memset(g.IO.InputCharacters, 0, sizeof(g.IO.InputCharacters));
|
|
|
|
g.FrameCountEnded = g.FrameCount;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::Render()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(g.Initialized); // Forgot to call ImGui::NewFrame()
|
|
|
|
if (g.FrameCountEnded != g.FrameCount)
|
|
ImGui::EndFrame();
|
|
g.FrameCountRendered = g.FrameCount;
|
|
|
|
// Skip render altogether if alpha is 0.0
|
|
// Note that vertex buffers have been created and are wasted, so it is best practice that you don't create windows in the first place, or consistently respond to Begin() returning false.
|
|
if (g.Style.Alpha > 0.0f)
|
|
{
|
|
// Gather windows to render
|
|
g.IO.MetricsRenderVertices = g.IO.MetricsRenderIndices = g.IO.MetricsActiveWindows = 0;
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.RenderDrawLists); i++)
|
|
g.RenderDrawLists[i].resize(0);
|
|
for (int i = 0; i != g.Windows.Size; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.Windows[i];
|
|
if (window->Active && window->HiddenFrames <= 0 && (window->Flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow)) == 0)
|
|
AddWindowToRenderListSelectLayer(window);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Flatten layers
|
|
int n = g.RenderDrawLists[0].Size;
|
|
int flattened_size = n;
|
|
for (int i = 1; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.RenderDrawLists); i++)
|
|
flattened_size += g.RenderDrawLists[i].Size;
|
|
g.RenderDrawLists[0].resize(flattened_size);
|
|
for (int i = 1; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.RenderDrawLists); i++)
|
|
{
|
|
ImVector<ImDrawList*>& layer = g.RenderDrawLists[i];
|
|
if (layer.empty())
|
|
continue;
|
|
memcpy(&g.RenderDrawLists[0][n], &layer[0], layer.Size * sizeof(ImDrawList*));
|
|
n += layer.Size;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Draw software mouse cursor if requested
|
|
if (g.IO.MouseDrawCursor)
|
|
{
|
|
const ImGuiMouseCursorData& cursor_data = g.MouseCursorData[g.MouseCursor];
|
|
const ImVec2 pos = g.IO.MousePos - cursor_data.HotOffset;
|
|
const ImVec2 size = cursor_data.Size;
|
|
const ImTextureID tex_id = g.IO.Fonts->TexID;
|
|
g.OverlayDrawList.PushTextureID(tex_id);
|
|
g.OverlayDrawList.AddImage(tex_id, pos+ImVec2(1,0), pos+ImVec2(1,0) + size, cursor_data.TexUvMin[1], cursor_data.TexUvMax[1], IM_COL32(0,0,0,48)); // Shadow
|
|
g.OverlayDrawList.AddImage(tex_id, pos+ImVec2(2,0), pos+ImVec2(2,0) + size, cursor_data.TexUvMin[1], cursor_data.TexUvMax[1], IM_COL32(0,0,0,48)); // Shadow
|
|
g.OverlayDrawList.AddImage(tex_id, pos, pos + size, cursor_data.TexUvMin[1], cursor_data.TexUvMax[1], IM_COL32(0,0,0,255)); // Black border
|
|
g.OverlayDrawList.AddImage(tex_id, pos, pos + size, cursor_data.TexUvMin[0], cursor_data.TexUvMax[0], IM_COL32(255,255,255,255)); // White fill
|
|
g.OverlayDrawList.PopTextureID();
|
|
}
|
|
if (!g.OverlayDrawList.VtxBuffer.empty())
|
|
AddDrawListToRenderList(g.RenderDrawLists[0], &g.OverlayDrawList);
|
|
|
|
// Setup draw data
|
|
g.RenderDrawData.Valid = true;
|
|
g.RenderDrawData.CmdLists = (g.RenderDrawLists[0].Size > 0) ? &g.RenderDrawLists[0][0] : NULL;
|
|
g.RenderDrawData.CmdListsCount = g.RenderDrawLists[0].Size;
|
|
g.RenderDrawData.TotalVtxCount = g.IO.MetricsRenderVertices;
|
|
g.RenderDrawData.TotalIdxCount = g.IO.MetricsRenderIndices;
|
|
|
|
// Render. If user hasn't set a callback then they may retrieve the draw data via GetDrawData()
|
|
if (g.RenderDrawData.CmdListsCount > 0 && g.IO.RenderDrawListsFn != NULL)
|
|
g.IO.RenderDrawListsFn(&g.RenderDrawData);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const char* ImGui::FindRenderedTextEnd(const char* text, const char* text_end)
|
|
{
|
|
const char* text_display_end = text;
|
|
if (!text_end)
|
|
text_end = (const char*)-1;
|
|
|
|
while (text_display_end < text_end && *text_display_end != '\0' && (text_display_end[0] != '#' || text_display_end[1] != '#'))
|
|
text_display_end++;
|
|
return text_display_end;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Pass text data straight to log (without being displayed)
|
|
void ImGui::LogText(const char* fmt, ...)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (!g.LogEnabled)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
va_list args;
|
|
va_start(args, fmt);
|
|
if (g.LogFile)
|
|
{
|
|
vfprintf(g.LogFile, fmt, args);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
g.LogClipboard->appendfv(fmt, args);
|
|
}
|
|
va_end(args);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Internal version that takes a position to decide on newline placement and pad items according to their depth.
|
|
// We split text into individual lines to add current tree level padding
|
|
static void LogRenderedText(const ImVec2* ref_pos, const char* text, const char* text_end = NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
|
|
if (!text_end)
|
|
text_end = ImGui::FindRenderedTextEnd(text, text_end);
|
|
|
|
const bool log_new_line = ref_pos && (ref_pos->y > window->DC.LogLinePosY + 1);
|
|
if (ref_pos)
|
|
window->DC.LogLinePosY = ref_pos->y;
|
|
|
|
const char* text_remaining = text;
|
|
if (g.LogStartDepth > window->DC.TreeDepth) // Re-adjust padding if we have popped out of our starting depth
|
|
g.LogStartDepth = window->DC.TreeDepth;
|
|
const int tree_depth = (window->DC.TreeDepth - g.LogStartDepth);
|
|
for (;;)
|
|
{
|
|
// Split the string. Each new line (after a '\n') is followed by spacing corresponding to the current depth of our log entry.
|
|
const char* line_end = text_remaining;
|
|
while (line_end < text_end)
|
|
if (*line_end == '\n')
|
|
break;
|
|
else
|
|
line_end++;
|
|
if (line_end >= text_end)
|
|
line_end = NULL;
|
|
|
|
const bool is_first_line = (text == text_remaining);
|
|
bool is_last_line = false;
|
|
if (line_end == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
is_last_line = true;
|
|
line_end = text_end;
|
|
}
|
|
if (line_end != NULL && !(is_last_line && (line_end - text_remaining)==0))
|
|
{
|
|
const int char_count = (int)(line_end - text_remaining);
|
|
if (log_new_line || !is_first_line)
|
|
ImGui::LogText(IM_NEWLINE "%*s%.*s", tree_depth*4, "", char_count, text_remaining);
|
|
else
|
|
ImGui::LogText(" %.*s", char_count, text_remaining);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (is_last_line)
|
|
break;
|
|
text_remaining = line_end + 1;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Internal ImGui functions to render text
|
|
// RenderText***() functions calls ImDrawList::AddText() calls ImBitmapFont::RenderText()
|
|
void ImGui::RenderText(ImVec2 pos, const char* text, const char* text_end, bool hide_text_after_hash)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
|
|
// Hide anything after a '##' string
|
|
const char* text_display_end;
|
|
if (hide_text_after_hash)
|
|
{
|
|
text_display_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(text, text_end);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if (!text_end)
|
|
text_end = text + strlen(text); // FIXME-OPT
|
|
text_display_end = text_end;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const int text_len = (int)(text_display_end - text);
|
|
if (text_len > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
window->DrawList->AddText(g.Font, g.FontSize, pos, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text), text, text_display_end);
|
|
if (g.LogEnabled)
|
|
LogRenderedText(&pos, text, text_display_end);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::RenderTextWrapped(ImVec2 pos, const char* text, const char* text_end, float wrap_width)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
|
|
if (!text_end)
|
|
text_end = text + strlen(text); // FIXME-OPT
|
|
|
|
const int text_len = (int)(text_end - text);
|
|
if (text_len > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
window->DrawList->AddText(g.Font, g.FontSize, pos, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text), text, text_end, wrap_width);
|
|
if (g.LogEnabled)
|
|
LogRenderedText(&pos, text, text_end);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Default clip_rect uses (pos_min,pos_max)
|
|
// Handle clipping on CPU immediately (vs typically let the GPU clip the triangles that are overlapping the clipping rectangle edges)
|
|
void ImGui::RenderTextClipped(const ImVec2& pos_min, const ImVec2& pos_max, const char* text, const char* text_end, const ImVec2* text_size_if_known, const ImVec2& align, const ImRect* clip_rect)
|
|
{
|
|
// Hide anything after a '##' string
|
|
const char* text_display_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(text, text_end);
|
|
const int text_len = (int)(text_display_end - text);
|
|
if (text_len == 0)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
|
|
// Perform CPU side clipping for single clipped element to avoid using scissor state
|
|
ImVec2 pos = pos_min;
|
|
const ImVec2 text_size = text_size_if_known ? *text_size_if_known : CalcTextSize(text, text_display_end, false, 0.0f);
|
|
|
|
const ImVec2* clip_min = clip_rect ? &clip_rect->Min : &pos_min;
|
|
const ImVec2* clip_max = clip_rect ? &clip_rect->Max : &pos_max;
|
|
bool need_clipping = (pos.x + text_size.x >= clip_max->x) || (pos.y + text_size.y >= clip_max->y);
|
|
if (clip_rect) // If we had no explicit clipping rectangle then pos==clip_min
|
|
need_clipping |= (pos.x < clip_min->x) || (pos.y < clip_min->y);
|
|
|
|
// Align whole block. We should defer that to the better rendering function when we'll have support for individual line alignment.
|
|
if (align.x > 0.0f) pos.x = ImMax(pos.x, pos.x + (pos_max.x - pos.x - text_size.x) * align.x);
|
|
if (align.y > 0.0f) pos.y = ImMax(pos.y, pos.y + (pos_max.y - pos.y - text_size.y) * align.y);
|
|
|
|
// Render
|
|
if (need_clipping)
|
|
{
|
|
ImVec4 fine_clip_rect(clip_min->x, clip_min->y, clip_max->x, clip_max->y);
|
|
window->DrawList->AddText(g.Font, g.FontSize, pos, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text), text, text_display_end, 0.0f, &fine_clip_rect);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
window->DrawList->AddText(g.Font, g.FontSize, pos, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text), text, text_display_end, 0.0f, NULL);
|
|
}
|
|
if (g.LogEnabled)
|
|
LogRenderedText(&pos, text, text_display_end);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Render a rectangle shaped with optional rounding and borders
|
|
void ImGui::RenderFrame(ImVec2 p_min, ImVec2 p_max, ImU32 fill_col, bool border, float rounding)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(p_min, p_max, fill_col, rounding);
|
|
const float border_size = g.Style.FrameBorderSize;
|
|
if (border && border_size > 0.0f)
|
|
{
|
|
window->DrawList->AddRect(p_min+ImVec2(1,1), p_max+ImVec2(1,1), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_BorderShadow), rounding, ImDrawCornerFlags_All, border_size);
|
|
window->DrawList->AddRect(p_min, p_max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Border), rounding, ImDrawCornerFlags_All, border_size);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::RenderFrameBorder(ImVec2 p_min, ImVec2 p_max, float rounding)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
const float border_size = g.Style.FrameBorderSize;
|
|
if (border_size > 0.0f)
|
|
{
|
|
window->DrawList->AddRect(p_min+ImVec2(1,1), p_max+ImVec2(1,1), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_BorderShadow), rounding, ImDrawCornerFlags_All, border_size);
|
|
window->DrawList->AddRect(p_min, p_max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Border), rounding, ImDrawCornerFlags_All, border_size);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Render a triangle to denote expanded/collapsed state
|
|
void ImGui::RenderTriangle(ImVec2 p_min, ImGuiDir dir, float scale)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
|
|
const float h = g.FontSize * 1.00f;
|
|
float r = h * 0.40f * scale;
|
|
ImVec2 center = p_min + ImVec2(h * 0.50f, h * 0.50f * scale);
|
|
|
|
ImVec2 a, b, c;
|
|
switch (dir)
|
|
{
|
|
case ImGuiDir_Up:
|
|
r = -r; // ...fall through, no break!
|
|
case ImGuiDir_Down:
|
|
center.y -= r * 0.25f;
|
|
a = ImVec2(0,1) * r;
|
|
b = ImVec2(-0.866f,-0.5f) * r;
|
|
c = ImVec2(+0.866f,-0.5f) * r;
|
|
break;
|
|
case ImGuiDir_Left:
|
|
r = -r; // ...fall through, no break!
|
|
case ImGuiDir_Right:
|
|
center.x -= r * 0.25f;
|
|
a = ImVec2(1,0) * r;
|
|
b = ImVec2(-0.500f,+0.866f) * r;
|
|
c = ImVec2(-0.500f,-0.866f) * r;
|
|
break;
|
|
default:
|
|
IM_ASSERT(0);
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
window->DrawList->AddTriangleFilled(center + a, center + b, center + c, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::RenderBullet(ImVec2 pos)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
window->DrawList->AddCircleFilled(pos, GImGui->FontSize*0.20f, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text), 8);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::RenderCheckMark(ImVec2 pos, ImU32 col, float sz)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
|
|
float thickness = ImMax(sz / 5.0f, 1.0f);
|
|
sz -= thickness*0.5f;
|
|
pos += ImVec2(thickness*0.25f, thickness*0.25f);
|
|
|
|
float third = sz / 3.0f;
|
|
float bx = pos.x + third;
|
|
float by = pos.y + sz - third*0.5f;
|
|
window->DrawList->PathLineTo(ImVec2(bx - third, by - third));
|
|
window->DrawList->PathLineTo(ImVec2(bx, by));
|
|
window->DrawList->PathLineTo(ImVec2(bx + third*2, by - third*2));
|
|
window->DrawList->PathStroke(col, false, thickness);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Calculate text size. Text can be multi-line. Optionally ignore text after a ## marker.
|
|
// CalcTextSize("") should return ImVec2(0.0f, GImGui->FontSize)
|
|
ImVec2 ImGui::CalcTextSize(const char* text, const char* text_end, bool hide_text_after_double_hash, float wrap_width)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
|
|
const char* text_display_end;
|
|
if (hide_text_after_double_hash)
|
|
text_display_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(text, text_end); // Hide anything after a '##' string
|
|
else
|
|
text_display_end = text_end;
|
|
|
|
ImFont* font = g.Font;
|
|
const float font_size = g.FontSize;
|
|
if (text == text_display_end)
|
|
return ImVec2(0.0f, font_size);
|
|
ImVec2 text_size = font->CalcTextSizeA(font_size, FLT_MAX, wrap_width, text, text_display_end, NULL);
|
|
|
|
// Cancel out character spacing for the last character of a line (it is baked into glyph->AdvanceX field)
|
|
const float font_scale = font_size / font->FontSize;
|
|
const float character_spacing_x = 1.0f * font_scale;
|
|
if (text_size.x > 0.0f)
|
|
text_size.x -= character_spacing_x;
|
|
text_size.x = (float)(int)(text_size.x + 0.95f);
|
|
|
|
return text_size;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Helper to calculate coarse clipping of large list of evenly sized items.
|
|
// NB: Prefer using the ImGuiListClipper higher-level helper if you can! Read comments and instructions there on how those use this sort of pattern.
|
|
// NB: 'items_count' is only used to clamp the result, if you don't know your count you can use INT_MAX
|
|
void ImGui::CalcListClipping(int items_count, float items_height, int* out_items_display_start, int* out_items_display_end)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
if (g.LogEnabled)
|
|
{
|
|
// If logging is active, do not perform any clipping
|
|
*out_items_display_start = 0;
|
|
*out_items_display_end = items_count;
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
{
|
|
*out_items_display_start = *out_items_display_end = 0;
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos;
|
|
int start = (int)((window->ClipRect.Min.y - pos.y) / items_height);
|
|
int end = (int)((window->ClipRect.Max.y - pos.y) / items_height);
|
|
start = ImClamp(start, 0, items_count);
|
|
end = ImClamp(end + 1, start, items_count);
|
|
*out_items_display_start = start;
|
|
*out_items_display_end = end;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Find window given position, search front-to-back
|
|
// FIXME: Note that we have a lag here because WindowRectClipped is updated in Begin() so windows moved by user via SetWindowPos() and not SetNextWindowPos() will have that rectangle lagging by a frame at the time FindHoveredWindow() is called, aka before the next Begin(). Moving window thankfully isn't affected.
|
|
static ImGuiWindow* FindHoveredWindow(ImVec2 pos)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
for (int i = g.Windows.Size-1; i >= 0; i--)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.Windows[i];
|
|
if (!window->Active)
|
|
continue;
|
|
if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoInputs)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
// Using the clipped AABB, a child window will typically be clipped by its parent (not always)
|
|
ImRect bb(window->WindowRectClipped.Min - g.Style.TouchExtraPadding, window->WindowRectClipped.Max + g.Style.TouchExtraPadding);
|
|
if (bb.Contains(pos))
|
|
return window;
|
|
}
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Test if mouse cursor is hovering given rectangle
|
|
// NB- Rectangle is clipped by our current clip setting
|
|
// NB- Expand the rectangle to be generous on imprecise inputs systems (g.Style.TouchExtraPadding)
|
|
bool ImGui::IsMouseHoveringRect(const ImVec2& r_min, const ImVec2& r_max, bool clip)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
|
|
// Clip
|
|
ImRect rect_clipped(r_min, r_max);
|
|
if (clip)
|
|
rect_clipped.ClipWith(window->ClipRect);
|
|
|
|
// Expand for touch input
|
|
const ImRect rect_for_touch(rect_clipped.Min - g.Style.TouchExtraPadding, rect_clipped.Max + g.Style.TouchExtraPadding);
|
|
return rect_for_touch.Contains(g.IO.MousePos);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::IsAnyWindowHovered()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
return g.HoveredWindow != NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static bool IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey key, bool repeat)
|
|
{
|
|
const int key_index = GImGui->IO.KeyMap[key];
|
|
return (key_index >= 0) ? ImGui::IsKeyPressed(key_index, repeat) : false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
int ImGui::GetKeyIndex(ImGuiKey imgui_key)
|
|
{
|
|
IM_ASSERT(imgui_key >= 0 && imgui_key < ImGuiKey_COUNT);
|
|
return GImGui->IO.KeyMap[imgui_key];
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Note that imgui doesn't know the semantic of each entry of io.KeyDown[]. Use your own indices/enums according to how your backend/engine stored them into KeyDown[]!
|
|
bool ImGui::IsKeyDown(int user_key_index)
|
|
{
|
|
if (user_key_index < 0) return false;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(user_key_index >= 0 && user_key_index < IM_ARRAYSIZE(GImGui->IO.KeysDown));
|
|
return GImGui->IO.KeysDown[user_key_index];
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
int ImGui::CalcTypematicPressedRepeatAmount(float t, float t_prev, float repeat_delay, float repeat_rate)
|
|
{
|
|
if (t == 0.0f)
|
|
return 1;
|
|
if (t <= repeat_delay || repeat_rate <= 0.0f)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
const int count = (int)((t - repeat_delay) / repeat_rate) - (int)((t_prev - repeat_delay) / repeat_rate);
|
|
return (count > 0) ? count : 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
int ImGui::GetKeyPressedAmount(int key_index, float repeat_delay, float repeat_rate)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (key_index < 0) return false;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(key_index >= 0 && key_index < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.KeysDown));
|
|
const float t = g.IO.KeysDownDuration[key_index];
|
|
return CalcTypematicPressedRepeatAmount(t, t - g.IO.DeltaTime, repeat_delay, repeat_rate);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::IsKeyPressed(int user_key_index, bool repeat)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (user_key_index < 0) return false;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(user_key_index >= 0 && user_key_index < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.KeysDown));
|
|
const float t = g.IO.KeysDownDuration[user_key_index];
|
|
if (t == 0.0f)
|
|
return true;
|
|
if (repeat && t > g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay)
|
|
return GetKeyPressedAmount(user_key_index, g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay, g.IO.KeyRepeatRate) > 0;
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::IsKeyReleased(int user_key_index)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (user_key_index < 0) return false;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(user_key_index >= 0 && user_key_index < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.KeysDown));
|
|
if (g.IO.KeysDownDurationPrev[user_key_index] >= 0.0f && !g.IO.KeysDown[user_key_index])
|
|
return true;
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::IsMouseDown(int button)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(button >= 0 && button < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown));
|
|
return g.IO.MouseDown[button];
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::IsMouseClicked(int button, bool repeat)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(button >= 0 && button < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown));
|
|
const float t = g.IO.MouseDownDuration[button];
|
|
if (t == 0.0f)
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
if (repeat && t > g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay)
|
|
{
|
|
float delay = g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay, rate = g.IO.KeyRepeatRate;
|
|
if ((fmodf(t - delay, rate) > rate*0.5f) != (fmodf(t - delay - g.IO.DeltaTime, rate) > rate*0.5f))
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::IsMouseReleased(int button)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(button >= 0 && button < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown));
|
|
return g.IO.MouseReleased[button];
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::IsMouseDoubleClicked(int button)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(button >= 0 && button < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown));
|
|
return g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[button];
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::IsMouseDragging(int button, float lock_threshold)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(button >= 0 && button < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown));
|
|
if (!g.IO.MouseDown[button])
|
|
return false;
|
|
if (lock_threshold < 0.0f)
|
|
lock_threshold = g.IO.MouseDragThreshold;
|
|
return g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceSqr[button] >= lock_threshold * lock_threshold;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImVec2 ImGui::GetMousePos()
|
|
{
|
|
return GImGui->IO.MousePos;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// NB: prefer to call right after BeginPopup(). At the time Selectable/MenuItem is activated, the popup is already closed!
|
|
ImVec2 ImGui::GetMousePosOnOpeningCurrentPopup()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (g.CurrentPopupStack.Size > 0)
|
|
return g.OpenPopupStack[g.CurrentPopupStack.Size-1].MousePosOnOpen;
|
|
return g.IO.MousePos;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// We typically use ImVec2(-FLT_MAX,-FLT_MAX) to denote an invalid mouse position
|
|
bool ImGui::IsMousePosValid(const ImVec2* mouse_pos)
|
|
{
|
|
if (mouse_pos == NULL)
|
|
mouse_pos = &GImGui->IO.MousePos;
|
|
const float MOUSE_INVALID = -256000.0f;
|
|
return mouse_pos->x >= MOUSE_INVALID && mouse_pos->y >= MOUSE_INVALID;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImVec2 ImGui::GetMouseDragDelta(int button, float lock_threshold)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(button >= 0 && button < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown));
|
|
if (lock_threshold < 0.0f)
|
|
lock_threshold = g.IO.MouseDragThreshold;
|
|
if (g.IO.MouseDown[button])
|
|
if (g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceSqr[button] >= lock_threshold * lock_threshold)
|
|
return g.IO.MousePos - g.IO.MouseClickedPos[button]; // Assume we can only get active with left-mouse button (at the moment).
|
|
return ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::ResetMouseDragDelta(int button)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(button >= 0 && button < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown));
|
|
// NB: We don't need to reset g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceSqr
|
|
g.IO.MouseClickedPos[button] = g.IO.MousePos;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImGuiMouseCursor ImGui::GetMouseCursor()
|
|
{
|
|
return GImGui->MouseCursor;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetMouseCursor(ImGuiMouseCursor cursor_type)
|
|
{
|
|
GImGui->MouseCursor = cursor_type;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::CaptureKeyboardFromApp(bool capture)
|
|
{
|
|
GImGui->WantCaptureKeyboardNextFrame = capture ? 1 : 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::CaptureMouseFromApp(bool capture)
|
|
{
|
|
GImGui->WantCaptureMouseNextFrame = capture ? 1 : 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::IsItemActive()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (g.ActiveId)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
return g.ActiveId == window->DC.LastItemId;
|
|
}
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::IsItemClicked(int mouse_button)
|
|
{
|
|
return IsMouseClicked(mouse_button) && IsItemHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_Default);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::IsAnyItemHovered()
|
|
{
|
|
return GImGui->HoveredId != 0 || GImGui->HoveredIdPreviousFrame != 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::IsAnyItemActive()
|
|
{
|
|
return GImGui->ActiveId != 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::IsItemVisible()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
return window->ClipRect.Overlaps(window->DC.LastItemRect);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Allow last item to be overlapped by a subsequent item. Both may be activated during the same frame before the later one takes priority.
|
|
void ImGui::SetItemAllowOverlap()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (g.HoveredId == g.CurrentWindow->DC.LastItemId)
|
|
g.HoveredIdAllowOverlap = true;
|
|
if (g.ActiveId == g.CurrentWindow->DC.LastItemId)
|
|
g.ActiveIdAllowOverlap = true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImVec2 ImGui::GetItemRectMin()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
return window->DC.LastItemRect.Min;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImVec2 ImGui::GetItemRectMax()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
return window->DC.LastItemRect.Max;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImVec2 ImGui::GetItemRectSize()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
return window->DC.LastItemRect.GetSize();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImVec2 ImGui::CalcItemRectClosestPoint(const ImVec2& pos, bool on_edge, float outward)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
ImRect rect = window->DC.LastItemRect;
|
|
rect.Expand(outward);
|
|
return rect.GetClosestPoint(pos, on_edge);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static ImRect GetVisibleRect()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (g.IO.DisplayVisibleMin.x != g.IO.DisplayVisibleMax.x && g.IO.DisplayVisibleMin.y != g.IO.DisplayVisibleMax.y)
|
|
return ImRect(g.IO.DisplayVisibleMin, g.IO.DisplayVisibleMax);
|
|
return ImRect(0.0f, 0.0f, g.IO.DisplaySize.x, g.IO.DisplaySize.y);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Not exposed publicly as BeginTooltip() because bool parameters are evil. Let's see if other needs arise first.
|
|
void ImGui::BeginTooltipEx(ImGuiWindowFlags extra_flags, bool override_previous_tooltip)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
char window_name[16];
|
|
ImFormatString(window_name, IM_ARRAYSIZE(window_name), "##Tooltip%02d", g.TooltipOverrideCount);
|
|
if (override_previous_tooltip)
|
|
if (ImGuiWindow* window = FindWindowByName(window_name))
|
|
if (window->Active)
|
|
{
|
|
// Hide previous tooltips. We can't easily "reset" the content of a window so we create a new one.
|
|
window->HiddenFrames = 1;
|
|
ImFormatString(window_name, IM_ARRAYSIZE(window_name), "##Tooltip%02d", ++g.TooltipOverrideCount);
|
|
}
|
|
ImGuiWindowFlags flags = ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings|ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize;
|
|
Begin(window_name, NULL, flags | extra_flags);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetTooltipV(const char* fmt, va_list args)
|
|
{
|
|
BeginTooltipEx(0, true);
|
|
TextV(fmt, args);
|
|
EndTooltip();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetTooltip(const char* fmt, ...)
|
|
{
|
|
va_list args;
|
|
va_start(args, fmt);
|
|
SetTooltipV(fmt, args);
|
|
va_end(args);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::BeginTooltip()
|
|
{
|
|
BeginTooltipEx(0, false);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::EndTooltip()
|
|
{
|
|
IM_ASSERT(GetCurrentWindowRead()->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip); // Mismatched BeginTooltip()/EndTooltip() calls
|
|
ImGui::End();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Mark popup as open (toggle toward open state).
|
|
// Popups are closed when user click outside, or activate a pressable item, or CloseCurrentPopup() is called within a BeginPopup()/EndPopup() block.
|
|
// Popup identifiers are relative to the current ID-stack (so OpenPopup and BeginPopup needs to be at the same level).
|
|
// One open popup per level of the popup hierarchy (NB: when assigning we reset the Window member of ImGuiPopupRef to NULL)
|
|
void ImGui::OpenPopupEx(ImGuiID id, bool reopen_existing)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
int current_stack_size = g.CurrentPopupStack.Size;
|
|
ImGuiPopupRef popup_ref = ImGuiPopupRef(id, window, window->GetID("##menus"), g.IO.MousePos); // Tagged as new ref because constructor sets Window to NULL (we are passing the ParentWindow info here)
|
|
if (g.OpenPopupStack.Size < current_stack_size + 1)
|
|
g.OpenPopupStack.push_back(popup_ref);
|
|
else if (reopen_existing || g.OpenPopupStack[current_stack_size].PopupId != id)
|
|
{
|
|
g.OpenPopupStack.resize(current_stack_size+1);
|
|
g.OpenPopupStack[current_stack_size] = popup_ref;
|
|
|
|
// When reopening a popup we first refocus its parent, otherwise if its parent is itself a popup it would get closed by CloseInactivePopups().
|
|
// This is equivalent to what ClosePopupToLevel() does.
|
|
if (g.OpenPopupStack[current_stack_size].PopupId == id)
|
|
FocusWindow(window);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::OpenPopup(const char* str_id)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
OpenPopupEx(g.CurrentWindow->GetID(str_id), false);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void CloseInactivePopups(ImGuiWindow* ref_window)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (g.OpenPopupStack.empty())
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
// When popups are stacked, clicking on a lower level popups puts focus back to it and close popups above it.
|
|
// Don't close our own child popup windows.
|
|
int n = 0;
|
|
if (ref_window)
|
|
{
|
|
for (n = 0; n < g.OpenPopupStack.Size; n++)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiPopupRef& popup = g.OpenPopupStack[n];
|
|
if (!popup.Window)
|
|
continue;
|
|
IM_ASSERT((popup.Window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) != 0);
|
|
if (popup.Window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
// Trim the stack if popups are not direct descendant of the reference window (which is often the NavWindow)
|
|
bool has_focus = false;
|
|
for (int m = n; m < g.OpenPopupStack.Size && !has_focus; m++)
|
|
has_focus = (g.OpenPopupStack[m].Window && g.OpenPopupStack[m].Window->RootWindow == ref_window->RootWindow);
|
|
if (!has_focus)
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if (n < g.OpenPopupStack.Size) // This test is not required but it allows to set a convenient breakpoint on the block below
|
|
ClosePopupToLevel(n);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static ImGuiWindow* GetFrontMostModalRootWindow()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
for (int n = g.OpenPopupStack.Size-1; n >= 0; n--)
|
|
if (ImGuiWindow* popup = g.OpenPopupStack.Data[n].Window)
|
|
if (popup->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal)
|
|
return popup;
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void ClosePopupToLevel(int remaining)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (remaining > 0)
|
|
ImGui::FocusWindow(g.OpenPopupStack[remaining-1].Window);
|
|
else
|
|
ImGui::FocusWindow(g.OpenPopupStack[0].ParentWindow);
|
|
g.OpenPopupStack.resize(remaining);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::ClosePopup(ImGuiID id)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!IsPopupOpen(id))
|
|
return;
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ClosePopupToLevel(g.OpenPopupStack.Size - 1);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Close the popup we have begin-ed into.
|
|
void ImGui::CloseCurrentPopup()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
int popup_idx = g.CurrentPopupStack.Size - 1;
|
|
if (popup_idx < 0 || popup_idx >= g.OpenPopupStack.Size || g.CurrentPopupStack[popup_idx].PopupId != g.OpenPopupStack[popup_idx].PopupId)
|
|
return;
|
|
while (popup_idx > 0 && g.OpenPopupStack[popup_idx].Window && (g.OpenPopupStack[popup_idx].Window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu))
|
|
popup_idx--;
|
|
ClosePopupToLevel(popup_idx);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static inline void ClearSetNextWindowData()
|
|
{
|
|
// FIXME-OPT
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
g.SetNextWindowPosCond = g.SetNextWindowSizeCond = g.SetNextWindowContentSizeCond = g.SetNextWindowCollapsedCond = 0;
|
|
g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraint = g.SetNextWindowFocus = false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::BeginPopupEx(ImGuiID id, ImGuiWindowFlags extra_flags)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (!IsPopupOpen(id))
|
|
{
|
|
ClearSetNextWindowData(); // We behave like Begin() and need to consume those values
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImGuiWindowFlags flags = extra_flags|ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings;
|
|
|
|
char name[20];
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu)
|
|
ImFormatString(name, IM_ARRAYSIZE(name), "##menu_%d", g.CurrentPopupStack.Size); // Recycle windows based on depth
|
|
else
|
|
ImFormatString(name, IM_ARRAYSIZE(name), "##popup_%08x", id); // Not recycling, so we can close/open during the same frame
|
|
|
|
bool is_open = Begin(name, NULL, flags);
|
|
if (!is_open) // NB: Begin can return false when the popup is completely clipped (e.g. zero size display)
|
|
EndPopup();
|
|
|
|
return is_open;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::BeginPopup(const char* str_id)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (g.OpenPopupStack.Size <= g.CurrentPopupStack.Size) // Early out for performance
|
|
{
|
|
ClearSetNextWindowData(); // We behave like Begin() and need to consume those values
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
return BeginPopupEx(g.CurrentWindow->GetID(str_id), ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::IsPopupOpen(ImGuiID id)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
return g.OpenPopupStack.Size > g.CurrentPopupStack.Size && g.OpenPopupStack[g.CurrentPopupStack.Size].PopupId == id;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::IsPopupOpen(const char* str_id)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
return g.OpenPopupStack.Size > g.CurrentPopupStack.Size && g.OpenPopupStack[g.CurrentPopupStack.Size].PopupId == g.CurrentWindow->GetID(str_id);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::BeginPopupModal(const char* name, bool* p_open, ImGuiWindowFlags extra_flags)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(name);
|
|
if (!IsPopupOpen(id))
|
|
{
|
|
ClearSetNextWindowData(); // We behave like Begin() and need to consume those values
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Center modal windows by default
|
|
if ((window->SetWindowPosAllowFlags & g.SetNextWindowPosCond) == 0)
|
|
SetNextWindowPos(g.IO.DisplaySize * 0.5f, ImGuiCond_Appearing, ImVec2(0.5f, 0.5f));
|
|
|
|
ImGuiWindowFlags flags = extra_flags|ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup|ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoCollapse|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings;
|
|
bool is_open = Begin(name, p_open, flags);
|
|
if (!is_open || (p_open && !*p_open)) // NB: is_open can be 'false' when the popup is completely clipped (e.g. zero size display)
|
|
{
|
|
EndPopup();
|
|
if (is_open)
|
|
ClosePopup(id);
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return is_open;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::EndPopup()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; (void)g;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(g.CurrentWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup); // Mismatched BeginPopup()/EndPopup() calls
|
|
IM_ASSERT(g.CurrentPopupStack.Size > 0);
|
|
End();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::OpenPopupOnItemClick(const char* str_id, int mouse_button)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow;
|
|
if (IsMouseClicked(mouse_button) && IsItemHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByPopup))
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiID id = str_id ? window->GetID(str_id) : window->DC.LastItemId; // If user hasn't passed an ID, we can use the LastItemID. Using LastItemID as a Popup ID won't conflict!
|
|
IM_ASSERT(id != 0); // However, you cannot pass a NULL str_id if the last item has no identifier (e.g. a Text() item)
|
|
OpenPopupEx(id, true);
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// This is a helper to handle the simplest case of associating one named popup to one given widget.
|
|
// You may want to handle this on user side if you have specific needs (e.g. tweaking IsItemHovered() parameters).
|
|
// You can pass a NULL str_id to use the identifier of the last item.
|
|
bool ImGui::BeginPopupContextItem(const char* str_id, int mouse_button)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow;
|
|
ImGuiID id = str_id ? window->GetID(str_id) : window->DC.LastItemId; // If user hasn't passed an ID, we can use the LastItemID. Using LastItemID as a Popup ID won't conflict!
|
|
IM_ASSERT(id != 0); // However, you cannot pass a NULL str_id if the last item has no identifier (e.g. a Text() item)
|
|
if (IsMouseClicked(mouse_button) && IsItemHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByPopup))
|
|
OpenPopupEx(id, true);
|
|
return BeginPopupEx(id, ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::BeginPopupContextWindow(const char* str_id, int mouse_button, bool also_over_items)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!str_id)
|
|
str_id = "window_context";
|
|
ImGuiID id = GImGui->CurrentWindow->GetID(str_id);
|
|
if (IsMouseClicked(mouse_button))
|
|
if (IsWindowHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByPopup))
|
|
if (also_over_items || !IsAnyItemHovered())
|
|
OpenPopupEx(id, true);
|
|
return BeginPopupEx(id, ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::BeginPopupContextVoid(const char* str_id, int mouse_button)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!str_id)
|
|
str_id = "void_context";
|
|
ImGuiID id = GImGui->CurrentWindow->GetID(str_id);
|
|
if (!IsAnyWindowHovered() && IsMouseClicked(mouse_button))
|
|
OpenPopupEx(id, true);
|
|
return BeginPopupEx(id, ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static bool BeginChildEx(const char* name, ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& size_arg, bool border, ImGuiWindowFlags extra_flags)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* parent_window = ImGui::GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
ImGuiWindowFlags flags = ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings|ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow;
|
|
flags |= (parent_window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove); // Inherit the NoMove flag
|
|
|
|
const ImVec2 content_avail = ImGui::GetContentRegionAvail();
|
|
ImVec2 size = ImFloor(size_arg);
|
|
const int auto_fit_axises = ((size.x == 0.0f) ? (1 << ImGuiAxis_X) : 0x00) | ((size.y == 0.0f) ? (1 << ImGuiAxis_Y) : 0x00);
|
|
if (size.x <= 0.0f)
|
|
size.x = ImMax(content_avail.x, 4.0f) - fabsf(size.x); // Arbitrary minimum zero-ish child size of 4.0f (0.0f causing too much issues)
|
|
if (size.y <= 0.0f)
|
|
size.y = ImMax(content_avail.y, 4.0f) - fabsf(size.y);
|
|
|
|
const float backup_border_size = g.Style.ChildBorderSize;
|
|
if (!border)
|
|
g.Style.ChildBorderSize = 0.0f;
|
|
flags |= extra_flags;
|
|
|
|
char title[256];
|
|
if (name)
|
|
ImFormatString(title, IM_ARRAYSIZE(title), "%s/%s_%08X", parent_window->Name, name, id);
|
|
else
|
|
ImFormatString(title, IM_ARRAYSIZE(title), "%s/%08X", parent_window->Name, id);
|
|
|
|
ImGui::SetNextWindowSize(size);
|
|
bool ret = ImGui::Begin(title, NULL, flags);
|
|
ImGuiWindow* child_window = ImGui::GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
child_window->AutoFitChildAxises = auto_fit_axises;
|
|
g.Style.ChildBorderSize = backup_border_size;
|
|
|
|
return ret;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::BeginChild(const char* str_id, const ImVec2& size_arg, bool border, ImGuiWindowFlags extra_flags)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
return BeginChildEx(str_id, window->GetID(str_id), size_arg, border, extra_flags);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::BeginChild(ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& size_arg, bool border, ImGuiWindowFlags extra_flags)
|
|
{
|
|
return BeginChildEx(NULL, id, size_arg, border, extra_flags);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::EndChild()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
|
|
IM_ASSERT(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow); // Mismatched BeginChild()/EndChild() callss
|
|
if ((window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ComboBox) || window->BeginCount > 1)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGui::End();
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// When using auto-filling child window, we don't provide full width/height to ItemSize so that it doesn't feed back into automatic size-fitting.
|
|
ImVec2 sz = GetWindowSize();
|
|
if (window->AutoFitChildAxises & (1 << ImGuiAxis_X)) // Arbitrary minimum zero-ish child size of 4.0f causes less trouble than a 0.0f
|
|
sz.x = ImMax(4.0f, sz.x);
|
|
if (window->AutoFitChildAxises & (1 << ImGuiAxis_Y))
|
|
sz.y = ImMax(4.0f, sz.y);
|
|
ImGui::End();
|
|
|
|
ImGuiWindow* parent_window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
ImRect bb(parent_window->DC.CursorPos, parent_window->DC.CursorPos + sz);
|
|
ItemSize(sz);
|
|
ItemAdd(bb, 0);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Helper to create a child window / scrolling region that looks like a normal widget frame.
|
|
bool ImGui::BeginChildFrame(ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiWindowFlags extra_flags)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_ChildBg, style.Colors[ImGuiCol_FrameBg]);
|
|
PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ChildRounding, style.FrameRounding);
|
|
PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ChildBorderSize, style.FrameBorderSize);
|
|
PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_WindowPadding, style.FramePadding);
|
|
return BeginChild(id, size, true, ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove | ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysUseWindowPadding | extra_flags);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::EndChildFrame()
|
|
{
|
|
EndChild();
|
|
PopStyleVar(3);
|
|
PopStyleColor();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Save and compare stack sizes on Begin()/End() to detect usage errors
|
|
static void CheckStacksSize(ImGuiWindow* window, bool write)
|
|
{
|
|
// NOT checking: DC.ItemWidth, DC.AllowKeyboardFocus, DC.ButtonRepeat, DC.TextWrapPos (per window) to allow user to conveniently push once and not pop (they are cleared on Begin)
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
int* p_backup = &window->DC.StackSizesBackup[0];
|
|
{ int current = window->IDStack.Size; if (write) *p_backup = current; else IM_ASSERT(*p_backup == current && "PushID/PopID or TreeNode/TreePop Mismatch!"); p_backup++; } // Too few or too many PopID()/TreePop()
|
|
{ int current = window->DC.GroupStack.Size; if (write) *p_backup = current; else IM_ASSERT(*p_backup == current && "BeginGroup/EndGroup Mismatch!"); p_backup++; } // Too few or too many EndGroup()
|
|
{ int current = g.CurrentPopupStack.Size; if (write) *p_backup = current; else IM_ASSERT(*p_backup == current && "BeginMenu/EndMenu or BeginPopup/EndPopup Mismatch"); p_backup++;}// Too few or too many EndMenu()/EndPopup()
|
|
{ int current = g.ColorModifiers.Size; if (write) *p_backup = current; else IM_ASSERT(*p_backup == current && "PushStyleColor/PopStyleColor Mismatch!"); p_backup++; } // Too few or too many PopStyleColor()
|
|
{ int current = g.StyleModifiers.Size; if (write) *p_backup = current; else IM_ASSERT(*p_backup == current && "PushStyleVar/PopStyleVar Mismatch!"); p_backup++; } // Too few or too many PopStyleVar()
|
|
{ int current = g.FontStack.Size; if (write) *p_backup = current; else IM_ASSERT(*p_backup == current && "PushFont/PopFont Mismatch!"); p_backup++; } // Too few or too many PopFont()
|
|
IM_ASSERT(p_backup == window->DC.StackSizesBackup + IM_ARRAYSIZE(window->DC.StackSizesBackup));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static ImVec2 FindBestWindowPosForPopup(const ImVec2& base_pos, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiDir* last_dir, const ImRect& r_avoid, ImGuiWindowFlags flags)
|
|
{
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = GImGui->Style;
|
|
|
|
// r_avoid = the rectangle to avoid (e.g. for tooltip it is a rectangle around the mouse cursor which we want to avoid. for popups it's a small point around the cursor.)
|
|
// r_outer = the visible area rectangle, minus safe area padding. If our popup size won't fit because of safe area padding we ignore it.
|
|
ImVec2 safe_padding = style.DisplaySafeAreaPadding;
|
|
ImRect r_outer(GetVisibleRect());
|
|
r_outer.Expand(ImVec2((size.x - r_outer.GetWidth() > safe_padding.x*2) ? -safe_padding.x : 0.0f, (size.y - r_outer.GetHeight() > safe_padding.y*2) ? -safe_padding.y : 0.0f));
|
|
ImVec2 base_pos_clamped = ImClamp(base_pos, r_outer.Min, r_outer.Max - size);
|
|
//GImGui->OverlayDrawList.AddRect(r_avoid.Min, r_avoid.Max, IM_COL32(255,0,0,255));
|
|
//GImGui->OverlayDrawList.AddRect(r_outer.Min, r_outer.Max, IM_COL32(0,255,0,255));
|
|
|
|
// Combo Box policy (we want a connecting edge)
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ComboBox)
|
|
{
|
|
const ImGuiDir dir_prefered_order[ImGuiDir_Count_] = { ImGuiDir_Down, ImGuiDir_Right, ImGuiDir_Left, ImGuiDir_Up };
|
|
for (int n = (*last_dir != ImGuiDir_None) ? -1 : 0; n < ImGuiDir_Count_; n++)
|
|
{
|
|
const ImGuiDir dir = (n == -1) ? *last_dir : dir_prefered_order[n];
|
|
if (n != -1 && dir == *last_dir) // Already tried this direction?
|
|
continue;
|
|
ImVec2 pos;
|
|
if (dir == ImGuiDir_Down) pos = ImVec2(r_avoid.Min.x, r_avoid.Max.y); // Below, Toward Right (default)
|
|
if (dir == ImGuiDir_Right) pos = ImVec2(r_avoid.Min.x, r_avoid.Min.y - size.y); // Above, Toward Right
|
|
if (dir == ImGuiDir_Left) pos = ImVec2(r_avoid.Max.x - size.x, r_avoid.Max.y); // Below, Toward Left
|
|
if (dir == ImGuiDir_Up) pos = ImVec2(r_avoid.Max.x - size.x, r_avoid.Min.y - size.y); // Above, Toward Left
|
|
if (!r_outer.Contains(ImRect(pos, pos + size)))
|
|
continue;
|
|
*last_dir = dir;
|
|
return pos;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Default popup policy
|
|
const ImGuiDir dir_prefered_order[ImGuiDir_Count_] = { ImGuiDir_Right, ImGuiDir_Down, ImGuiDir_Up, ImGuiDir_Left };
|
|
for (int n = (*last_dir != ImGuiDir_None) ? -1 : 0; n < ImGuiDir_Count_; n++)
|
|
{
|
|
const ImGuiDir dir = (n == -1) ? *last_dir : dir_prefered_order[n];
|
|
if (n != -1 && dir == *last_dir) // Already tried this direction?
|
|
continue;
|
|
float avail_w = (dir == ImGuiDir_Left ? r_avoid.Min.x : r_outer.Max.x) - (dir == ImGuiDir_Right ? r_avoid.Max.x : r_outer.Min.x);
|
|
float avail_h = (dir == ImGuiDir_Up ? r_avoid.Min.y : r_outer.Max.y) - (dir == ImGuiDir_Down ? r_avoid.Max.y : r_outer.Min.y);
|
|
if (avail_w < size.x || avail_h < size.y)
|
|
continue;
|
|
ImVec2 pos;
|
|
pos.x = (dir == ImGuiDir_Left) ? r_avoid.Min.x - size.x : (dir == ImGuiDir_Right) ? r_avoid.Max.x : base_pos_clamped.x;
|
|
pos.y = (dir == ImGuiDir_Up) ? r_avoid.Min.y - size.y : (dir == ImGuiDir_Down) ? r_avoid.Max.y : base_pos_clamped.y;
|
|
*last_dir = dir;
|
|
return pos;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Fallback, try to keep within display
|
|
*last_dir = ImGuiDir_None;
|
|
ImVec2 pos = base_pos;
|
|
pos.x = ImMax(ImMin(pos.x + size.x, r_outer.Max.x) - size.x, r_outer.Min.x);
|
|
pos.y = ImMax(ImMin(pos.y + size.y, r_outer.Max.y) - size.y, r_outer.Min.y);
|
|
return pos;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void SetWindowConditionAllowFlags(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiCond flags, bool enabled)
|
|
{
|
|
window->SetWindowPosAllowFlags = enabled ? (window->SetWindowPosAllowFlags | flags) : (window->SetWindowPosAllowFlags & ~flags);
|
|
window->SetWindowSizeAllowFlags = enabled ? (window->SetWindowSizeAllowFlags | flags) : (window->SetWindowSizeAllowFlags & ~flags);
|
|
window->SetWindowCollapsedAllowFlags = enabled ? (window->SetWindowCollapsedAllowFlags | flags) : (window->SetWindowCollapsedAllowFlags & ~flags);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImGuiWindow* ImGui::FindWindowByName(const char* name)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiID id = ImHash(name, 0);
|
|
return (ImGuiWindow*)g.WindowsById.GetVoidPtr(id);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static ImGuiWindow* CreateNewWindow(const char* name, ImVec2 size, ImGuiWindowFlags flags)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
|
|
// Create window the first time
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = (ImGuiWindow*)ImGui::MemAlloc(sizeof(ImGuiWindow));
|
|
IM_PLACEMENT_NEW(window) ImGuiWindow(name);
|
|
window->Flags = flags;
|
|
g.WindowsById.SetVoidPtr(window->ID, window);
|
|
|
|
// User can disable loading and saving of settings. Tooltip and child windows also don't store settings.
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings))
|
|
{
|
|
// Retrieve settings from .ini file
|
|
// Use SetWindowPos() or SetNextWindowPos() with the appropriate condition flag to change the initial position of a window.
|
|
window->PosFloat = ImVec2(60, 60);
|
|
window->Pos = ImVec2((float)(int)window->PosFloat.x, (float)(int)window->PosFloat.y);
|
|
|
|
if (ImGuiWindowSettings* settings = ImGui::FindWindowSettings(window->ID))
|
|
{
|
|
SetWindowConditionAllowFlags(window, ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver, false);
|
|
window->PosFloat = settings->Pos;
|
|
window->Pos = ImVec2((float)(int)window->PosFloat.x, (float)(int)window->PosFloat.y);
|
|
window->Collapsed = settings->Collapsed;
|
|
if (ImLengthSqr(settings->Size) > 0.00001f)
|
|
size = settings->Size;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
window->Size = window->SizeFull = window->SizeFullAtLastBegin = size;
|
|
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize) != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
window->AutoFitFramesX = window->AutoFitFramesY = 2;
|
|
window->AutoFitOnlyGrows = false;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if (window->Size.x <= 0.0f)
|
|
window->AutoFitFramesX = 2;
|
|
if (window->Size.y <= 0.0f)
|
|
window->AutoFitFramesY = 2;
|
|
window->AutoFitOnlyGrows = (window->AutoFitFramesX > 0) || (window->AutoFitFramesY > 0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoBringToFrontOnFocus)
|
|
g.Windows.insert(g.Windows.begin(), window); // Quite slow but rare and only once
|
|
else
|
|
g.Windows.push_back(window);
|
|
return window;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static ImVec2 CalcSizeAfterConstraint(ImGuiWindow* window, ImVec2 new_size)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraint)
|
|
{
|
|
// Using -1,-1 on either X/Y axis to preserve the current size.
|
|
ImRect cr = g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraintRect;
|
|
new_size.x = (cr.Min.x >= 0 && cr.Max.x >= 0) ? ImClamp(new_size.x, cr.Min.x, cr.Max.x) : window->SizeFull.x;
|
|
new_size.y = (cr.Min.y >= 0 && cr.Max.y >= 0) ? ImClamp(new_size.y, cr.Min.y, cr.Max.y) : window->SizeFull.y;
|
|
if (g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraintCallback)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiSizeConstraintCallbackData data;
|
|
data.UserData = g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraintCallbackUserData;
|
|
data.Pos = window->Pos;
|
|
data.CurrentSize = window->SizeFull;
|
|
data.DesiredSize = new_size;
|
|
g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraintCallback(&data);
|
|
new_size = data.DesiredSize;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Minimum size
|
|
if (!(window->Flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow | ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize)))
|
|
{
|
|
new_size = ImMax(new_size, g.Style.WindowMinSize);
|
|
new_size.y = ImMax(new_size.y, window->TitleBarHeight() + window->MenuBarHeight() + ImMax(0.0f, g.Style.WindowRounding - 1.0f)); // Reduce artifacts with very small windows
|
|
}
|
|
return new_size;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static ImVec2 CalcSizeContents(ImGuiWindow* window)
|
|
{
|
|
ImVec2 sz;
|
|
sz.x = (float)(int)((window->SizeContentsExplicit.x != 0.0f) ? window->SizeContentsExplicit.x : (window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x - window->Pos.x + window->Scroll.x));
|
|
sz.y = (float)(int)((window->SizeContentsExplicit.y != 0.0f) ? window->SizeContentsExplicit.y : (window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y - window->Pos.y + window->Scroll.y));
|
|
return sz + window->WindowPadding;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static ImVec2 CalcSizeAutoFit(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImVec2& size_contents)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
ImGuiWindowFlags flags = window->Flags;
|
|
ImVec2 size_auto_fit;
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip) != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
// Tooltip always resize. We keep the spacing symmetric on both axises for aesthetic purpose.
|
|
size_auto_fit = size_contents;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// Handling case of auto fit window not fitting on the screen (on either axis): we are growing the size on the other axis to compensate for expected scrollbar. FIXME: Might turn bigger than DisplaySize-WindowPadding.
|
|
size_auto_fit = ImClamp(size_contents, style.WindowMinSize, ImMax(style.WindowMinSize, g.IO.DisplaySize - g.Style.DisplaySafeAreaPadding));
|
|
ImVec2 size_auto_fit_after_constraint = CalcSizeAfterConstraint(window, size_auto_fit);
|
|
if (size_auto_fit_after_constraint.x < size_contents.x && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar) && (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar))
|
|
size_auto_fit.y += style.ScrollbarSize;
|
|
if (size_auto_fit_after_constraint.y < size_contents.y && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar))
|
|
size_auto_fit.x += style.ScrollbarSize;
|
|
}
|
|
return size_auto_fit;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static float GetScrollMaxX(ImGuiWindow* window)
|
|
{
|
|
return ImMax(0.0f, window->SizeContents.x - (window->SizeFull.x - window->ScrollbarSizes.x));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static float GetScrollMaxY(ImGuiWindow* window)
|
|
{
|
|
return ImMax(0.0f, window->SizeContents.y - (window->SizeFull.y - window->ScrollbarSizes.y));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static ImVec2 CalcNextScrollFromScrollTargetAndClamp(ImGuiWindow* window)
|
|
{
|
|
ImVec2 scroll = window->Scroll;
|
|
float cr_x = window->ScrollTargetCenterRatio.x;
|
|
float cr_y = window->ScrollTargetCenterRatio.y;
|
|
if (window->ScrollTarget.x < FLT_MAX)
|
|
scroll.x = window->ScrollTarget.x - cr_x * (window->SizeFull.x - window->ScrollbarSizes.x);
|
|
if (window->ScrollTarget.y < FLT_MAX)
|
|
scroll.y = window->ScrollTarget.y - (1.0f - cr_y) * (window->TitleBarHeight() + window->MenuBarHeight()) - cr_y * (window->SizeFull.y - window->ScrollbarSizes.y);
|
|
scroll = ImMax(scroll, ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f));
|
|
if (!window->Collapsed && !window->SkipItems)
|
|
{
|
|
scroll.x = ImMin(scroll.x, GetScrollMaxX(window));
|
|
scroll.y = ImMin(scroll.y, GetScrollMaxY(window));
|
|
}
|
|
return scroll;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static ImGuiCol GetWindowBgColorIdxFromFlags(ImGuiWindowFlags flags)
|
|
{
|
|
if (flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip | ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup))
|
|
return ImGuiCol_PopupBg;
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow)
|
|
return ImGuiCol_ChildBg;
|
|
return ImGuiCol_WindowBg;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void CalcResizePosSizeFromAnyCorner(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImVec2& corner_target, const ImVec2& corner_norm, ImVec2* out_pos, ImVec2* out_size)
|
|
{
|
|
ImVec2 pos_min = ImLerp(corner_target, window->Pos, corner_norm); // Expected window upper-left
|
|
ImVec2 pos_max = ImLerp(window->Pos + window->Size, corner_target, corner_norm); // Expected window lower-right
|
|
ImVec2 size_expected = pos_max - pos_min;
|
|
ImVec2 size_constrained = CalcSizeAfterConstraint(window, size_expected);
|
|
*out_pos = pos_min;
|
|
if (corner_norm.x == 0.0f)
|
|
out_pos->x -= (size_constrained.x - size_expected.x);
|
|
if (corner_norm.y == 0.0f)
|
|
out_pos->y -= (size_constrained.y - size_expected.y);
|
|
*out_size = size_constrained;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
struct ImGuiResizeGripDef
|
|
{
|
|
ImVec2 CornerPos;
|
|
ImVec2 InnerDir;
|
|
int AngleMin12, AngleMax12;
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
const ImGuiResizeGripDef resize_grip_def[4] =
|
|
{
|
|
{ ImVec2(1,1), ImVec2(-1,-1), 0, 3 }, // Lower right
|
|
{ ImVec2(0,1), ImVec2(+1,-1), 3, 6 }, // Lower left
|
|
{ ImVec2(0,0), ImVec2(+1,+1), 6, 9 }, // Upper left
|
|
{ ImVec2(1,0), ImVec2(-1,+1), 9,12 }, // Upper right
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
static ImRect GetBorderRect(ImGuiWindow* window, int border_n, float perp_padding, float thickness)
|
|
{
|
|
ImRect rect = window->Rect();
|
|
if (thickness == 0.0f) rect.Max -= ImVec2(1,1);
|
|
if (border_n == 0) return ImRect(rect.Min.x + perp_padding, rect.Min.y, rect.Max.x - perp_padding, rect.Min.y + thickness);
|
|
if (border_n == 1) return ImRect(rect.Max.x - thickness, rect.Min.y + perp_padding, rect.Max.x, rect.Max.y - perp_padding);
|
|
if (border_n == 2) return ImRect(rect.Min.x + perp_padding, rect.Max.y - thickness, rect.Max.x - perp_padding, rect.Max.y);
|
|
if (border_n == 3) return ImRect(rect.Min.x, rect.Min.y + perp_padding, rect.Min.x + thickness, rect.Max.y - perp_padding);
|
|
IM_ASSERT(0);
|
|
return ImRect();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Push a new ImGui window to add widgets to.
|
|
// - A default window called "Debug" is automatically stacked at the beginning of every frame so you can use widgets without explicitly calling a Begin/End pair.
|
|
// - Begin/End can be called multiple times during the frame with the same window name to append content.
|
|
// - The window name is used as a unique identifier to preserve window information across frames (and save rudimentary information to the .ini file).
|
|
// You can use the "##" or "###" markers to use the same label with different id, or same id with different label. See documentation at the top of this file.
|
|
// - Return false when window is collapsed, so you can early out in your code. You always need to call ImGui::End() even if false is returned.
|
|
// - Passing 'bool* p_open' displays a Close button on the upper-right corner of the window, the pointed value will be set to false when the button is pressed.
|
|
bool ImGui::Begin(const char* name, bool* p_open, ImGuiWindowFlags flags)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(name != NULL); // Window name required
|
|
IM_ASSERT(g.Initialized); // Forgot to call ImGui::NewFrame()
|
|
IM_ASSERT(g.FrameCountEnded != g.FrameCount); // Called ImGui::Render() or ImGui::EndFrame() and haven't called ImGui::NewFrame() again yet
|
|
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoInputs)
|
|
flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize;
|
|
|
|
// Find or create
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = FindWindowByName(name);
|
|
if (!window)
|
|
{
|
|
ImVec2 size_on_first_use = (g.SetNextWindowSizeCond != 0) ? g.SetNextWindowSizeVal : ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); // Any condition flag will do since we are creating a new window here.
|
|
window = CreateNewWindow(name, size_on_first_use, flags);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const int current_frame = g.FrameCount;
|
|
const bool first_begin_of_the_frame = (window->LastFrameActive != current_frame);
|
|
if (first_begin_of_the_frame)
|
|
window->Flags = (ImGuiWindowFlags)flags;
|
|
else
|
|
flags = window->Flags;
|
|
|
|
// Update the Appearing flag
|
|
bool window_just_activated_by_user = (window->LastFrameActive < current_frame - 1); // Not using !WasActive because the implicit "Debug" window would always toggle off->on
|
|
const bool window_just_appearing_after_hidden_for_resize = (window->HiddenFrames == 1);
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiPopupRef& popup_ref = g.OpenPopupStack[g.CurrentPopupStack.Size];
|
|
window_just_activated_by_user |= (window->PopupId != popup_ref.PopupId); // We recycle popups so treat window as activated if popup id changed
|
|
window_just_activated_by_user |= (window != popup_ref.Window);
|
|
}
|
|
window->Appearing = (window_just_activated_by_user || window_just_appearing_after_hidden_for_resize);
|
|
window->CloseButton = (p_open != NULL);
|
|
if (window->Appearing)
|
|
SetWindowConditionAllowFlags(window, ImGuiCond_Appearing, true);
|
|
|
|
// Parent window is latched only on the first call to Begin() of the frame, so further append-calls can be done from a different window stack
|
|
ImGuiWindow* parent_window = first_begin_of_the_frame ? (!g.CurrentWindowStack.empty() ? g.CurrentWindowStack.back() : NULL) : window->ParentWindow;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(parent_window != NULL || !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow));
|
|
|
|
// Add to stack
|
|
g.CurrentWindowStack.push_back(window);
|
|
SetCurrentWindow(window);
|
|
CheckStacksSize(window, true);
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiPopupRef& popup_ref = g.OpenPopupStack[g.CurrentPopupStack.Size];
|
|
popup_ref.Window = window;
|
|
g.CurrentPopupStack.push_back(popup_ref);
|
|
window->PopupId = popup_ref.PopupId;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Process SetNextWindow***() calls
|
|
bool window_pos_set_by_api = false;
|
|
bool window_size_x_set_by_api = false, window_size_y_set_by_api = false;
|
|
if (g.SetNextWindowPosCond)
|
|
{
|
|
window_pos_set_by_api = (window->SetWindowPosAllowFlags & g.SetNextWindowPosCond) != 0;
|
|
if (window_pos_set_by_api && ImLengthSqr(g.SetNextWindowPosPivot) > 0.00001f)
|
|
{
|
|
// May be processed on the next frame if this is our first frame and we are measuring size
|
|
// FIXME: Look into removing the branch so everything can go through this same code path for consistency.
|
|
window->SetWindowPosVal = g.SetNextWindowPosVal;
|
|
window->SetWindowPosPivot = g.SetNextWindowPosPivot;
|
|
window->SetWindowPosAllowFlags &= ~(ImGuiCond_Once | ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver | ImGuiCond_Appearing);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
SetWindowPos(window, g.SetNextWindowPosVal, g.SetNextWindowPosCond);
|
|
}
|
|
g.SetNextWindowPosCond = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
if (g.SetNextWindowSizeCond)
|
|
{
|
|
window_size_x_set_by_api = (window->SetWindowSizeAllowFlags & g.SetNextWindowSizeCond) != 0 && (g.SetNextWindowSizeVal.x > 0.0f);
|
|
window_size_y_set_by_api = (window->SetWindowSizeAllowFlags & g.SetNextWindowSizeCond) != 0 && (g.SetNextWindowSizeVal.y > 0.0f);
|
|
SetWindowSize(window, g.SetNextWindowSizeVal, g.SetNextWindowSizeCond);
|
|
g.SetNextWindowSizeCond = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
if (g.SetNextWindowContentSizeCond)
|
|
{
|
|
window->SizeContentsExplicit = g.SetNextWindowContentSizeVal;
|
|
g.SetNextWindowContentSizeCond = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (first_begin_of_the_frame)
|
|
{
|
|
window->SizeContentsExplicit = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f);
|
|
}
|
|
if (g.SetNextWindowCollapsedCond)
|
|
{
|
|
SetWindowCollapsed(window, g.SetNextWindowCollapsedVal, g.SetNextWindowCollapsedCond);
|
|
g.SetNextWindowCollapsedCond = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
if (g.SetNextWindowFocus)
|
|
{
|
|
SetWindowFocus();
|
|
g.SetNextWindowFocus = false;
|
|
}
|
|
if (window->Appearing)
|
|
SetWindowConditionAllowFlags(window, ImGuiCond_Appearing, false);
|
|
|
|
// When reusing window again multiple times a frame, just append content (don't need to setup again)
|
|
if (first_begin_of_the_frame)
|
|
{
|
|
// Initialize
|
|
window->ParentWindow = parent_window;
|
|
window->RootWindow = !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) ? window : parent_window->RootWindow;
|
|
window->RootNonPopupWindow = !(flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow | ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup)) || (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal) ? window : parent_window->RootNonPopupWindow; // Used to display TitleBgActive color and for selecting which window to use for NavWindowing
|
|
//window->RootNavWindow = window;
|
|
//while (window->RootNavWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened)
|
|
// window->RootNavWindow = window->RootNavWindow->ParentWindow;
|
|
|
|
window->Active = true;
|
|
window->OrderWithinParent = 0;
|
|
window->BeginCount = 0;
|
|
window->ClipRect = ImVec4(-FLT_MAX,-FLT_MAX,+FLT_MAX,+FLT_MAX);
|
|
window->LastFrameActive = current_frame;
|
|
window->IDStack.resize(1);
|
|
|
|
// Clear draw list, setup texture, outer clipping rectangle
|
|
window->DrawList->Clear();
|
|
window->DrawList->PushTextureID(g.Font->ContainerAtlas->TexID);
|
|
ImRect fullscreen_rect(GetVisibleRect());
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) && !(flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_ComboBox|ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup)))
|
|
PushClipRect(parent_window->ClipRect.Min, parent_window->ClipRect.Max, true);
|
|
else
|
|
PushClipRect(fullscreen_rect.Min, fullscreen_rect.Max, true);
|
|
|
|
if (window_just_activated_by_user)
|
|
{
|
|
// Popup first latch mouse position, will position itself when it appears next frame
|
|
window->AutoPosLastDirection = ImGuiDir_None;
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) != 0 && !window_pos_set_by_api)
|
|
window->PosFloat = g.IO.MousePos;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Collapse window by double-clicking on title bar
|
|
// At this point we don't have a clipping rectangle setup yet, so we can use the title bar area for hit detection and drawing
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoCollapse))
|
|
{
|
|
ImRect title_bar_rect = window->TitleBarRect();
|
|
if (g.HoveredWindow == window && IsMouseHoveringRect(title_bar_rect.Min, title_bar_rect.Max) && g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[0])
|
|
{
|
|
window->Collapsed = !window->Collapsed;
|
|
MarkIniSettingsDirty(window);
|
|
FocusWindow(window);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
window->Collapsed = false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SIZE
|
|
|
|
// Update contents size from last frame for auto-fitting (unless explicitly specified)
|
|
window->SizeContents = CalcSizeContents(window);
|
|
|
|
// Hide popup/tooltip window when re-opening while we measure size (because we recycle the windows)
|
|
if (window->HiddenFrames > 0)
|
|
window->HiddenFrames--;
|
|
if ((flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup | ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip)) != 0 && window_just_activated_by_user)
|
|
{
|
|
window->HiddenFrames = 1;
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!window_size_x_set_by_api)
|
|
window->Size.x = window->SizeFull.x = 0.f;
|
|
if (!window_size_y_set_by_api)
|
|
window->Size.y = window->SizeFull.y = 0.f;
|
|
window->SizeContents = ImVec2(0.f, 0.f);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Lock window rounding, border size and rounding so that altering the border sizes for children doesn't have side-effects.
|
|
window->WindowRounding = (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) ? style.ChildRounding : ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal)) ? style.PopupRounding : style.WindowRounding;
|
|
window->WindowBorderSize = (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) ? style.ChildBorderSize : ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal)) ? style.PopupBorderSize : style.WindowBorderSize;
|
|
window->WindowPadding = style.WindowPadding;
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) && !(flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysUseWindowPadding | ImGuiWindowFlags_ComboBox | ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup)) && window->WindowBorderSize == 0.0f)
|
|
window->WindowPadding = ImVec2(0.0f, (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar) ? style.WindowPadding.y : 0.0f);
|
|
const float window_rounding = window->WindowRounding;
|
|
const float window_border_size = window->WindowBorderSize;
|
|
|
|
// Calculate auto-fit size, handle automatic resize
|
|
const ImVec2 size_auto_fit = CalcSizeAutoFit(window, window->SizeContents);
|
|
ImVec2 size_full_modified(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX);
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize && !window->Collapsed)
|
|
{
|
|
// Using SetNextWindowSize() overrides ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize, so it can be used on tooltips/popups, etc.
|
|
if (!window_size_x_set_by_api)
|
|
window->SizeFull.x = size_full_modified.x = size_auto_fit.x;
|
|
if (!window_size_y_set_by_api)
|
|
window->SizeFull.y = size_full_modified.y = size_auto_fit.y;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (window->AutoFitFramesX > 0 || window->AutoFitFramesY > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
// Auto-fit only grows during the first few frames
|
|
// We still process initial auto-fit on collapsed windows to get a window width, but otherwise don't honor ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize.
|
|
if (!window_size_x_set_by_api && window->AutoFitFramesX > 0)
|
|
window->SizeFull.x = size_full_modified.x = window->AutoFitOnlyGrows ? ImMax(window->SizeFull.x, size_auto_fit.x) : size_auto_fit.x;
|
|
if (!window_size_y_set_by_api && window->AutoFitFramesY > 0)
|
|
window->SizeFull.y = size_full_modified.y = window->AutoFitOnlyGrows ? ImMax(window->SizeFull.y, size_auto_fit.y) : size_auto_fit.y;
|
|
if (!window->Collapsed)
|
|
MarkIniSettingsDirty(window);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Apply minimum/maximum window size constraints and final size
|
|
window->SizeFull = CalcSizeAfterConstraint(window, window->SizeFull);
|
|
window->Size = window->Collapsed ? window->TitleBarRect().GetSize() : window->SizeFull;
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup))
|
|
{
|
|
IM_ASSERT(window_size_x_set_by_api && window_size_x_set_by_api); // Submitted by BeginChild()
|
|
window->Size = window->SizeFull;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SCROLLBAR STATUS
|
|
|
|
// Update scrollbar status (based on the Size that was effective during last frame or the auto-resized Size).
|
|
if (!window->Collapsed)
|
|
{
|
|
// When reading the current size we need to read it after size constraints have been applied
|
|
float size_x_for_scrollbars = size_full_modified.x != FLT_MAX ? window->SizeFull.x : window->SizeFullAtLastBegin.x;
|
|
float size_y_for_scrollbars = size_full_modified.y != FLT_MAX ? window->SizeFull.y : window->SizeFullAtLastBegin.y;
|
|
window->ScrollbarY = (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysVerticalScrollbar) || ((window->SizeContents.y > size_y_for_scrollbars) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar));
|
|
window->ScrollbarX = (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysHorizontalScrollbar) || ((window->SizeContents.x > size_x_for_scrollbars - (window->ScrollbarY ? style.ScrollbarSize : 0.0f) - window->WindowPadding.x) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar) && (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar));
|
|
if (window->ScrollbarX && !window->ScrollbarY)
|
|
window->ScrollbarY = (window->SizeContents.y > size_y_for_scrollbars + style.ScrollbarSize) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar);
|
|
window->ScrollbarSizes = ImVec2(window->ScrollbarY ? style.ScrollbarSize : 0.0f, window->ScrollbarX ? style.ScrollbarSize : 0.0f);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// POSITION
|
|
|
|
// Position child window
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow)
|
|
{
|
|
window->OrderWithinParent = parent_window->DC.ChildWindows.Size;
|
|
parent_window->DC.ChildWindows.push_back(window);
|
|
}
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) && !window_pos_set_by_api)
|
|
window->Pos = window->PosFloat = parent_window->DC.CursorPos;
|
|
|
|
const bool window_pos_with_pivot = (window->SetWindowPosVal.x != FLT_MAX && window->HiddenFrames == 0);
|
|
if (window_pos_with_pivot)
|
|
{
|
|
// Position given a pivot (e.g. for centering)
|
|
SetWindowPos(window, ImMax(style.DisplaySafeAreaPadding, window->SetWindowPosVal - window->SizeFull * window->SetWindowPosPivot), 0);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu)
|
|
{
|
|
// Child menus typically request _any_ position within the parent menu item, and then our FindBestPopupWindowPos() function will move the new menu outside the parent bounds.
|
|
// This is how we end up with child menus appearing (most-commonly) on the right of the parent menu.
|
|
IM_ASSERT(window_pos_set_by_api);
|
|
float horizontal_overlap = style.ItemSpacing.x; // We want some overlap to convey the relative depth of each popup (currently the amount of overlap it is hard-coded to style.ItemSpacing.x, may need to introduce another style value).
|
|
ImRect rect_to_avoid;
|
|
if (parent_window->DC.MenuBarAppending)
|
|
rect_to_avoid = ImRect(-FLT_MAX, parent_window->Pos.y + parent_window->TitleBarHeight(), FLT_MAX, parent_window->Pos.y + parent_window->TitleBarHeight() + parent_window->MenuBarHeight());
|
|
else
|
|
rect_to_avoid = ImRect(parent_window->Pos.x + horizontal_overlap, -FLT_MAX, parent_window->Pos.x + parent_window->Size.x - horizontal_overlap - parent_window->ScrollbarSizes.x, FLT_MAX);
|
|
window->PosFloat = FindBestWindowPosForPopup(window->PosFloat, window->Size, &window->AutoPosLastDirection, rect_to_avoid, flags);
|
|
}
|
|
else if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) != 0 && !window_pos_set_by_api && window_just_appearing_after_hidden_for_resize)
|
|
{
|
|
ImRect rect_to_avoid(window->PosFloat.x - 1, window->PosFloat.y - 1, window->PosFloat.x + 1, window->PosFloat.y + 1);
|
|
window->PosFloat = FindBestWindowPosForPopup(window->PosFloat, window->Size, &window->AutoPosLastDirection, rect_to_avoid, flags);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Position tooltip (always follows mouse)
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip) != 0 && !window_pos_set_by_api)
|
|
{
|
|
ImVec2 ref_pos = g.IO.MousePos;
|
|
ImRect rect_to_avoid(ref_pos.x - 16, ref_pos.y - 8, ref_pos.x + 24, ref_pos.y + 24); // FIXME: Completely hard-coded. Store boxes in mouse cursor data? Scale? Center on cursor hit-point?
|
|
window->PosFloat = FindBestWindowPosForPopup(ref_pos, window->Size, &window->AutoPosLastDirection, rect_to_avoid, flags);
|
|
if (window->AutoPosLastDirection == ImGuiDir_None)
|
|
window->PosFloat = ref_pos + ImVec2(2,2); // If there's not enough room, for tooltip we prefer avoiding the cursor at all cost even if it means that part of the tooltip won't be visible.
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Clamp position so it stays visible
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip))
|
|
{
|
|
if (!window_pos_set_by_api && window->AutoFitFramesX <= 0 && window->AutoFitFramesY <= 0 && g.IO.DisplaySize.x > 0.0f && g.IO.DisplaySize.y > 0.0f) // Ignore zero-sized display explicitly to avoid losing positions if a window manager reports zero-sized window when initializing or minimizing.
|
|
{
|
|
ImVec2 padding = ImMax(style.DisplayWindowPadding, style.DisplaySafeAreaPadding);
|
|
window->PosFloat = ImMax(window->PosFloat + window->Size, padding) - window->Size;
|
|
window->PosFloat = ImMin(window->PosFloat, g.IO.DisplaySize - padding);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
window->Pos = ImVec2((float)(int)window->PosFloat.x, (float)(int)window->PosFloat.y);
|
|
|
|
// Default item width. Make it proportional to window size if window manually resizes
|
|
if (window->Size.x > 0.0f && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize))
|
|
window->ItemWidthDefault = (float)(int)(window->Size.x * 0.65f);
|
|
else
|
|
window->ItemWidthDefault = (float)(int)(g.FontSize * 16.0f);
|
|
|
|
// Prepare for focus requests
|
|
window->FocusIdxAllRequestCurrent = (window->FocusIdxAllRequestNext == INT_MAX || window->FocusIdxAllCounter == -1) ? INT_MAX : (window->FocusIdxAllRequestNext + (window->FocusIdxAllCounter+1)) % (window->FocusIdxAllCounter+1);
|
|
window->FocusIdxTabRequestCurrent = (window->FocusIdxTabRequestNext == INT_MAX || window->FocusIdxTabCounter == -1) ? INT_MAX : (window->FocusIdxTabRequestNext + (window->FocusIdxTabCounter+1)) % (window->FocusIdxTabCounter+1);
|
|
window->FocusIdxAllCounter = window->FocusIdxTabCounter = -1;
|
|
window->FocusIdxAllRequestNext = window->FocusIdxTabRequestNext = INT_MAX;
|
|
|
|
// Apply scrolling
|
|
window->Scroll = CalcNextScrollFromScrollTargetAndClamp(window);
|
|
window->ScrollTarget = ImVec2(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX);
|
|
|
|
// Modal window darkens what is behind them
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal) != 0 && window == GetFrontMostModalRootWindow())
|
|
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(fullscreen_rect.Min, fullscreen_rect.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_ModalWindowDarkening, g.ModalWindowDarkeningRatio));
|
|
|
|
// Apply focus, new windows appears in front
|
|
bool want_focus = false;
|
|
if (window_just_activated_by_user && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoFocusOnAppearing))
|
|
if (!(flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow | ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip)) || (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup))
|
|
want_focus = true;
|
|
|
|
// Draw window + handle manual resize
|
|
ImRect title_bar_rect = window->TitleBarRect();
|
|
if (window->Collapsed)
|
|
{
|
|
// Title bar only
|
|
float backup_border_size = style.FrameBorderSize;
|
|
g.Style.FrameBorderSize = window->WindowBorderSize;
|
|
RenderFrame(title_bar_rect.Min, title_bar_rect.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_TitleBgCollapsed), true, window_rounding);
|
|
g.Style.FrameBorderSize = backup_border_size;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// Handle resize for: Resize Grips, Borders, Gamepad
|
|
int border_held = -1;
|
|
ImU32 resize_grip_col[4] = { 0 };
|
|
const int resize_grip_count = (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ResizeFromAnySide) ? 2 : 1; // 4
|
|
const int resize_border_count = (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ResizeFromAnySide) ? 4 : 0;
|
|
|
|
const float grip_draw_size = (float)(int)ImMax(g.FontSize * 1.35f, window_rounding + 1.0f + g.FontSize * 0.2f);
|
|
const float grip_hover_size = (float)(int)(grip_draw_size * 0.75f);
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize) && window->AutoFitFramesX <= 0 && window->AutoFitFramesY <= 0 && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize))
|
|
{
|
|
ImVec2 pos_target(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX);
|
|
ImVec2 size_target(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX);
|
|
|
|
// Manual resize grips
|
|
PushID("#RESIZE");
|
|
for (int resize_grip_n = 0; resize_grip_n < resize_grip_count; resize_grip_n++)
|
|
{
|
|
const ImGuiResizeGripDef& grip = resize_grip_def[resize_grip_n];
|
|
const ImVec2 corner = ImLerp(window->Pos, window->Pos + window->Size, grip.CornerPos);
|
|
|
|
// Using the FlattenChilds button flag we make the resize button accessible even if we are hovering over a child window
|
|
ImRect resize_rect(corner, corner + grip.InnerDir * grip_hover_size);
|
|
resize_rect.FixInverted();
|
|
bool hovered, held;
|
|
ButtonBehavior(resize_rect, window->GetID((void*)(intptr_t)resize_grip_n), &hovered, &held, ImGuiButtonFlags_FlattenChilds);
|
|
if (hovered || held)
|
|
g.MouseCursor = (resize_grip_n & 1) ? ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNESW : ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNWSE;
|
|
|
|
if (g.HoveredWindow == window && held && g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[0] && resize_grip_n == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
// Manual auto-fit when double-clicking
|
|
size_target = CalcSizeAfterConstraint(window, size_auto_fit);
|
|
ClearActiveID();
|
|
}
|
|
else if (held)
|
|
{
|
|
// Resize from any of the four corners
|
|
// We don't use an incremental MouseDelta but rather compute an absolute target size based on mouse position
|
|
ImVec2 corner_target = g.IO.MousePos - g.ActiveIdClickOffset + resize_rect.GetSize() * grip.CornerPos; // Corner of the window corresponding to our corner grip
|
|
CalcResizePosSizeFromAnyCorner(window, corner_target, grip.CornerPos, &pos_target, &size_target);
|
|
}
|
|
if (resize_grip_n == 0 || held || hovered)
|
|
resize_grip_col[resize_grip_n] = GetColorU32(held ? ImGuiCol_ResizeGripActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_ResizeGripHovered : ImGuiCol_ResizeGrip);
|
|
}
|
|
for (int border_n = 0; border_n < resize_border_count; border_n++)
|
|
{
|
|
const float BORDER_SIZE = 5.0f; // FIXME: Only works _inside_ window because of HoveredWindow check.
|
|
const float BORDER_APPEAR_TIMER = 0.05f; // Reduce visual noise
|
|
bool hovered, held;
|
|
ImRect border_rect = GetBorderRect(window, border_n, grip_hover_size, BORDER_SIZE);
|
|
ButtonBehavior(border_rect, window->GetID((void*)(intptr_t)(border_n+4)), &hovered, &held, ImGuiButtonFlags_FlattenChilds);
|
|
if ((hovered && g.HoveredIdTimer > BORDER_APPEAR_TIMER) || held)
|
|
{
|
|
g.MouseCursor = (border_n & 1) ? ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeEW : ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNS;
|
|
if (held) border_held = border_n;
|
|
}
|
|
if (held)
|
|
{
|
|
ImVec2 border_target = window->Pos;
|
|
ImVec2 border_posn;
|
|
if (border_n == 0) { border_posn = ImVec2(0, 0); border_target.y = (g.IO.MousePos.y - g.ActiveIdClickOffset.y); }
|
|
if (border_n == 1) { border_posn = ImVec2(1, 0); border_target.x = (g.IO.MousePos.x - g.ActiveIdClickOffset.x + BORDER_SIZE); }
|
|
if (border_n == 2) { border_posn = ImVec2(0, 1); border_target.y = (g.IO.MousePos.y - g.ActiveIdClickOffset.y + BORDER_SIZE); }
|
|
if (border_n == 3) { border_posn = ImVec2(0, 0); border_target.x = (g.IO.MousePos.x - g.ActiveIdClickOffset.x); }
|
|
CalcResizePosSizeFromAnyCorner(window, border_target, border_posn, &pos_target, &size_target);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
PopID();
|
|
|
|
// Apply back modified position/size to window
|
|
if (size_target.x != FLT_MAX)
|
|
{
|
|
window->SizeFull = size_target;
|
|
MarkIniSettingsDirty(window);
|
|
}
|
|
if (pos_target.x != FLT_MAX)
|
|
{
|
|
window->Pos = window->PosFloat = ImVec2((float)(int)pos_target.x, (float)(int)pos_target.y);
|
|
MarkIniSettingsDirty(window);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
window->Size = window->SizeFull;
|
|
title_bar_rect = window->TitleBarRect();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Window background, Default Alpha
|
|
ImU32 bg_col = GetColorU32(GetWindowBgColorIdxFromFlags(flags));
|
|
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(window->Pos+ImVec2(0,window->TitleBarHeight()), window->Pos+window->Size, bg_col, window_rounding, (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar) ? ImDrawCornerFlags_All : ImDrawCornerFlags_Bot);
|
|
|
|
// Title bar
|
|
const bool window_is_focused = want_focus || (g.NavWindow && window->RootNonPopupWindow == g.NavWindow->RootNonPopupWindow);
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar))
|
|
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(title_bar_rect.Min, title_bar_rect.Max, GetColorU32(window_is_focused ? ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive : ImGuiCol_TitleBg), window_rounding, ImDrawCornerFlags_Top);
|
|
|
|
// Menu bar
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar)
|
|
{
|
|
ImRect menu_bar_rect = window->MenuBarRect();
|
|
menu_bar_rect.ClipWith(window->Rect()); // Soft clipping, in particular child window don't have minimum size covering the menu bar so this is useful for them.
|
|
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(menu_bar_rect.Min, menu_bar_rect.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_MenuBarBg), (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar) ? window_rounding : 0.0f, ImDrawCornerFlags_Top);
|
|
if (style.FrameBorderSize > 0.0f && menu_bar_rect.Max.y < window->Pos.y + window->Size.y)
|
|
window->DrawList->AddLine(menu_bar_rect.GetBL(), menu_bar_rect.GetBR(), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Border), style.FrameBorderSize);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Scrollbars
|
|
if (window->ScrollbarX)
|
|
Scrollbar(ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal);
|
|
if (window->ScrollbarY)
|
|
Scrollbar(ImGuiLayoutType_Vertical);
|
|
|
|
// Render resize grips (after their input handling so we don't have a frame of latency)
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize))
|
|
{
|
|
for (int resize_grip_n = 0; resize_grip_n < resize_grip_count; resize_grip_n++)
|
|
{
|
|
const ImGuiResizeGripDef& grip = resize_grip_def[resize_grip_n];
|
|
const ImVec2 corner = ImLerp(window->Pos, window->Pos + window->Size, grip.CornerPos);
|
|
window->DrawList->PathLineTo(corner + grip.InnerDir * ((resize_grip_n & 1) ? ImVec2(window_border_size, grip_draw_size) : ImVec2(grip_draw_size, window_border_size)));
|
|
window->DrawList->PathLineTo(corner + grip.InnerDir * ((resize_grip_n & 1) ? ImVec2(grip_draw_size, window_border_size) : ImVec2(window_border_size, grip_draw_size)));
|
|
window->DrawList->PathArcToFast(ImVec2(corner.x + grip.InnerDir.x * (window_rounding + window_border_size), corner.y + grip.InnerDir.y * (window_rounding + window_border_size)), window_rounding, grip.AngleMin12, grip.AngleMax12);
|
|
window->DrawList->PathFillConvex(resize_grip_col[resize_grip_n]);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Borders
|
|
if (window_border_size > 0.0f)
|
|
window->DrawList->AddRect(window->Pos, window->Pos+window->Size, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Border), window_rounding, ImDrawCornerFlags_All, window_border_size);
|
|
if (border_held != -1)
|
|
{
|
|
ImRect border = GetBorderRect(window, border_held, grip_draw_size, 0.0f);
|
|
window->DrawList->AddLine(border.Min, border.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_SeparatorActive), ImMax(1.0f, window_border_size));
|
|
}
|
|
if (style.FrameBorderSize > 0 && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar))
|
|
window->DrawList->AddLine(title_bar_rect.GetBL()+ImVec2(1,-1), title_bar_rect.GetBR()+ImVec2(-1,-1), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Border), style.FrameBorderSize);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Store a backup of SizeFull which we will use next frame to decide if we need scrollbars.
|
|
window->SizeFullAtLastBegin = window->SizeFull;
|
|
|
|
// Update ContentsRegionMax. All the variable it depends on are set above in this function.
|
|
window->ContentsRegionRect.Min.x = -window->Scroll.x + window->WindowPadding.x;
|
|
window->ContentsRegionRect.Min.y = -window->Scroll.y + window->WindowPadding.y + window->TitleBarHeight() + window->MenuBarHeight();
|
|
window->ContentsRegionRect.Max.x = -window->Scroll.x - window->WindowPadding.x + (window->SizeContentsExplicit.x != 0.0f ? window->SizeContentsExplicit.x : (window->Size.x - window->ScrollbarSizes.x));
|
|
window->ContentsRegionRect.Max.y = -window->Scroll.y - window->WindowPadding.y + (window->SizeContentsExplicit.y != 0.0f ? window->SizeContentsExplicit.y : (window->Size.y - window->ScrollbarSizes.y));
|
|
|
|
// Setup drawing context
|
|
// (NB: That term "drawing context / DC" lost its meaning a long time ago. Initially was meant to hold transient data only. Nowadays difference between window-> and window->DC-> is dubious.)
|
|
window->DC.IndentX = 0.0f + window->WindowPadding.x - window->Scroll.x;
|
|
window->DC.GroupOffsetX = 0.0f;
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsOffsetX = 0.0f;
|
|
window->DC.CursorStartPos = window->Pos + ImVec2(window->DC.IndentX + window->DC.ColumnsOffsetX, window->TitleBarHeight() + window->MenuBarHeight() + window->WindowPadding.y - window->Scroll.y);
|
|
window->DC.CursorPos = window->DC.CursorStartPos;
|
|
window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine = window->DC.CursorPos;
|
|
window->DC.CursorMaxPos = window->DC.CursorStartPos;
|
|
window->DC.CurrentLineHeight = window->DC.PrevLineHeight = 0.0f;
|
|
window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset = window->DC.PrevLineTextBaseOffset = 0.0f;
|
|
window->DC.MenuBarAppending = false;
|
|
window->DC.MenuBarOffsetX = ImMax(window->WindowPadding.x, style.ItemSpacing.x);
|
|
window->DC.LogLinePosY = window->DC.CursorPos.y - 9999.0f;
|
|
window->DC.ChildWindows.resize(0);
|
|
window->DC.LayoutType = ImGuiLayoutType_Vertical;
|
|
window->DC.ItemFlags = ImGuiItemFlags_Default_;
|
|
window->DC.ItemWidth = window->ItemWidthDefault;
|
|
window->DC.TextWrapPos = -1.0f; // disabled
|
|
window->DC.ItemFlagsStack.resize(0);
|
|
window->DC.ItemWidthStack.resize(0);
|
|
window->DC.TextWrapPosStack.resize(0);
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsCurrent = 0;
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsCount = 1;
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsStartPosY = window->DC.CursorPos.y;
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsStartMaxPosX = window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x;
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsCellMinY = window->DC.ColumnsCellMaxY = window->DC.ColumnsStartPosY;
|
|
window->DC.TreeDepth = 0;
|
|
window->DC.StateStorage = &window->StateStorage;
|
|
window->DC.GroupStack.resize(0);
|
|
window->MenuColumns.Update(3, style.ItemSpacing.x, window_just_activated_by_user);
|
|
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) && (window->DC.ItemFlags != parent_window->DC.ItemFlags))
|
|
{
|
|
window->DC.ItemFlags = parent_window->DC.ItemFlags;
|
|
window->DC.ItemFlagsStack.push_back(window->DC.ItemFlags);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (window->AutoFitFramesX > 0)
|
|
window->AutoFitFramesX--;
|
|
if (window->AutoFitFramesY > 0)
|
|
window->AutoFitFramesY--;
|
|
|
|
// Apply focus (we need to call FocusWindow() AFTER setting DC.CursorStartPos so our initial navigation reference rectangle can start around there)
|
|
if (want_focus)
|
|
FocusWindow(window);
|
|
|
|
// Title bar
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar))
|
|
{
|
|
// Collapse button
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoCollapse))
|
|
{
|
|
RenderTriangle(window->Pos + style.FramePadding, window->Collapsed ? ImGuiDir_Right : ImGuiDir_Down, 1.0f);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Close button
|
|
if (p_open != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
const float PAD = 2.0f;
|
|
const float rad = (window->TitleBarHeight() - PAD*2.0f) * 0.5f;
|
|
if (CloseButton(window->GetID("#CLOSE"), window->Rect().GetTR() + ImVec2(-PAD - rad, PAD + rad), rad))
|
|
*p_open = false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Title text (FIXME: refactor text alignment facilities along with RenderText helpers)
|
|
const ImVec2 text_size = CalcTextSize(name, NULL, true);
|
|
ImVec2 text_min = window->Pos;
|
|
ImVec2 text_max = window->Pos + ImVec2(window->Size.x, style.FramePadding.y*2 + text_size.y);
|
|
ImRect clip_rect;
|
|
clip_rect.Max = ImVec2(window->Pos.x + window->Size.x - (p_open ? title_bar_rect.GetHeight() - 3 : style.FramePadding.x), text_max.y); // Match the size of CloseWindowButton()
|
|
float pad_left = (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoCollapse) == 0 ? (style.FramePadding.x + g.FontSize + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x) : style.FramePadding.x;
|
|
float pad_right = (p_open != NULL) ? (style.FramePadding.x + g.FontSize + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x) : style.FramePadding.x;
|
|
if (style.WindowTitleAlign.x > 0.0f) pad_right = ImLerp(pad_right, pad_left, style.WindowTitleAlign.x);
|
|
text_min.x += pad_left;
|
|
text_max.x -= pad_right;
|
|
clip_rect.Min = ImVec2(text_min.x, window->Pos.y);
|
|
RenderTextClipped(text_min, text_max, name, NULL, &text_size, style.WindowTitleAlign, &clip_rect);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Save clipped aabb so we can access it in constant-time in FindHoveredWindow()
|
|
window->WindowRectClipped = window->Rect();
|
|
window->WindowRectClipped.ClipWith(window->ClipRect);
|
|
|
|
// Pressing CTRL+C while holding on a window copy its content to the clipboard
|
|
// This works but 1. doesn't handle multiple Begin/End pairs, 2. recursing into another Begin/End pair - so we need to work that out and add better logging scope.
|
|
// Maybe we can support CTRL+C on every element?
|
|
/*
|
|
if (g.ActiveId == move_id)
|
|
if (g.IO.KeyCtrl && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_C))
|
|
ImGui::LogToClipboard();
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
// Inner rectangle
|
|
// We set this up after processing the resize grip so that our clip rectangle doesn't lag by a frame
|
|
// Note that if our window is collapsed we will end up with a null clipping rectangle which is the correct behavior.
|
|
window->InnerRect.Min.x = title_bar_rect.Min.x;
|
|
window->InnerRect.Min.y = title_bar_rect.Max.y + window->MenuBarHeight();
|
|
window->InnerRect.Max.x = window->Pos.x + window->Size.x - window->ScrollbarSizes.x;
|
|
window->InnerRect.Max.y = window->Pos.y + window->Size.y - window->ScrollbarSizes.y;
|
|
//window->DrawList->AddRect(window->InnerRect.Min, window->InnerRect.Max, IM_COL32_WHITE);
|
|
|
|
// After Begin() we fill the last item / hovered data using the title bar data. Make that a standard behavior (to allow usage of context menus on title bar only, etc.).
|
|
window->DC.LastItemId = window->MoveId;
|
|
window->DC.LastItemRect = title_bar_rect;
|
|
window->DC.LastItemRectHoveredRect = IsMouseHoveringRect(title_bar_rect.Min, title_bar_rect.Max, false);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Inner clipping rectangle
|
|
// Force round operator last to ensure that e.g. (int)(max.x-min.x) in user's render code produce correct result.
|
|
const float border_size = window->WindowBorderSize;
|
|
ImRect clip_rect;
|
|
clip_rect.Min.x = ImFloor(0.5f + window->InnerRect.Min.x + ImMax(border_size, ImFloor(window->WindowPadding.x*0.5f)));
|
|
clip_rect.Min.y = ImFloor(0.5f + window->InnerRect.Min.y + border_size);
|
|
clip_rect.Max.x = ImFloor(0.5f + window->InnerRect.Max.x - ImMax(border_size, ImFloor(window->WindowPadding.x*0.5f)));
|
|
clip_rect.Max.y = ImFloor(0.5f + window->InnerRect.Max.y - border_size);
|
|
PushClipRect(clip_rect.Min, clip_rect.Max, true);
|
|
|
|
// Clear 'accessed' flag last thing (After PushClipRect which will set the flag. We want the flag to stay false when the default "Debug" window is unused)
|
|
if (first_begin_of_the_frame)
|
|
window->WriteAccessed = false;
|
|
|
|
window->BeginCount++;
|
|
g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraint = false;
|
|
|
|
// Child window can be out of sight and have "negative" clip windows.
|
|
// Mark them as collapsed so commands are skipped earlier (we can't manually collapse because they have no title bar).
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow)
|
|
{
|
|
IM_ASSERT((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar) != 0);
|
|
window->Collapsed = parent_window && parent_window->Collapsed;
|
|
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize) && window->AutoFitFramesX <= 0 && window->AutoFitFramesY <= 0)
|
|
window->Collapsed |= (window->WindowRectClipped.Min.x >= window->WindowRectClipped.Max.x || window->WindowRectClipped.Min.y >= window->WindowRectClipped.Max.y);
|
|
|
|
// We also hide the window from rendering because we've already added its border to the command list.
|
|
// (we could perform the check earlier in the function but it is simpler at this point)
|
|
if (window->Collapsed)
|
|
window->Active = false;
|
|
}
|
|
if (style.Alpha <= 0.0f)
|
|
window->Active = false;
|
|
|
|
// Return false if we don't intend to display anything to allow user to perform an early out optimization
|
|
window->SkipItems = (window->Collapsed || !window->Active) && window->AutoFitFramesX <= 0 && window->AutoFitFramesY <= 0;
|
|
return !window->SkipItems;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Old Begin() API with 5 parameters, avoid calling this version directly! Use SetNextWindowSize()+Begin() instead.
|
|
#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS
|
|
bool ImGui::Begin(const char* name, bool* p_open, const ImVec2& size_on_first_use, float bg_alpha_override, ImGuiWindowFlags flags)
|
|
{
|
|
// Old API feature: we could pass the initial window size as a parameter, however this was very misleading because in most cases it would only affect the window when it didn't have storage in the .ini file.
|
|
if (size_on_first_use.x != 0.0f || size_on_first_use.y != 0.0f)
|
|
SetNextWindowSize(size_on_first_use, ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver);
|
|
|
|
// Old API feature: we could override the window background alpha with a parameter. This is actually tricky to reproduce manually because:
|
|
// (1) there are multiple variants of WindowBg (popup, tooltip, etc.) and (2) you can't call PushStyleColor before Begin and PopStyleColor just after Begin() because of how CheckStackSizes() behave.
|
|
// The user-side solution is to do backup = GetStyleColorVec4(ImGuiCol_xxxBG), PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_xxxBg), Begin, PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_xxxBg, backup), [...], PopStyleColor(), End(); PopStyleColor() - which is super awkward.
|
|
// The alpha override was rarely used but for now we'll leave the Begin() variant around for a bit. We may either lift the constraint on CheckStackSizes() either add a SetNextWindowBgAlpha() helper that does it magically.
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const ImGuiCol bg_color_idx = GetWindowBgColorIdxFromFlags(flags);
|
|
const ImVec4 bg_color_backup = g.Style.Colors[bg_color_idx];
|
|
if (bg_alpha_override >= 0.0f)
|
|
g.Style.Colors[bg_color_idx].w = bg_alpha_override;
|
|
|
|
bool ret = Begin(name, p_open, flags);
|
|
|
|
if (bg_alpha_override >= 0.0f)
|
|
g.Style.Colors[bg_color_idx] = bg_color_backup;
|
|
return ret;
|
|
}
|
|
#endif // IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::End()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
|
|
if (window->DC.ColumnsCount != 1) // close columns set if any is open
|
|
EndColumns();
|
|
PopClipRect(); // inner window clip rectangle
|
|
|
|
// Stop logging
|
|
if (!(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow)) // FIXME: add more options for scope of logging
|
|
LogFinish();
|
|
|
|
// Pop
|
|
// NB: we don't clear 'window->RootWindow'. The pointer is allowed to live until the next call to Begin().
|
|
g.CurrentWindowStack.pop_back();
|
|
if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup)
|
|
g.CurrentPopupStack.pop_back();
|
|
CheckStacksSize(window, false);
|
|
SetCurrentWindow(g.CurrentWindowStack.empty() ? NULL : g.CurrentWindowStack.back());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Vertical scrollbar
|
|
// The entire piece of code below is rather confusing because:
|
|
// - We handle absolute seeking (when first clicking outside the grab) and relative manipulation (afterward or when clicking inside the grab)
|
|
// - We store values as normalized ratio and in a form that allows the window content to change while we are holding on a scrollbar
|
|
// - We handle both horizontal and vertical scrollbars, which makes the terminology not ideal.
|
|
void ImGui::Scrollbar(ImGuiLayoutType direction)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
|
|
const bool horizontal = (direction == ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal);
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(horizontal ? "#SCROLLX" : "#SCROLLY");
|
|
|
|
// Render background
|
|
bool other_scrollbar = (horizontal ? window->ScrollbarY : window->ScrollbarX);
|
|
float other_scrollbar_size_w = other_scrollbar ? style.ScrollbarSize : 0.0f;
|
|
const ImRect window_rect = window->Rect();
|
|
const float border_size = window->WindowBorderSize;
|
|
ImRect bb = horizontal
|
|
? ImRect(window->Pos.x + border_size, window_rect.Max.y - style.ScrollbarSize, window_rect.Max.x - other_scrollbar_size_w - border_size, window_rect.Max.y - border_size)
|
|
: ImRect(window_rect.Max.x - style.ScrollbarSize, window->Pos.y + border_size, window_rect.Max.x - border_size, window_rect.Max.y - other_scrollbar_size_w - border_size);
|
|
if (!horizontal)
|
|
bb.Min.y += window->TitleBarHeight() + ((window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar) ? window->MenuBarHeight() : 0.0f);
|
|
if (bb.GetWidth() <= 0.0f || bb.GetHeight() <= 0.0f)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
int window_rounding_corners;
|
|
if (horizontal)
|
|
window_rounding_corners = ImDrawCornerFlags_BotLeft | (other_scrollbar ? 0 : ImDrawCornerFlags_BotRight);
|
|
else
|
|
window_rounding_corners = (((window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar) && !(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar)) ? ImDrawCornerFlags_TopRight : 0) | (other_scrollbar ? 0 : ImDrawCornerFlags_BotRight);
|
|
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(bb.Min, bb.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_ScrollbarBg), window->WindowRounding, window_rounding_corners);
|
|
bb.Expand(ImVec2(-ImClamp((float)(int)((bb.Max.x - bb.Min.x - 2.0f) * 0.5f), 0.0f, 3.0f), -ImClamp((float)(int)((bb.Max.y - bb.Min.y - 2.0f) * 0.5f), 0.0f, 3.0f)));
|
|
|
|
// V denote the main, longer axis of the scrollbar (= height for a vertical scrollbar)
|
|
float scrollbar_size_v = horizontal ? bb.GetWidth() : bb.GetHeight();
|
|
float scroll_v = horizontal ? window->Scroll.x : window->Scroll.y;
|
|
float win_size_avail_v = (horizontal ? window->SizeFull.x : window->SizeFull.y) - other_scrollbar_size_w;
|
|
float win_size_contents_v = horizontal ? window->SizeContents.x : window->SizeContents.y;
|
|
|
|
// Calculate the height of our grabbable box. It generally represent the amount visible (vs the total scrollable amount)
|
|
// But we maintain a minimum size in pixel to allow for the user to still aim inside.
|
|
IM_ASSERT(ImMax(win_size_contents_v, win_size_avail_v) > 0.0f); // Adding this assert to check if the ImMax(XXX,1.0f) is still needed. PLEASE CONTACT ME if this triggers.
|
|
const float win_size_v = ImMax(ImMax(win_size_contents_v, win_size_avail_v), 1.0f);
|
|
const float grab_h_pixels = ImClamp(scrollbar_size_v * (win_size_avail_v / win_size_v), style.GrabMinSize, scrollbar_size_v);
|
|
const float grab_h_norm = grab_h_pixels / scrollbar_size_v;
|
|
|
|
// Handle input right away. None of the code of Begin() is relying on scrolling position before calling Scrollbar().
|
|
bool held = false;
|
|
bool hovered = false;
|
|
const bool previously_held = (g.ActiveId == id);
|
|
ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held);
|
|
|
|
float scroll_max = ImMax(1.0f, win_size_contents_v - win_size_avail_v);
|
|
float scroll_ratio = ImSaturate(scroll_v / scroll_max);
|
|
float grab_v_norm = scroll_ratio * (scrollbar_size_v - grab_h_pixels) / scrollbar_size_v;
|
|
if (held && grab_h_norm < 1.0f)
|
|
{
|
|
float scrollbar_pos_v = horizontal ? bb.Min.x : bb.Min.y;
|
|
float mouse_pos_v = horizontal ? g.IO.MousePos.x : g.IO.MousePos.y;
|
|
float* click_delta_to_grab_center_v = horizontal ? &g.ScrollbarClickDeltaToGrabCenter.x : &g.ScrollbarClickDeltaToGrabCenter.y;
|
|
|
|
// Click position in scrollbar normalized space (0.0f->1.0f)
|
|
const float clicked_v_norm = ImSaturate((mouse_pos_v - scrollbar_pos_v) / scrollbar_size_v);
|
|
SetHoveredID(id);
|
|
|
|
bool seek_absolute = false;
|
|
if (!previously_held)
|
|
{
|
|
// On initial click calculate the distance between mouse and the center of the grab
|
|
if (clicked_v_norm >= grab_v_norm && clicked_v_norm <= grab_v_norm + grab_h_norm)
|
|
{
|
|
*click_delta_to_grab_center_v = clicked_v_norm - grab_v_norm - grab_h_norm*0.5f;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
seek_absolute = true;
|
|
*click_delta_to_grab_center_v = 0.0f;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Apply scroll
|
|
// It is ok to modify Scroll here because we are being called in Begin() after the calculation of SizeContents and before setting up our starting position
|
|
const float scroll_v_norm = ImSaturate((clicked_v_norm - *click_delta_to_grab_center_v - grab_h_norm*0.5f) / (1.0f - grab_h_norm));
|
|
scroll_v = (float)(int)(0.5f + scroll_v_norm * scroll_max);//(win_size_contents_v - win_size_v));
|
|
if (horizontal)
|
|
window->Scroll.x = scroll_v;
|
|
else
|
|
window->Scroll.y = scroll_v;
|
|
|
|
// Update values for rendering
|
|
scroll_ratio = ImSaturate(scroll_v / scroll_max);
|
|
grab_v_norm = scroll_ratio * (scrollbar_size_v - grab_h_pixels) / scrollbar_size_v;
|
|
|
|
// Update distance to grab now that we have seeked and saturated
|
|
if (seek_absolute)
|
|
*click_delta_to_grab_center_v = clicked_v_norm - grab_v_norm - grab_h_norm*0.5f;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Render
|
|
const ImU32 grab_col = GetColorU32(held ? ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrabActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrabHovered : ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrab);
|
|
ImRect grab_rect;
|
|
if (horizontal)
|
|
grab_rect = ImRect(ImLerp(bb.Min.x, bb.Max.x, grab_v_norm), bb.Min.y, ImMin(ImLerp(bb.Min.x, bb.Max.x, grab_v_norm) + grab_h_pixels, window_rect.Max.x), bb.Max.y);
|
|
else
|
|
grab_rect = ImRect(bb.Min.x, ImLerp(bb.Min.y, bb.Max.y, grab_v_norm), bb.Max.x, ImMin(ImLerp(bb.Min.y, bb.Max.y, grab_v_norm) + grab_h_pixels, window_rect.Max.y));
|
|
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(grab_rect.Min, grab_rect.Max, grab_col, style.ScrollbarRounding);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::BringWindowToFront(ImGuiWindow* window)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (g.Windows.back() == window)
|
|
return;
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < g.Windows.Size; i++)
|
|
if (g.Windows[i] == window)
|
|
{
|
|
g.Windows.erase(g.Windows.begin() + i);
|
|
g.Windows.push_back(window);
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::BringWindowToBack(ImGuiWindow* window)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (g.Windows[0] == window)
|
|
return;
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < g.Windows.Size; i++)
|
|
if (g.Windows[i] == window)
|
|
{
|
|
memmove(&g.Windows[1], &g.Windows[0], (size_t)i * sizeof(ImGuiWindow*));
|
|
g.Windows[0] = window;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Moving window to front of display and set focus (which happens to be back of our sorted list)
|
|
void ImGui::FocusWindow(ImGuiWindow* window)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
|
|
// Always mark the window we passed as focused. This is used for keyboard interactions such as tabbing.
|
|
g.NavWindow = window;
|
|
|
|
// Passing NULL allow to disable keyboard focus
|
|
if (!window)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
// Move the root window to the top of the pile
|
|
if (window->RootWindow)
|
|
window = window->RootWindow;
|
|
|
|
// Steal focus on active widgets
|
|
if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) // FIXME: This statement should be unnecessary. Need further testing before removing it..
|
|
if (g.ActiveId != 0 && g.ActiveIdWindow && g.ActiveIdWindow->RootWindow != window)
|
|
ClearActiveID();
|
|
|
|
// Bring to front
|
|
if (!(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoBringToFrontOnFocus))
|
|
BringWindowToFront(window);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::FocusPreviousWindow()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
for (int i = g.Windows.Size - 1; i >= 0; i--)
|
|
if (g.Windows[i]->WasActive && !(g.Windows[i]->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow))
|
|
{
|
|
FocusWindow(g.Windows[i]);
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PushItemWidth(float item_width)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
window->DC.ItemWidth = (item_width == 0.0f ? window->ItemWidthDefault : item_width);
|
|
window->DC.ItemWidthStack.push_back(window->DC.ItemWidth);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PushMultiItemsWidths(int components, float w_full)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = GImGui->Style;
|
|
if (w_full <= 0.0f)
|
|
w_full = CalcItemWidth();
|
|
const float w_item_one = ImMax(1.0f, (float)(int)((w_full - (style.ItemInnerSpacing.x) * (components-1)) / (float)components));
|
|
const float w_item_last = ImMax(1.0f, (float)(int)(w_full - (w_item_one + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x) * (components-1)));
|
|
window->DC.ItemWidthStack.push_back(w_item_last);
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < components-1; i++)
|
|
window->DC.ItemWidthStack.push_back(w_item_one);
|
|
window->DC.ItemWidth = window->DC.ItemWidthStack.back();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PopItemWidth()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
window->DC.ItemWidthStack.pop_back();
|
|
window->DC.ItemWidth = window->DC.ItemWidthStack.empty() ? window->ItemWidthDefault : window->DC.ItemWidthStack.back();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
float ImGui::CalcItemWidth()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
float w = window->DC.ItemWidth;
|
|
if (w < 0.0f)
|
|
{
|
|
// Align to a right-side limit. We include 1 frame padding in the calculation because this is how the width is always used (we add 2 frame padding to it), but we could move that responsibility to the widget as well.
|
|
float width_to_right_edge = GetContentRegionAvail().x;
|
|
w = ImMax(1.0f, width_to_right_edge + w);
|
|
}
|
|
w = (float)(int)w;
|
|
return w;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static ImFont* GetDefaultFont()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
return g.IO.FontDefault ? g.IO.FontDefault : g.IO.Fonts->Fonts[0];
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void SetCurrentFont(ImFont* font)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(font && font->IsLoaded()); // Font Atlas not created. Did you call io.Fonts->GetTexDataAsRGBA32 / GetTexDataAsAlpha8 ?
|
|
IM_ASSERT(font->Scale > 0.0f);
|
|
g.Font = font;
|
|
g.FontBaseSize = g.IO.FontGlobalScale * g.Font->FontSize * g.Font->Scale;
|
|
g.FontSize = g.CurrentWindow ? g.CurrentWindow->CalcFontSize() : 0.0f;
|
|
g.FontTexUvWhitePixel = g.Font->ContainerAtlas->TexUvWhitePixel;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PushFont(ImFont* font)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (!font)
|
|
font = GetDefaultFont();
|
|
SetCurrentFont(font);
|
|
g.FontStack.push_back(font);
|
|
g.CurrentWindow->DrawList->PushTextureID(font->ContainerAtlas->TexID);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PopFont()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
g.CurrentWindow->DrawList->PopTextureID();
|
|
g.FontStack.pop_back();
|
|
SetCurrentFont(g.FontStack.empty() ? GetDefaultFont() : g.FontStack.back());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags option, bool enabled)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (enabled)
|
|
window->DC.ItemFlags |= option;
|
|
else
|
|
window->DC.ItemFlags &= ~option;
|
|
window->DC.ItemFlagsStack.push_back(window->DC.ItemFlags);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PopItemFlag()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
window->DC.ItemFlagsStack.pop_back();
|
|
window->DC.ItemFlags = window->DC.ItemFlagsStack.empty() ? ImGuiItemFlags_Default_ : window->DC.ItemFlagsStack.back();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PushAllowKeyboardFocus(bool allow_keyboard_focus)
|
|
{
|
|
PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_AllowKeyboardFocus, allow_keyboard_focus);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PopAllowKeyboardFocus()
|
|
{
|
|
PopItemFlag();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PushButtonRepeat(bool repeat)
|
|
{
|
|
PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_ButtonRepeat, repeat);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PopButtonRepeat()
|
|
{
|
|
PopItemFlag();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PushTextWrapPos(float wrap_pos_x)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
window->DC.TextWrapPos = wrap_pos_x;
|
|
window->DC.TextWrapPosStack.push_back(wrap_pos_x);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PopTextWrapPos()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
window->DC.TextWrapPosStack.pop_back();
|
|
window->DC.TextWrapPos = window->DC.TextWrapPosStack.empty() ? -1.0f : window->DC.TextWrapPosStack.back();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// FIXME: This may incur a round-trip (if the end user got their data from a float4) but eventually we aim to store the in-flight colors as ImU32
|
|
void ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol idx, ImU32 col)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiColMod backup;
|
|
backup.Col = idx;
|
|
backup.BackupValue = g.Style.Colors[idx];
|
|
g.ColorModifiers.push_back(backup);
|
|
g.Style.Colors[idx] = ColorConvertU32ToFloat4(col);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol idx, const ImVec4& col)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiColMod backup;
|
|
backup.Col = idx;
|
|
backup.BackupValue = g.Style.Colors[idx];
|
|
g.ColorModifiers.push_back(backup);
|
|
g.Style.Colors[idx] = col;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PopStyleColor(int count)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
while (count > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiColMod& backup = g.ColorModifiers.back();
|
|
g.Style.Colors[backup.Col] = backup.BackupValue;
|
|
g.ColorModifiers.pop_back();
|
|
count--;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
struct ImGuiStyleVarInfo
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiDataType Type;
|
|
ImU32 Offset;
|
|
void* GetVarPtr(ImGuiStyle* style) const { return (void*)((unsigned char*)style + Offset); }
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
static const ImGuiStyleVarInfo GStyleVarInfo[ImGuiStyleVar_Count_] =
|
|
{
|
|
{ ImGuiDataType_Float, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, Alpha) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_Alpha
|
|
{ ImGuiDataType_Float2, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, WindowPadding) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_WindowPadding
|
|
{ ImGuiDataType_Float, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, WindowRounding) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_WindowRounding
|
|
{ ImGuiDataType_Float, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, WindowBorderSize) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_WindowBorderSize
|
|
{ ImGuiDataType_Float2, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, WindowMinSize) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_WindowMinSize
|
|
{ ImGuiDataType_Float, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, ChildRounding) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_ChildRounding
|
|
{ ImGuiDataType_Float, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, ChildBorderSize) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_ChildBorderSize
|
|
{ ImGuiDataType_Float, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, PopupRounding) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_PopupRounding
|
|
{ ImGuiDataType_Float, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, PopupBorderSize) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_PopupBorderSize
|
|
{ ImGuiDataType_Float2, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, FramePadding) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_FramePadding
|
|
{ ImGuiDataType_Float, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, FrameRounding) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_FrameRounding
|
|
{ ImGuiDataType_Float, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, FrameBorderSize) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_FrameBorderSize
|
|
{ ImGuiDataType_Float2, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, ItemSpacing) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing
|
|
{ ImGuiDataType_Float2, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, ItemInnerSpacing) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_ItemInnerSpacing
|
|
{ ImGuiDataType_Float, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, IndentSpacing) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_IndentSpacing
|
|
{ ImGuiDataType_Float, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, GrabMinSize) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_GrabMinSize
|
|
{ ImGuiDataType_Float2, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, ButtonTextAlign) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_ButtonTextAlign
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
static const ImGuiStyleVarInfo* GetStyleVarInfo(ImGuiStyleVar idx)
|
|
{
|
|
IM_ASSERT(idx >= 0 && idx < ImGuiStyleVar_Count_);
|
|
return &GStyleVarInfo[idx];
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar idx, float val)
|
|
{
|
|
const ImGuiStyleVarInfo* var_info = GetStyleVarInfo(idx);
|
|
if (var_info->Type == ImGuiDataType_Float)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
float* pvar = (float*)var_info->GetVarPtr(&g.Style);
|
|
g.StyleModifiers.push_back(ImGuiStyleMod(idx, *pvar));
|
|
*pvar = val;
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
IM_ASSERT(0); // Called function with wrong-type? Variable is not a float.
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar idx, const ImVec2& val)
|
|
{
|
|
const ImGuiStyleVarInfo* var_info = GetStyleVarInfo(idx);
|
|
if (var_info->Type == ImGuiDataType_Float2)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImVec2* pvar = (ImVec2*)var_info->GetVarPtr(&g.Style);
|
|
g.StyleModifiers.push_back(ImGuiStyleMod(idx, *pvar));
|
|
*pvar = val;
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
IM_ASSERT(0); // Called function with wrong-type? Variable is not a ImVec2.
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PopStyleVar(int count)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
while (count > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiStyleMod& backup = g.StyleModifiers.back();
|
|
const ImGuiStyleVarInfo* info = GetStyleVarInfo(backup.VarIdx);
|
|
if (info->Type == ImGuiDataType_Float) (*(float*)info->GetVarPtr(&g.Style)) = backup.BackupFloat[0];
|
|
else if (info->Type == ImGuiDataType_Float2) (*(ImVec2*)info->GetVarPtr(&g.Style)) = ImVec2(backup.BackupFloat[0], backup.BackupFloat[1]);
|
|
else if (info->Type == ImGuiDataType_Int) (*(int*)info->GetVarPtr(&g.Style)) = backup.BackupInt[0];
|
|
g.StyleModifiers.pop_back();
|
|
count--;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const char* ImGui::GetStyleColorName(ImGuiCol idx)
|
|
{
|
|
// Create switch-case from enum with regexp: ImGuiCol_{.*}, --> case ImGuiCol_\1: return "\1";
|
|
switch (idx)
|
|
{
|
|
case ImGuiCol_Text: return "Text";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_TextDisabled: return "TextDisabled";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_WindowBg: return "WindowBg";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_ChildBg: return "ChildBg";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_PopupBg: return "PopupBg";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_Border: return "Border";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_BorderShadow: return "BorderShadow";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_FrameBg: return "FrameBg";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered: return "FrameBgHovered";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive: return "FrameBgActive";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_TitleBg: return "TitleBg";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive: return "TitleBgActive";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_TitleBgCollapsed: return "TitleBgCollapsed";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_MenuBarBg: return "MenuBarBg";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_ScrollbarBg: return "ScrollbarBg";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrab: return "ScrollbarGrab";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrabHovered: return "ScrollbarGrabHovered";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrabActive: return "ScrollbarGrabActive";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_CheckMark: return "CheckMark";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_SliderGrab: return "SliderGrab";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_SliderGrabActive: return "SliderGrabActive";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_Button: return "Button";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered: return "ButtonHovered";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_ButtonActive: return "ButtonActive";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_Header: return "Header";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered: return "HeaderHovered";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_HeaderActive: return "HeaderActive";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_Separator: return "Separator";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_SeparatorHovered: return "SeparatorHovered";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_SeparatorActive: return "SeparatorActive";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_ResizeGrip: return "ResizeGrip";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_ResizeGripHovered: return "ResizeGripHovered";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_ResizeGripActive: return "ResizeGripActive";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_CloseButton: return "CloseButton";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_CloseButtonHovered: return "CloseButtonHovered";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_CloseButtonActive: return "CloseButtonActive";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_PlotLines: return "PlotLines";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_PlotLinesHovered: return "PlotLinesHovered";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_PlotHistogram: return "PlotHistogram";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_PlotHistogramHovered: return "PlotHistogramHovered";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_TextSelectedBg: return "TextSelectedBg";
|
|
case ImGuiCol_ModalWindowDarkening: return "ModalWindowDarkening";
|
|
}
|
|
IM_ASSERT(0);
|
|
return "Unknown";
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::IsWindowHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags flags)
|
|
{
|
|
IM_ASSERT((flags & ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenOverlapped) == 0); // Flags not supported by this function
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiHoveredFlags_FlattenChilds)
|
|
{
|
|
if (g.HoveredRootWindow != g.CurrentWindow->RootWindow)
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if (g.HoveredWindow != g.CurrentWindow)
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
if (!IsWindowContentHoverable(g.HoveredRootWindow, flags))
|
|
return false;
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByActiveItem))
|
|
if (g.ActiveId != 0 && !g.ActiveIdAllowOverlap && g.ActiveId != g.HoveredWindow->MoveId)
|
|
return false;
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::IsWindowFocused()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(g.CurrentWindow); // Not inside a Begin()/End()
|
|
return g.NavWindow == g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::IsRootWindowFocused()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(g.CurrentWindow); // Not inside a Begin()/End()
|
|
return g.NavWindow == g.CurrentWindow->RootWindow;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::IsRootWindowOrAnyChildFocused()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(g.CurrentWindow); // Not inside a Begin()/End()
|
|
return g.NavWindow && g.NavWindow->RootWindow == g.CurrentWindow->RootWindow;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
float ImGui::GetWindowWidth()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow;
|
|
return window->Size.x;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
float ImGui::GetWindowHeight()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow;
|
|
return window->Size.y;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImVec2 ImGui::GetWindowPos()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
return window->Pos;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void SetWindowScrollY(ImGuiWindow* window, float new_scroll_y)
|
|
{
|
|
window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y += window->Scroll.y; // SizeContents is generally computed based on CursorMaxPos which is affected by scroll position, so we need to apply our change to it.
|
|
window->Scroll.y = new_scroll_y;
|
|
window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y -= window->Scroll.y;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void SetWindowPos(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImVec2& pos, ImGuiCond cond)
|
|
{
|
|
// Test condition (NB: bit 0 is always true) and clear flags for next time
|
|
if (cond && (window->SetWindowPosAllowFlags & cond) == 0)
|
|
return;
|
|
window->SetWindowPosAllowFlags &= ~(ImGuiCond_Once | ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver | ImGuiCond_Appearing);
|
|
window->SetWindowPosVal = ImVec2(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX);
|
|
|
|
// Set
|
|
const ImVec2 old_pos = window->Pos;
|
|
window->PosFloat = pos;
|
|
window->Pos = ImVec2((float)(int)window->PosFloat.x, (float)(int)window->PosFloat.y);
|
|
window->DC.CursorPos += (window->Pos - old_pos); // As we happen to move the window while it is being appended to (which is a bad idea - will smear) let's at least offset the cursor
|
|
window->DC.CursorMaxPos += (window->Pos - old_pos); // And more importantly we need to adjust this so size calculation doesn't get affected.
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetWindowPos(const ImVec2& pos, ImGuiCond cond)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
SetWindowPos(window, pos, cond);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetWindowPos(const char* name, const ImVec2& pos, ImGuiCond cond)
|
|
{
|
|
if (ImGuiWindow* window = FindWindowByName(name))
|
|
SetWindowPos(window, pos, cond);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImVec2 ImGui::GetWindowSize()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
return window->Size;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void SetWindowSize(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiCond cond)
|
|
{
|
|
// Test condition (NB: bit 0 is always true) and clear flags for next time
|
|
if (cond && (window->SetWindowSizeAllowFlags & cond) == 0)
|
|
return;
|
|
window->SetWindowSizeAllowFlags &= ~(ImGuiCond_Once | ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver | ImGuiCond_Appearing);
|
|
|
|
// Set
|
|
if (size.x > 0.0f)
|
|
{
|
|
window->AutoFitFramesX = 0;
|
|
window->SizeFull.x = size.x;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
window->AutoFitFramesX = 2;
|
|
window->AutoFitOnlyGrows = false;
|
|
}
|
|
if (size.y > 0.0f)
|
|
{
|
|
window->AutoFitFramesY = 0;
|
|
window->SizeFull.y = size.y;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
window->AutoFitFramesY = 2;
|
|
window->AutoFitOnlyGrows = false;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetWindowSize(const ImVec2& size, ImGuiCond cond)
|
|
{
|
|
SetWindowSize(GImGui->CurrentWindow, size, cond);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetWindowSize(const char* name, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiCond cond)
|
|
{
|
|
if (ImGuiWindow* window = FindWindowByName(name))
|
|
SetWindowSize(window, size, cond);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void SetWindowCollapsed(ImGuiWindow* window, bool collapsed, ImGuiCond cond)
|
|
{
|
|
// Test condition (NB: bit 0 is always true) and clear flags for next time
|
|
if (cond && (window->SetWindowCollapsedAllowFlags & cond) == 0)
|
|
return;
|
|
window->SetWindowCollapsedAllowFlags &= ~(ImGuiCond_Once | ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver | ImGuiCond_Appearing);
|
|
|
|
// Set
|
|
window->Collapsed = collapsed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetWindowCollapsed(bool collapsed, ImGuiCond cond)
|
|
{
|
|
SetWindowCollapsed(GImGui->CurrentWindow, collapsed, cond);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::IsWindowCollapsed()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
return window->Collapsed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::IsWindowAppearing()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
return window->Appearing;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetWindowCollapsed(const char* name, bool collapsed, ImGuiCond cond)
|
|
{
|
|
if (ImGuiWindow* window = FindWindowByName(name))
|
|
SetWindowCollapsed(window, collapsed, cond);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetWindowFocus()
|
|
{
|
|
FocusWindow(GImGui->CurrentWindow);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetWindowFocus(const char* name)
|
|
{
|
|
if (name)
|
|
{
|
|
if (ImGuiWindow* window = FindWindowByName(name))
|
|
FocusWindow(window);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
FocusWindow(NULL);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetNextWindowPos(const ImVec2& pos, ImGuiCond cond, const ImVec2& pivot)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
g.SetNextWindowPosVal = pos;
|
|
g.SetNextWindowPosPivot = pivot;
|
|
g.SetNextWindowPosCond = cond ? cond : ImGuiCond_Always;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetNextWindowSize(const ImVec2& size, ImGuiCond cond)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
g.SetNextWindowSizeVal = size;
|
|
g.SetNextWindowSizeCond = cond ? cond : ImGuiCond_Always;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(const ImVec2& size_min, const ImVec2& size_max, ImGuiSizeConstraintCallback custom_callback, void* custom_callback_user_data)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraint = true;
|
|
g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraintRect = ImRect(size_min, size_max);
|
|
g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraintCallback = custom_callback;
|
|
g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraintCallbackUserData = custom_callback_user_data;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetNextWindowContentSize(const ImVec2& size)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
g.SetNextWindowContentSizeVal = size;
|
|
g.SetNextWindowContentSizeCond = ImGuiCond_Always;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetNextWindowContentWidth(float width)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
g.SetNextWindowContentSizeVal = ImVec2(width, g.SetNextWindowContentSizeCond ? g.SetNextWindowContentSizeVal.y : 0.0f);
|
|
g.SetNextWindowContentSizeCond = ImGuiCond_Always;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetNextWindowCollapsed(bool collapsed, ImGuiCond cond)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
g.SetNextWindowCollapsedVal = collapsed;
|
|
g.SetNextWindowCollapsedCond = cond ? cond : ImGuiCond_Always;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetNextWindowFocus()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
g.SetNextWindowFocus = true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// In window space (not screen space!)
|
|
ImVec2 ImGui::GetContentRegionMax()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
ImVec2 mx = window->ContentsRegionRect.Max;
|
|
if (window->DC.ColumnsCount != 1)
|
|
mx.x = GetColumnOffset(window->DC.ColumnsCurrent + 1) - window->WindowPadding.x;
|
|
return mx;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImVec2 ImGui::GetContentRegionAvail()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
return GetContentRegionMax() - (window->DC.CursorPos - window->Pos);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
float ImGui::GetContentRegionAvailWidth()
|
|
{
|
|
return GetContentRegionAvail().x;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// In window space (not screen space!)
|
|
ImVec2 ImGui::GetWindowContentRegionMin()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
return window->ContentsRegionRect.Min;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImVec2 ImGui::GetWindowContentRegionMax()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
return window->ContentsRegionRect.Max;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
float ImGui::GetWindowContentRegionWidth()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
return window->ContentsRegionRect.Max.x - window->ContentsRegionRect.Min.x;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
float ImGui::GetTextLineHeight()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
return g.FontSize;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
float ImGui::GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
return g.FontSize + g.Style.ItemSpacing.y;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
float ImGui::GetItemsLineHeightWithSpacing()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
return g.FontSize + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f + g.Style.ItemSpacing.y;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImDrawList* ImGui::GetWindowDrawList()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
return window->DrawList;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImFont* ImGui::GetFont()
|
|
{
|
|
return GImGui->Font;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
float ImGui::GetFontSize()
|
|
{
|
|
return GImGui->FontSize;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImVec2 ImGui::GetFontTexUvWhitePixel()
|
|
{
|
|
return GImGui->FontTexUvWhitePixel;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetWindowFontScale(float scale)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
window->FontWindowScale = scale;
|
|
g.FontSize = window->CalcFontSize();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// User generally sees positions in window coordinates. Internally we store CursorPos in absolute screen coordinates because it is more convenient.
|
|
// Conversion happens as we pass the value to user, but it makes our naming convention confusing because GetCursorPos() == (DC.CursorPos - window.Pos). May want to rename 'DC.CursorPos'.
|
|
ImVec2 ImGui::GetCursorPos()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
return window->DC.CursorPos - window->Pos + window->Scroll;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
float ImGui::GetCursorPosX()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
return window->DC.CursorPos.x - window->Pos.x + window->Scroll.x;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
float ImGui::GetCursorPosY()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
return window->DC.CursorPos.y - window->Pos.y + window->Scroll.y;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetCursorPos(const ImVec2& local_pos)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
window->DC.CursorPos = window->Pos - window->Scroll + local_pos;
|
|
window->DC.CursorMaxPos = ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos, window->DC.CursorPos);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetCursorPosX(float x)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
window->DC.CursorPos.x = window->Pos.x - window->Scroll.x + x;
|
|
window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x = ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x, window->DC.CursorPos.x);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetCursorPosY(float y)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
window->DC.CursorPos.y = window->Pos.y - window->Scroll.y + y;
|
|
window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y = ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y, window->DC.CursorPos.y);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImVec2 ImGui::GetCursorStartPos()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
return window->DC.CursorStartPos - window->Pos;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImVec2 ImGui::GetCursorScreenPos()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
return window->DC.CursorPos;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetCursorScreenPos(const ImVec2& screen_pos)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
window->DC.CursorPos = screen_pos;
|
|
window->DC.CursorMaxPos = ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos, window->DC.CursorPos);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
float ImGui::GetScrollX()
|
|
{
|
|
return GImGui->CurrentWindow->Scroll.x;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
float ImGui::GetScrollY()
|
|
{
|
|
return GImGui->CurrentWindow->Scroll.y;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
float ImGui::GetScrollMaxX()
|
|
{
|
|
return GetScrollMaxX(GImGui->CurrentWindow);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
float ImGui::GetScrollMaxY()
|
|
{
|
|
return GetScrollMaxY(GImGui->CurrentWindow);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetScrollX(float scroll_x)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
window->ScrollTarget.x = scroll_x;
|
|
window->ScrollTargetCenterRatio.x = 0.0f;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetScrollY(float scroll_y)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
window->ScrollTarget.y = scroll_y + window->TitleBarHeight() + window->MenuBarHeight(); // title bar height canceled out when using ScrollTargetRelY
|
|
window->ScrollTargetCenterRatio.y = 0.0f;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetScrollFromPosY(float pos_y, float center_y_ratio)
|
|
{
|
|
// We store a target position so centering can occur on the next frame when we are guaranteed to have a known window size
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
IM_ASSERT(center_y_ratio >= 0.0f && center_y_ratio <= 1.0f);
|
|
window->ScrollTarget.y = (float)(int)(pos_y + window->Scroll.y);
|
|
window->ScrollTargetCenterRatio.y = center_y_ratio;
|
|
|
|
// Minor hack to to make scrolling to top/bottom of window take account of WindowPadding, it looks more right to the user this way
|
|
if (center_y_ratio <= 0.0f && window->ScrollTarget.y <= window->WindowPadding.y)
|
|
window->ScrollTarget.y = 0.0f;
|
|
else if (center_y_ratio >= 1.0f && window->ScrollTarget.y >= window->SizeContents.y - window->WindowPadding.y + GImGui->Style.ItemSpacing.y)
|
|
window->ScrollTarget.y = window->SizeContents.y;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// center_y_ratio: 0.0f top of last item, 0.5f vertical center of last item, 1.0f bottom of last item.
|
|
void ImGui::SetScrollHere(float center_y_ratio)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
float target_y = window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine.y - window->Pos.y; // Top of last item, in window space
|
|
target_y += (window->DC.PrevLineHeight * center_y_ratio) + (GImGui->Style.ItemSpacing.y * (center_y_ratio - 0.5f) * 2.0f); // Precisely aim above, in the middle or below the last line.
|
|
SetScrollFromPosY(target_y, center_y_ratio);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetKeyboardFocusHere(int offset)
|
|
{
|
|
IM_ASSERT(offset >= -1); // -1 is allowed but not below
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
window->FocusIdxAllRequestNext = window->FocusIdxAllCounter + 1 + offset;
|
|
window->FocusIdxTabRequestNext = INT_MAX;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetStateStorage(ImGuiStorage* tree)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
window->DC.StateStorage = tree ? tree : &window->StateStorage;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImGuiStorage* ImGui::GetStateStorage()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
return window->DC.StateStorage;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::TextV(const char* fmt, va_list args)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const char* text_end = g.TempBuffer + ImFormatStringV(g.TempBuffer, IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.TempBuffer), fmt, args);
|
|
TextUnformatted(g.TempBuffer, text_end);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::Text(const char* fmt, ...)
|
|
{
|
|
va_list args;
|
|
va_start(args, fmt);
|
|
TextV(fmt, args);
|
|
va_end(args);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::TextColoredV(const ImVec4& col, const char* fmt, va_list args)
|
|
{
|
|
PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, col);
|
|
TextV(fmt, args);
|
|
PopStyleColor();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::TextColored(const ImVec4& col, const char* fmt, ...)
|
|
{
|
|
va_list args;
|
|
va_start(args, fmt);
|
|
TextColoredV(col, fmt, args);
|
|
va_end(args);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::TextDisabledV(const char* fmt, va_list args)
|
|
{
|
|
PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, GImGui->Style.Colors[ImGuiCol_TextDisabled]);
|
|
TextV(fmt, args);
|
|
PopStyleColor();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::TextDisabled(const char* fmt, ...)
|
|
{
|
|
va_list args;
|
|
va_start(args, fmt);
|
|
TextDisabledV(fmt, args);
|
|
va_end(args);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::TextWrappedV(const char* fmt, va_list args)
|
|
{
|
|
bool need_wrap = (GImGui->CurrentWindow->DC.TextWrapPos < 0.0f); // Keep existing wrap position is one ia already set
|
|
if (need_wrap) PushTextWrapPos(0.0f);
|
|
TextV(fmt, args);
|
|
if (need_wrap) PopTextWrapPos();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::TextWrapped(const char* fmt, ...)
|
|
{
|
|
va_list args;
|
|
va_start(args, fmt);
|
|
TextWrappedV(fmt, args);
|
|
va_end(args);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::TextUnformatted(const char* text, const char* text_end)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(text != NULL);
|
|
const char* text_begin = text;
|
|
if (text_end == NULL)
|
|
text_end = text + strlen(text); // FIXME-OPT
|
|
|
|
const ImVec2 text_pos(window->DC.CursorPos.x, window->DC.CursorPos.y + window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset);
|
|
const float wrap_pos_x = window->DC.TextWrapPos;
|
|
const bool wrap_enabled = wrap_pos_x >= 0.0f;
|
|
if (text_end - text > 2000 && !wrap_enabled)
|
|
{
|
|
// Long text!
|
|
// Perform manual coarse clipping to optimize for long multi-line text
|
|
// From this point we will only compute the width of lines that are visible. Optimization only available when word-wrapping is disabled.
|
|
// We also don't vertically center the text within the line full height, which is unlikely to matter because we are likely the biggest and only item on the line.
|
|
const char* line = text;
|
|
const float line_height = GetTextLineHeight();
|
|
const ImRect clip_rect = window->ClipRect;
|
|
ImVec2 text_size(0,0);
|
|
|
|
if (text_pos.y <= clip_rect.Max.y)
|
|
{
|
|
ImVec2 pos = text_pos;
|
|
|
|
// Lines to skip (can't skip when logging text)
|
|
if (!g.LogEnabled)
|
|
{
|
|
int lines_skippable = (int)((clip_rect.Min.y - text_pos.y) / line_height);
|
|
if (lines_skippable > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
int lines_skipped = 0;
|
|
while (line < text_end && lines_skipped < lines_skippable)
|
|
{
|
|
const char* line_end = strchr(line, '\n');
|
|
if (!line_end)
|
|
line_end = text_end;
|
|
line = line_end + 1;
|
|
lines_skipped++;
|
|
}
|
|
pos.y += lines_skipped * line_height;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Lines to render
|
|
if (line < text_end)
|
|
{
|
|
ImRect line_rect(pos, pos + ImVec2(FLT_MAX, line_height));
|
|
while (line < text_end)
|
|
{
|
|
const char* line_end = strchr(line, '\n');
|
|
if (IsClippedEx(line_rect, 0, false))
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
const ImVec2 line_size = CalcTextSize(line, line_end, false);
|
|
text_size.x = ImMax(text_size.x, line_size.x);
|
|
RenderText(pos, line, line_end, false);
|
|
if (!line_end)
|
|
line_end = text_end;
|
|
line = line_end + 1;
|
|
line_rect.Min.y += line_height;
|
|
line_rect.Max.y += line_height;
|
|
pos.y += line_height;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Count remaining lines
|
|
int lines_skipped = 0;
|
|
while (line < text_end)
|
|
{
|
|
const char* line_end = strchr(line, '\n');
|
|
if (!line_end)
|
|
line_end = text_end;
|
|
line = line_end + 1;
|
|
lines_skipped++;
|
|
}
|
|
pos.y += lines_skipped * line_height;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
text_size.y += (pos - text_pos).y;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImRect bb(text_pos, text_pos + text_size);
|
|
ItemSize(bb);
|
|
ItemAdd(bb, 0);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
const float wrap_width = wrap_enabled ? CalcWrapWidthForPos(window->DC.CursorPos, wrap_pos_x) : 0.0f;
|
|
const ImVec2 text_size = CalcTextSize(text_begin, text_end, false, wrap_width);
|
|
|
|
// Account of baseline offset
|
|
ImRect bb(text_pos, text_pos + text_size);
|
|
ItemSize(text_size);
|
|
if (!ItemAdd(bb, 0))
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
// Render (we don't hide text after ## in this end-user function)
|
|
RenderTextWrapped(bb.Min, text_begin, text_end, wrap_width);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::AlignTextToFramePadding()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
window->DC.CurrentLineHeight = ImMax(window->DC.CurrentLineHeight, g.FontSize + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2);
|
|
window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset = ImMax(window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset, g.Style.FramePadding.y);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Add a label+text combo aligned to other label+value widgets
|
|
void ImGui::LabelTextV(const char* label, const char* fmt, va_list args)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
const float w = CalcItemWidth();
|
|
|
|
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
|
|
const ImRect value_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(w, label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y*2));
|
|
const ImRect total_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(w + (label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x : 0.0f), style.FramePadding.y*2) + label_size);
|
|
ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y);
|
|
if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, 0))
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
// Render
|
|
const char* value_text_begin = &g.TempBuffer[0];
|
|
const char* value_text_end = value_text_begin + ImFormatStringV(g.TempBuffer, IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.TempBuffer), fmt, args);
|
|
RenderTextClipped(value_bb.Min, value_bb.Max, value_text_begin, value_text_end, NULL, ImVec2(0.0f,0.5f));
|
|
if (label_size.x > 0.0f)
|
|
RenderText(ImVec2(value_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, value_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::LabelText(const char* label, const char* fmt, ...)
|
|
{
|
|
va_list args;
|
|
va_start(args, fmt);
|
|
LabelTextV(label, fmt, args);
|
|
va_end(args);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::ButtonBehavior(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, bool* out_hovered, bool* out_held, ImGuiButtonFlags flags)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_Disabled)
|
|
{
|
|
if (out_hovered) *out_hovered = false;
|
|
if (out_held) *out_held = false;
|
|
if (g.ActiveId == id) ClearActiveID();
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Default behavior requires click+release on same spot
|
|
if ((flags & (ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease | ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick | ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnRelease | ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDoubleClick)) == 0)
|
|
flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiWindow* backup_hovered_window = g.HoveredWindow;
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_FlattenChilds) && g.HoveredRootWindow == window)
|
|
g.HoveredWindow = window;
|
|
|
|
bool pressed = false;
|
|
bool hovered = ItemHoverable(bb, id);
|
|
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_FlattenChilds) && g.HoveredRootWindow == window)
|
|
g.HoveredWindow = backup_hovered_window;
|
|
|
|
// AllowOverlap mode (rarely used) requires previous frame HoveredId to be null or to match. This allows using patterns where a later submitted widget overlaps a previous one.
|
|
if (hovered && (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_AllowOverlapMode) && (g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame != id && g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame != 0))
|
|
hovered = false;
|
|
|
|
if (hovered)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_NoKeyModifiers) || (!g.IO.KeyCtrl && !g.IO.KeyShift && !g.IO.KeyAlt))
|
|
{
|
|
// | CLICKING | HOLDING with ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat
|
|
// PressedOnClickRelease | <on release>* | <on repeat> <on repeat> .. (NOT on release) <-- MOST COMMON! (*) only if both click/release were over bounds
|
|
// PressedOnClick | <on click> | <on click> <on repeat> <on repeat> ..
|
|
// PressedOnRelease | <on release> | <on repeat> <on repeat> .. (NOT on release)
|
|
// PressedOnDoubleClick | <on dclick> | <on dclick> <on repeat> <on repeat> ..
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease) && g.IO.MouseClicked[0])
|
|
{
|
|
SetActiveID(id, window); // Hold on ID
|
|
FocusWindow(window);
|
|
g.ActiveIdClickOffset = g.IO.MousePos - bb.Min;
|
|
}
|
|
if (((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick) && g.IO.MouseClicked[0]) || ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDoubleClick) && g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[0]))
|
|
{
|
|
pressed = true;
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_NoHoldingActiveID)
|
|
{
|
|
ClearActiveID();
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
SetActiveID(id, window); // Hold on ID
|
|
g.ActiveIdClickOffset = g.IO.MousePos - bb.Min;
|
|
}
|
|
FocusWindow(window);
|
|
}
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnRelease) && g.IO.MouseReleased[0])
|
|
{
|
|
if (!((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat) && g.IO.MouseDownDurationPrev[0] >= g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay)) // Repeat mode trumps <on release>
|
|
pressed = true;
|
|
ClearActiveID();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// 'Repeat' mode acts when held regardless of _PressedOn flags (see table above).
|
|
// Relies on repeat logic of IsMouseClicked() but we may as well do it ourselves if we end up exposing finer RepeatDelay/RepeatRate settings.
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat) && g.ActiveId == id && g.IO.MouseDownDuration[0] > 0.0f && IsMouseClicked(0, true))
|
|
pressed = true;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool held = false;
|
|
if (g.ActiveId == id)
|
|
{
|
|
if (g.IO.MouseDown[0])
|
|
{
|
|
held = true;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if (hovered && (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease))
|
|
if (!((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat) && g.IO.MouseDownDurationPrev[0] >= g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay)) // Repeat mode trumps <on release>
|
|
pressed = true;
|
|
ClearActiveID();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (out_hovered) *out_hovered = hovered;
|
|
if (out_held) *out_held = held;
|
|
|
|
return pressed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::ButtonEx(const char* label, const ImVec2& size_arg, ImGuiButtonFlags flags)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label);
|
|
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
|
|
|
|
ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos;
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_AlignTextBaseLine) && style.FramePadding.y < window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset) // Try to vertically align buttons that are smaller/have no padding so that text baseline matches (bit hacky, since it shouldn't be a flag)
|
|
pos.y += window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset - style.FramePadding.y;
|
|
ImVec2 size = CalcItemSize(size_arg, label_size.x + style.FramePadding.x * 2.0f, label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f);
|
|
|
|
const ImRect bb(pos, pos + size);
|
|
ItemSize(bb, style.FramePadding.y);
|
|
if (!ItemAdd(bb, id))
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
if (window->DC.ItemFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_ButtonRepeat) flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat;
|
|
bool hovered, held;
|
|
bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held, flags);
|
|
|
|
// Render
|
|
const ImU32 col = GetColorU32((hovered && held) ? ImGuiCol_ButtonActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered : ImGuiCol_Button);
|
|
RenderFrame(bb.Min, bb.Max, col, true, style.FrameRounding);
|
|
RenderTextClipped(bb.Min + style.FramePadding, bb.Max - style.FramePadding, label, NULL, &label_size, style.ButtonTextAlign, &bb);
|
|
|
|
// Automatically close popups
|
|
//if (pressed && !(flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_DontClosePopups) && (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup))
|
|
// CloseCurrentPopup();
|
|
|
|
return pressed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::Button(const char* label, const ImVec2& size_arg)
|
|
{
|
|
return ButtonEx(label, size_arg, 0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Small buttons fits within text without additional vertical spacing.
|
|
bool ImGui::SmallButton(const char* label)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
float backup_padding_y = g.Style.FramePadding.y;
|
|
g.Style.FramePadding.y = 0.0f;
|
|
bool pressed = ButtonEx(label, ImVec2(0,0), ImGuiButtonFlags_AlignTextBaseLine);
|
|
g.Style.FramePadding.y = backup_padding_y;
|
|
return pressed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Tip: use ImGui::PushID()/PopID() to push indices or pointers in the ID stack.
|
|
// Then you can keep 'str_id' empty or the same for all your buttons (instead of creating a string based on a non-string id)
|
|
bool ImGui::InvisibleButton(const char* str_id, const ImVec2& size_arg)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(str_id);
|
|
ImVec2 size = CalcItemSize(size_arg, 0.0f, 0.0f);
|
|
const ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size);
|
|
ItemSize(bb);
|
|
if (!ItemAdd(bb, id))
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
bool hovered, held;
|
|
bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held);
|
|
|
|
return pressed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Upper-right button to close a window.
|
|
bool ImGui::CloseButton(ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& pos, float radius)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
|
|
const ImRect bb(pos - ImVec2(radius,radius), pos + ImVec2(radius,radius));
|
|
|
|
bool hovered, held;
|
|
bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held);
|
|
|
|
// Render
|
|
const ImU32 col = GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_CloseButtonActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_CloseButtonHovered : ImGuiCol_CloseButton);
|
|
const ImVec2 center = bb.GetCenter();
|
|
window->DrawList->AddCircleFilled(center, ImMax(2.0f, radius), col, 12);
|
|
|
|
const float cross_extent = (radius * 0.7071f) - 1.0f;
|
|
if (hovered)
|
|
{
|
|
window->DrawList->AddLine(center + ImVec2(+cross_extent,+cross_extent), center + ImVec2(-cross_extent,-cross_extent), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text));
|
|
window->DrawList->AddLine(center + ImVec2(+cross_extent,-cross_extent), center + ImVec2(-cross_extent,+cross_extent), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return pressed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// [Internal]
|
|
bool ImGui::ArrowButton(ImGuiID id, ImGuiDir dir, ImVec2 padding, ImGuiButtonFlags flags)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
|
|
const ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(g.FontSize + padding.x * 2.0f, g.FontSize + padding.y * 2.0f));
|
|
ItemSize(bb, style.FramePadding.y);
|
|
if (!ItemAdd(bb, id))
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
bool hovered, held;
|
|
bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held, flags);
|
|
|
|
const ImU32 col = GetColorU32((hovered && held) ? ImGuiCol_ButtonActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered : ImGuiCol_Button);
|
|
#ifdef IMGUI_HAS_NAV
|
|
RenderNavHighlight(bb, id);
|
|
#endif
|
|
RenderFrame(bb.Min, bb.Max, col, true, style.FrameRounding);
|
|
RenderTriangle(bb.Min + padding, dir, 1.0f);
|
|
|
|
return pressed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::Image(ImTextureID user_texture_id, const ImVec2& size, const ImVec2& uv0, const ImVec2& uv1, const ImVec4& tint_col, const ImVec4& border_col)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size);
|
|
if (border_col.w > 0.0f)
|
|
bb.Max += ImVec2(2,2);
|
|
ItemSize(bb);
|
|
if (!ItemAdd(bb, 0))
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
if (border_col.w > 0.0f)
|
|
{
|
|
window->DrawList->AddRect(bb.Min, bb.Max, GetColorU32(border_col), 0.0f);
|
|
window->DrawList->AddImage(user_texture_id, bb.Min+ImVec2(1,1), bb.Max-ImVec2(1,1), uv0, uv1, GetColorU32(tint_col));
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
window->DrawList->AddImage(user_texture_id, bb.Min, bb.Max, uv0, uv1, GetColorU32(tint_col));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// frame_padding < 0: uses FramePadding from style (default)
|
|
// frame_padding = 0: no framing
|
|
// frame_padding > 0: set framing size
|
|
// The color used are the button colors.
|
|
bool ImGui::ImageButton(ImTextureID user_texture_id, const ImVec2& size, const ImVec2& uv0, const ImVec2& uv1, int frame_padding, const ImVec4& bg_col, const ImVec4& tint_col)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
|
|
// Default to using texture ID as ID. User can still push string/integer prefixes.
|
|
// We could hash the size/uv to create a unique ID but that would prevent the user from animating UV.
|
|
PushID((void *)user_texture_id);
|
|
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID("#image");
|
|
PopID();
|
|
|
|
const ImVec2 padding = (frame_padding >= 0) ? ImVec2((float)frame_padding, (float)frame_padding) : style.FramePadding;
|
|
const ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size + padding*2);
|
|
const ImRect image_bb(window->DC.CursorPos + padding, window->DC.CursorPos + padding + size);
|
|
ItemSize(bb);
|
|
if (!ItemAdd(bb, id))
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
bool hovered, held;
|
|
bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held);
|
|
|
|
// Render
|
|
const ImU32 col = GetColorU32((hovered && held) ? ImGuiCol_ButtonActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered : ImGuiCol_Button);
|
|
RenderFrame(bb.Min, bb.Max, col, true, ImClamp((float)ImMin(padding.x, padding.y), 0.0f, style.FrameRounding));
|
|
if (bg_col.w > 0.0f)
|
|
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(image_bb.Min, image_bb.Max, GetColorU32(bg_col));
|
|
window->DrawList->AddImage(user_texture_id, image_bb.Min, image_bb.Max, uv0, uv1, GetColorU32(tint_col));
|
|
|
|
return pressed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Start logging ImGui output to TTY
|
|
void ImGui::LogToTTY(int max_depth)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (g.LogEnabled)
|
|
return;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
|
|
g.LogEnabled = true;
|
|
g.LogFile = stdout;
|
|
g.LogStartDepth = window->DC.TreeDepth;
|
|
if (max_depth >= 0)
|
|
g.LogAutoExpandMaxDepth = max_depth;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Start logging ImGui output to given file
|
|
void ImGui::LogToFile(int max_depth, const char* filename)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (g.LogEnabled)
|
|
return;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
|
|
if (!filename)
|
|
{
|
|
filename = g.IO.LogFilename;
|
|
if (!filename)
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
g.LogFile = ImFileOpen(filename, "ab");
|
|
if (!g.LogFile)
|
|
{
|
|
IM_ASSERT(g.LogFile != NULL); // Consider this an error
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
g.LogEnabled = true;
|
|
g.LogStartDepth = window->DC.TreeDepth;
|
|
if (max_depth >= 0)
|
|
g.LogAutoExpandMaxDepth = max_depth;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Start logging ImGui output to clipboard
|
|
void ImGui::LogToClipboard(int max_depth)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (g.LogEnabled)
|
|
return;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
|
|
g.LogEnabled = true;
|
|
g.LogFile = NULL;
|
|
g.LogStartDepth = window->DC.TreeDepth;
|
|
if (max_depth >= 0)
|
|
g.LogAutoExpandMaxDepth = max_depth;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::LogFinish()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (!g.LogEnabled)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
LogText(IM_NEWLINE);
|
|
g.LogEnabled = false;
|
|
if (g.LogFile != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
if (g.LogFile == stdout)
|
|
fflush(g.LogFile);
|
|
else
|
|
fclose(g.LogFile);
|
|
g.LogFile = NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
if (g.LogClipboard->size() > 1)
|
|
{
|
|
SetClipboardText(g.LogClipboard->begin());
|
|
g.LogClipboard->clear();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Helper to display logging buttons
|
|
void ImGui::LogButtons()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
|
|
PushID("LogButtons");
|
|
const bool log_to_tty = Button("Log To TTY"); SameLine();
|
|
const bool log_to_file = Button("Log To File"); SameLine();
|
|
const bool log_to_clipboard = Button("Log To Clipboard"); SameLine();
|
|
PushItemWidth(80.0f);
|
|
PushAllowKeyboardFocus(false);
|
|
SliderInt("Depth", &g.LogAutoExpandMaxDepth, 0, 9, NULL);
|
|
PopAllowKeyboardFocus();
|
|
PopItemWidth();
|
|
PopID();
|
|
|
|
// Start logging at the end of the function so that the buttons don't appear in the log
|
|
if (log_to_tty)
|
|
LogToTTY(g.LogAutoExpandMaxDepth);
|
|
if (log_to_file)
|
|
LogToFile(g.LogAutoExpandMaxDepth, g.IO.LogFilename);
|
|
if (log_to_clipboard)
|
|
LogToClipboard(g.LogAutoExpandMaxDepth);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::TreeNodeBehaviorIsOpen(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags)
|
|
{
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Leaf)
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
// We only write to the tree storage if the user clicks (or explicitely use SetNextTreeNode*** functions)
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
ImGuiStorage* storage = window->DC.StateStorage;
|
|
|
|
bool is_open;
|
|
if (g.SetNextTreeNodeOpenCond != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
if (g.SetNextTreeNodeOpenCond & ImGuiCond_Always)
|
|
{
|
|
is_open = g.SetNextTreeNodeOpenVal;
|
|
storage->SetInt(id, is_open);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// We treat ImGuiCond_Once and ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver the same because tree node state are not saved persistently.
|
|
const int stored_value = storage->GetInt(id, -1);
|
|
if (stored_value == -1)
|
|
{
|
|
is_open = g.SetNextTreeNodeOpenVal;
|
|
storage->SetInt(id, is_open);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
is_open = stored_value != 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
g.SetNextTreeNodeOpenCond = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
is_open = storage->GetInt(id, (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_DefaultOpen) ? 1 : 0) != 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// When logging is enabled, we automatically expand tree nodes (but *NOT* collapsing headers.. seems like sensible behavior).
|
|
// NB- If we are above max depth we still allow manually opened nodes to be logged.
|
|
if (g.LogEnabled && !(flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoAutoOpenOnLog) && window->DC.TreeDepth < g.LogAutoExpandMaxDepth)
|
|
is_open = true;
|
|
|
|
return is_open;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::TreeNodeBehavior(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* label, const char* label_end)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
const bool display_frame = (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Framed) != 0;
|
|
const ImVec2 padding = (display_frame || (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_FramePadding)) ? style.FramePadding : ImVec2(style.FramePadding.x, 0.0f);
|
|
|
|
if (!label_end)
|
|
label_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(label);
|
|
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, label_end, false);
|
|
|
|
// We vertically grow up to current line height up the typical widget height.
|
|
const float text_base_offset_y = ImMax(padding.y, window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset); // Latch before ItemSize changes it
|
|
const float frame_height = ImMax(ImMin(window->DC.CurrentLineHeight, g.FontSize + style.FramePadding.y*2), label_size.y + padding.y*2);
|
|
ImRect bb = ImRect(window->DC.CursorPos, ImVec2(window->Pos.x + GetContentRegionMax().x, window->DC.CursorPos.y + frame_height));
|
|
if (display_frame)
|
|
{
|
|
// Framed header expand a little outside the default padding
|
|
bb.Min.x -= (float)(int)(window->WindowPadding.x*0.5f) - 1;
|
|
bb.Max.x += (float)(int)(window->WindowPadding.x*0.5f) - 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const float text_offset_x = (g.FontSize + (display_frame ? padding.x*3 : padding.x*2)); // Collapser arrow width + Spacing
|
|
const float text_width = g.FontSize + (label_size.x > 0.0f ? label_size.x + padding.x*2 : 0.0f); // Include collapser
|
|
ItemSize(ImVec2(text_width, frame_height), text_base_offset_y);
|
|
|
|
// For regular tree nodes, we arbitrary allow to click past 2 worth of ItemSpacing
|
|
// (Ideally we'd want to add a flag for the user to specify if we want the hit test to be done up to the right side of the content or not)
|
|
const ImRect interact_bb = display_frame ? bb : ImRect(bb.Min.x, bb.Min.y, bb.Min.x + text_width + style.ItemSpacing.x*2, bb.Max.y);
|
|
bool is_open = TreeNodeBehaviorIsOpen(id, flags);
|
|
if (!ItemAdd(interact_bb, id))
|
|
{
|
|
if (is_open && !(flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen))
|
|
TreePushRawID(id);
|
|
return is_open;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Flags that affects opening behavior:
|
|
// - 0(default) ..................... single-click anywhere to open
|
|
// - OpenOnDoubleClick .............. double-click anywhere to open
|
|
// - OpenOnArrow .................... single-click on arrow to open
|
|
// - OpenOnDoubleClick|OpenOnArrow .. single-click on arrow or double-click anywhere to open
|
|
ImGuiButtonFlags button_flags = ImGuiButtonFlags_NoKeyModifiers | ((flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_AllowOverlapMode) ? ImGuiButtonFlags_AllowOverlapMode : 0);
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick)
|
|
button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDoubleClick | ((flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnArrow) ? ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease : 0);
|
|
bool hovered, held, pressed = ButtonBehavior(interact_bb, id, &hovered, &held, button_flags);
|
|
if (pressed && !(flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Leaf))
|
|
{
|
|
bool toggled = !(flags & (ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnArrow | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick));
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnArrow)
|
|
toggled |= IsMouseHoveringRect(interact_bb.Min, ImVec2(interact_bb.Min.x + text_offset_x, interact_bb.Max.y));
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick)
|
|
toggled |= g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[0];
|
|
if (toggled)
|
|
{
|
|
is_open = !is_open;
|
|
window->DC.StateStorage->SetInt(id, is_open);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_AllowOverlapMode)
|
|
SetItemAllowOverlap();
|
|
|
|
// Render
|
|
const ImU32 col = GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_HeaderActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered : ImGuiCol_Header);
|
|
const ImVec2 text_pos = bb.Min + ImVec2(text_offset_x, text_base_offset_y);
|
|
if (display_frame)
|
|
{
|
|
// Framed type
|
|
RenderFrame(bb.Min, bb.Max, col, true, style.FrameRounding);
|
|
RenderTriangle(bb.Min + ImVec2(padding.x, text_base_offset_y), is_open ? ImGuiDir_Down : ImGuiDir_Right, 1.0f);
|
|
if (g.LogEnabled)
|
|
{
|
|
// NB: '##' is normally used to hide text (as a library-wide feature), so we need to specify the text range to make sure the ## aren't stripped out here.
|
|
const char log_prefix[] = "\n##";
|
|
const char log_suffix[] = "##";
|
|
LogRenderedText(&text_pos, log_prefix, log_prefix+3);
|
|
RenderTextClipped(text_pos, bb.Max, label, label_end, &label_size);
|
|
LogRenderedText(&text_pos, log_suffix+1, log_suffix+3);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
RenderTextClipped(text_pos, bb.Max, label, label_end, &label_size);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// Unframed typed for tree nodes
|
|
if (hovered || (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Selected))
|
|
RenderFrame(bb.Min, bb.Max, col, false);
|
|
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Bullet)
|
|
RenderBullet(bb.Min + ImVec2(text_offset_x * 0.5f, g.FontSize*0.50f + text_base_offset_y));
|
|
else if (!(flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Leaf))
|
|
RenderTriangle(bb.Min + ImVec2(padding.x, g.FontSize*0.15f + text_base_offset_y), is_open ? ImGuiDir_Down : ImGuiDir_Right, 0.70f);
|
|
if (g.LogEnabled)
|
|
LogRenderedText(&text_pos, ">");
|
|
RenderText(text_pos, label, label_end, false);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (is_open && !(flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen))
|
|
TreePushRawID(id);
|
|
return is_open;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CollapsingHeader returns true when opened but do not indent nor push into the ID stack (because of the ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen flag).
|
|
// This is basically the same as calling TreeNodeEx(label, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_CollapsingHeader | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen). You can remove the _NoTreePushOnOpen flag if you want behavior closer to normal TreeNode().
|
|
bool ImGui::CollapsingHeader(const char* label, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
return TreeNodeBehavior(window->GetID(label), flags | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_CollapsingHeader | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen, label);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::CollapsingHeader(const char* label, bool* p_open, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
if (p_open && !*p_open)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label);
|
|
bool is_open = TreeNodeBehavior(id, flags | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_CollapsingHeader | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen | (p_open ? ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_AllowOverlapMode : 0), label);
|
|
if (p_open)
|
|
{
|
|
// Create a small overlapping close button // FIXME: We can evolve this into user accessible helpers to add extra buttons on title bars, headers, etc.
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
float button_sz = g.FontSize * 0.5f;
|
|
ImGuiItemHoveredDataBackup last_item_backup;
|
|
last_item_backup.Backup();
|
|
if (CloseButton(window->GetID((void*)(intptr_t)(id+1)), ImVec2(ImMin(window->DC.LastItemRect.Max.x, window->ClipRect.Max.x) - g.Style.FramePadding.x - button_sz, window->DC.LastItemRect.Min.y + g.Style.FramePadding.y + button_sz), button_sz))
|
|
*p_open = false;
|
|
last_item_backup.Restore();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return is_open;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::TreeNodeEx(const char* label, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
return TreeNodeBehavior(window->GetID(label), flags, label, NULL);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::TreeNodeExV(const char* str_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* fmt, va_list args)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const char* label_end = g.TempBuffer + ImFormatStringV(g.TempBuffer, IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.TempBuffer), fmt, args);
|
|
return TreeNodeBehavior(window->GetID(str_id), flags, g.TempBuffer, label_end);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::TreeNodeExV(const void* ptr_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* fmt, va_list args)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const char* label_end = g.TempBuffer + ImFormatStringV(g.TempBuffer, IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.TempBuffer), fmt, args);
|
|
return TreeNodeBehavior(window->GetID(ptr_id), flags, g.TempBuffer, label_end);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::TreeNodeV(const char* str_id, const char* fmt, va_list args)
|
|
{
|
|
return TreeNodeExV(str_id, 0, fmt, args);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::TreeNodeV(const void* ptr_id, const char* fmt, va_list args)
|
|
{
|
|
return TreeNodeExV(ptr_id, 0, fmt, args);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::TreeNodeEx(const char* str_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* fmt, ...)
|
|
{
|
|
va_list args;
|
|
va_start(args, fmt);
|
|
bool is_open = TreeNodeExV(str_id, flags, fmt, args);
|
|
va_end(args);
|
|
return is_open;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::TreeNodeEx(const void* ptr_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* fmt, ...)
|
|
{
|
|
va_list args;
|
|
va_start(args, fmt);
|
|
bool is_open = TreeNodeExV(ptr_id, flags, fmt, args);
|
|
va_end(args);
|
|
return is_open;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::TreeNode(const char* str_id, const char* fmt, ...)
|
|
{
|
|
va_list args;
|
|
va_start(args, fmt);
|
|
bool is_open = TreeNodeExV(str_id, 0, fmt, args);
|
|
va_end(args);
|
|
return is_open;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::TreeNode(const void* ptr_id, const char* fmt, ...)
|
|
{
|
|
va_list args;
|
|
va_start(args, fmt);
|
|
bool is_open = TreeNodeExV(ptr_id, 0, fmt, args);
|
|
va_end(args);
|
|
return is_open;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::TreeNode(const char* label)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
return TreeNodeBehavior(window->GetID(label), 0, label, NULL);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::TreeAdvanceToLabelPos()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
g.CurrentWindow->DC.CursorPos.x += GetTreeNodeToLabelSpacing();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Horizontal distance preceding label when using TreeNode() or Bullet()
|
|
float ImGui::GetTreeNodeToLabelSpacing()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
return g.FontSize + (g.Style.FramePadding.x * 2.0f);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetNextTreeNodeOpen(bool is_open, ImGuiCond cond)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (g.CurrentWindow->SkipItems)
|
|
return;
|
|
g.SetNextTreeNodeOpenVal = is_open;
|
|
g.SetNextTreeNodeOpenCond = cond ? cond : ImGuiCond_Always;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PushID(const char* str_id)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
window->IDStack.push_back(window->GetID(str_id));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PushID(const char* str_id_begin, const char* str_id_end)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
window->IDStack.push_back(window->GetID(str_id_begin, str_id_end));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PushID(const void* ptr_id)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
window->IDStack.push_back(window->GetID(ptr_id));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PushID(int int_id)
|
|
{
|
|
const void* ptr_id = (void*)(intptr_t)int_id;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
window->IDStack.push_back(window->GetID(ptr_id));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PopID()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
window->IDStack.pop_back();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImGuiID ImGui::GetID(const char* str_id)
|
|
{
|
|
return GImGui->CurrentWindow->GetID(str_id);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImGuiID ImGui::GetID(const char* str_id_begin, const char* str_id_end)
|
|
{
|
|
return GImGui->CurrentWindow->GetID(str_id_begin, str_id_end);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImGuiID ImGui::GetID(const void* ptr_id)
|
|
{
|
|
return GImGui->CurrentWindow->GetID(ptr_id);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::Bullet()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
const float line_height = ImMax(ImMin(window->DC.CurrentLineHeight, g.FontSize + g.Style.FramePadding.y*2), g.FontSize);
|
|
const ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(g.FontSize, line_height));
|
|
ItemSize(bb);
|
|
if (!ItemAdd(bb, 0))
|
|
{
|
|
SameLine(0, style.FramePadding.x*2);
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Render and stay on same line
|
|
RenderBullet(bb.Min + ImVec2(style.FramePadding.x + g.FontSize*0.5f, line_height*0.5f));
|
|
SameLine(0, style.FramePadding.x*2);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Text with a little bullet aligned to the typical tree node.
|
|
void ImGui::BulletTextV(const char* fmt, va_list args)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
|
|
const char* text_begin = g.TempBuffer;
|
|
const char* text_end = text_begin + ImFormatStringV(g.TempBuffer, IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.TempBuffer), fmt, args);
|
|
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(text_begin, text_end, false);
|
|
const float text_base_offset_y = ImMax(0.0f, window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset); // Latch before ItemSize changes it
|
|
const float line_height = ImMax(ImMin(window->DC.CurrentLineHeight, g.FontSize + g.Style.FramePadding.y*2), g.FontSize);
|
|
const ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(g.FontSize + (label_size.x > 0.0f ? (label_size.x + style.FramePadding.x*2) : 0.0f), ImMax(line_height, label_size.y))); // Empty text doesn't add padding
|
|
ItemSize(bb);
|
|
if (!ItemAdd(bb, 0))
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
// Render
|
|
RenderBullet(bb.Min + ImVec2(style.FramePadding.x + g.FontSize*0.5f, line_height*0.5f));
|
|
RenderText(bb.Min+ImVec2(g.FontSize + style.FramePadding.x*2, text_base_offset_y), text_begin, text_end, false);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::BulletText(const char* fmt, ...)
|
|
{
|
|
va_list args;
|
|
va_start(args, fmt);
|
|
BulletTextV(fmt, args);
|
|
va_end(args);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static inline void DataTypeFormatString(ImGuiDataType data_type, void* data_ptr, const char* display_format, char* buf, int buf_size)
|
|
{
|
|
if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Int)
|
|
ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, display_format, *(int*)data_ptr);
|
|
else if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Float)
|
|
ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, display_format, *(float*)data_ptr);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static inline void DataTypeFormatString(ImGuiDataType data_type, void* data_ptr, int decimal_precision, char* buf, int buf_size)
|
|
{
|
|
if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Int)
|
|
{
|
|
if (decimal_precision < 0)
|
|
ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, "%d", *(int*)data_ptr);
|
|
else
|
|
ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, "%.*d", decimal_precision, *(int*)data_ptr);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Float)
|
|
{
|
|
if (decimal_precision < 0)
|
|
ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, "%f", *(float*)data_ptr); // Ideally we'd have a minimum decimal precision of 1 to visually denote that it is a float, while hiding non-significant digits?
|
|
else
|
|
ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, "%.*f", decimal_precision, *(float*)data_ptr);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void DataTypeApplyOp(ImGuiDataType data_type, int op, void* value1, const void* value2)// Store into value1
|
|
{
|
|
if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Int)
|
|
{
|
|
if (op == '+')
|
|
*(int*)value1 = *(int*)value1 + *(const int*)value2;
|
|
else if (op == '-')
|
|
*(int*)value1 = *(int*)value1 - *(const int*)value2;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Float)
|
|
{
|
|
if (op == '+')
|
|
*(float*)value1 = *(float*)value1 + *(const float*)value2;
|
|
else if (op == '-')
|
|
*(float*)value1 = *(float*)value1 - *(const float*)value2;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// User can input math operators (e.g. +100) to edit a numerical values.
|
|
static bool DataTypeApplyOpFromText(const char* buf, const char* initial_value_buf, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* data_ptr, const char* scalar_format)
|
|
{
|
|
while (ImCharIsSpace(*buf))
|
|
buf++;
|
|
|
|
// We don't support '-' op because it would conflict with inputing negative value.
|
|
// Instead you can use +-100 to subtract from an existing value
|
|
char op = buf[0];
|
|
if (op == '+' || op == '*' || op == '/')
|
|
{
|
|
buf++;
|
|
while (ImCharIsSpace(*buf))
|
|
buf++;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
op = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
if (!buf[0])
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Int)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!scalar_format)
|
|
scalar_format = "%d";
|
|
int* v = (int*)data_ptr;
|
|
const int old_v = *v;
|
|
int arg0i = *v;
|
|
if (op && sscanf(initial_value_buf, scalar_format, &arg0i) < 1)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
// Store operand in a float so we can use fractional value for multipliers (*1.1), but constant always parsed as integer so we can fit big integers (e.g. 2000000003) past float precision
|
|
float arg1f = 0.0f;
|
|
if (op == '+') { if (sscanf(buf, "%f", &arg1f) == 1) *v = (int)(arg0i + arg1f); } // Add (use "+-" to subtract)
|
|
else if (op == '*') { if (sscanf(buf, "%f", &arg1f) == 1) *v = (int)(arg0i * arg1f); } // Multiply
|
|
else if (op == '/') { if (sscanf(buf, "%f", &arg1f) == 1 && arg1f != 0.0f) *v = (int)(arg0i / arg1f); }// Divide
|
|
else { if (sscanf(buf, scalar_format, &arg0i) == 1) *v = arg0i; } // Assign constant (read as integer so big values are not lossy)
|
|
return (old_v != *v);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Float)
|
|
{
|
|
// For floats we have to ignore format with precision (e.g. "%.2f") because sscanf doesn't take them in
|
|
scalar_format = "%f";
|
|
float* v = (float*)data_ptr;
|
|
const float old_v = *v;
|
|
float arg0f = *v;
|
|
if (op && sscanf(initial_value_buf, scalar_format, &arg0f) < 1)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
float arg1f = 0.0f;
|
|
if (sscanf(buf, scalar_format, &arg1f) < 1)
|
|
return false;
|
|
if (op == '+') { *v = arg0f + arg1f; } // Add (use "+-" to subtract)
|
|
else if (op == '*') { *v = arg0f * arg1f; } // Multiply
|
|
else if (op == '/') { if (arg1f != 0.0f) *v = arg0f / arg1f; } // Divide
|
|
else { *v = arg1f; } // Assign constant
|
|
return (old_v != *v);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Create text input in place of a slider (when CTRL+Clicking on slider)
|
|
// FIXME: Logic is messy and confusing.
|
|
bool ImGui::InputScalarAsWidgetReplacement(const ImRect& aabb, const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* data_ptr, ImGuiID id, int decimal_precision)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
|
|
// Our replacement widget will override the focus ID (registered previously to allow for a TAB focus to happen)
|
|
// On the first frame, g.ScalarAsInputTextId == 0, then on subsequent frames it becomes == id
|
|
SetActiveID(g.ScalarAsInputTextId, window);
|
|
SetHoveredID(0);
|
|
FocusableItemUnregister(window);
|
|
|
|
char buf[32];
|
|
DataTypeFormatString(data_type, data_ptr, decimal_precision, buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf));
|
|
bool text_value_changed = InputTextEx(label, buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), aabb.GetSize(), ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsDecimal | ImGuiInputTextFlags_AutoSelectAll);
|
|
if (g.ScalarAsInputTextId == 0) // First frame we started displaying the InputText widget
|
|
{
|
|
IM_ASSERT(g.ActiveId == id); // InputText ID expected to match the Slider ID (else we'd need to store them both, which is also possible)
|
|
g.ScalarAsInputTextId = g.ActiveId;
|
|
SetHoveredID(id);
|
|
}
|
|
if (text_value_changed)
|
|
return DataTypeApplyOpFromText(buf, GImGui->InputTextState.InitialText.begin(), data_type, data_ptr, NULL);
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Parse display precision back from the display format string
|
|
int ImGui::ParseFormatPrecision(const char* fmt, int default_precision)
|
|
{
|
|
int precision = default_precision;
|
|
while ((fmt = strchr(fmt, '%')) != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
fmt++;
|
|
if (fmt[0] == '%') { fmt++; continue; } // Ignore "%%"
|
|
while (*fmt >= '0' && *fmt <= '9')
|
|
fmt++;
|
|
if (*fmt == '.')
|
|
{
|
|
fmt = ImAtoi(fmt + 1, &precision);
|
|
if (precision < 0 || precision > 10)
|
|
precision = default_precision;
|
|
}
|
|
if (*fmt == 'e' || *fmt == 'E') // Maximum precision with scientific notation
|
|
precision = -1;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
return precision;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static float GetMinimumStepAtDecimalPrecision(int decimal_precision)
|
|
{
|
|
static const float min_steps[10] = { 1.0f, 0.1f, 0.01f, 0.001f, 0.0001f, 0.00001f, 0.000001f, 0.0000001f, 0.00000001f, 0.000000001f };
|
|
return (decimal_precision >= 0 && decimal_precision < 10) ? min_steps[decimal_precision] : powf(10.0f, (float)-decimal_precision);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
float ImGui::RoundScalar(float value, int decimal_precision)
|
|
{
|
|
// Round past decimal precision
|
|
// So when our value is 1.99999 with a precision of 0.001 we'll end up rounding to 2.0
|
|
// FIXME: Investigate better rounding methods
|
|
if (decimal_precision < 0)
|
|
return value;
|
|
const float min_step = GetMinimumStepAtDecimalPrecision(decimal_precision);
|
|
bool negative = value < 0.0f;
|
|
value = fabsf(value);
|
|
float remainder = fmodf(value, min_step);
|
|
if (remainder <= min_step*0.5f)
|
|
value -= remainder;
|
|
else
|
|
value += (min_step - remainder);
|
|
return negative ? -value : value;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static inline float SliderBehaviorCalcRatioFromValue(float v, float v_min, float v_max, float power, float linear_zero_pos)
|
|
{
|
|
if (v_min == v_max)
|
|
return 0.0f;
|
|
|
|
const bool is_non_linear = (power < 1.0f-0.00001f) || (power > 1.0f+0.00001f);
|
|
const float v_clamped = (v_min < v_max) ? ImClamp(v, v_min, v_max) : ImClamp(v, v_max, v_min);
|
|
if (is_non_linear)
|
|
{
|
|
if (v_clamped < 0.0f)
|
|
{
|
|
const float f = 1.0f - (v_clamped - v_min) / (ImMin(0.0f,v_max) - v_min);
|
|
return (1.0f - powf(f, 1.0f/power)) * linear_zero_pos;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
const float f = (v_clamped - ImMax(0.0f,v_min)) / (v_max - ImMax(0.0f,v_min));
|
|
return linear_zero_pos + powf(f, 1.0f/power) * (1.0f - linear_zero_pos);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Linear slider
|
|
return (v_clamped - v_min) / (v_max - v_min);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::SliderBehavior(const ImRect& frame_bb, ImGuiID id, float* v, float v_min, float v_max, float power, int decimal_precision, ImGuiSliderFlags flags)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
|
|
// Draw frame
|
|
RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_FrameBg), true, style.FrameRounding);
|
|
|
|
const bool is_non_linear = (power < 1.0f-0.00001f) || (power > 1.0f+0.00001f);
|
|
const bool is_horizontal = (flags & ImGuiSliderFlags_Vertical) == 0;
|
|
|
|
const float grab_padding = 2.0f;
|
|
const float slider_sz = is_horizontal ? (frame_bb.GetWidth() - grab_padding * 2.0f) : (frame_bb.GetHeight() - grab_padding * 2.0f);
|
|
float grab_sz;
|
|
if (decimal_precision != 0)
|
|
grab_sz = ImMin(style.GrabMinSize, slider_sz);
|
|
else
|
|
grab_sz = ImMin(ImMax(1.0f * (slider_sz / ((v_min < v_max ? v_max - v_min : v_min - v_max) + 1.0f)), style.GrabMinSize), slider_sz); // Integer sliders, if possible have the grab size represent 1 unit
|
|
const float slider_usable_sz = slider_sz - grab_sz;
|
|
const float slider_usable_pos_min = (is_horizontal ? frame_bb.Min.x : frame_bb.Min.y) + grab_padding + grab_sz*0.5f;
|
|
const float slider_usable_pos_max = (is_horizontal ? frame_bb.Max.x : frame_bb.Max.y) - grab_padding - grab_sz*0.5f;
|
|
|
|
// For logarithmic sliders that cross over sign boundary we want the exponential increase to be symmetric around 0.0f
|
|
float linear_zero_pos = 0.0f; // 0.0->1.0f
|
|
if (v_min * v_max < 0.0f)
|
|
{
|
|
// Different sign
|
|
const float linear_dist_min_to_0 = powf(fabsf(0.0f - v_min), 1.0f/power);
|
|
const float linear_dist_max_to_0 = powf(fabsf(v_max - 0.0f), 1.0f/power);
|
|
linear_zero_pos = linear_dist_min_to_0 / (linear_dist_min_to_0+linear_dist_max_to_0);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// Same sign
|
|
linear_zero_pos = v_min < 0.0f ? 1.0f : 0.0f;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Process clicking on the slider
|
|
bool value_changed = false;
|
|
if (g.ActiveId == id)
|
|
{
|
|
bool set_new_value = false;
|
|
float clicked_t = 0.0f;
|
|
if (g.IO.MouseDown[0])
|
|
{
|
|
const float mouse_abs_pos = is_horizontal ? g.IO.MousePos.x : g.IO.MousePos.y;
|
|
clicked_t = (slider_usable_sz > 0.0f) ? ImClamp((mouse_abs_pos - slider_usable_pos_min) / slider_usable_sz, 0.0f, 1.0f) : 0.0f;
|
|
if (!is_horizontal)
|
|
clicked_t = 1.0f - clicked_t;
|
|
set_new_value = true;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
ClearActiveID();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (set_new_value)
|
|
{
|
|
float new_value;
|
|
if (is_non_linear)
|
|
{
|
|
// Account for logarithmic scale on both sides of the zero
|
|
if (clicked_t < linear_zero_pos)
|
|
{
|
|
// Negative: rescale to the negative range before powering
|
|
float a = 1.0f - (clicked_t / linear_zero_pos);
|
|
a = powf(a, power);
|
|
new_value = ImLerp(ImMin(v_max,0.0f), v_min, a);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// Positive: rescale to the positive range before powering
|
|
float a;
|
|
if (fabsf(linear_zero_pos - 1.0f) > 1.e-6f)
|
|
a = (clicked_t - linear_zero_pos) / (1.0f - linear_zero_pos);
|
|
else
|
|
a = clicked_t;
|
|
a = powf(a, power);
|
|
new_value = ImLerp(ImMax(v_min,0.0f), v_max, a);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// Linear slider
|
|
new_value = ImLerp(v_min, v_max, clicked_t);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Round past decimal precision
|
|
new_value = RoundScalar(new_value, decimal_precision);
|
|
if (*v != new_value)
|
|
{
|
|
*v = new_value;
|
|
value_changed = true;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Draw
|
|
float grab_t = SliderBehaviorCalcRatioFromValue(*v, v_min, v_max, power, linear_zero_pos);
|
|
if (!is_horizontal)
|
|
grab_t = 1.0f - grab_t;
|
|
const float grab_pos = ImLerp(slider_usable_pos_min, slider_usable_pos_max, grab_t);
|
|
ImRect grab_bb;
|
|
if (is_horizontal)
|
|
grab_bb = ImRect(ImVec2(grab_pos - grab_sz*0.5f, frame_bb.Min.y + grab_padding), ImVec2(grab_pos + grab_sz*0.5f, frame_bb.Max.y - grab_padding));
|
|
else
|
|
grab_bb = ImRect(ImVec2(frame_bb.Min.x + grab_padding, grab_pos - grab_sz*0.5f), ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x - grab_padding, grab_pos + grab_sz*0.5f));
|
|
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(grab_bb.Min, grab_bb.Max, GetColorU32(g.ActiveId == id ? ImGuiCol_SliderGrabActive : ImGuiCol_SliderGrab), style.GrabRounding);
|
|
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Use power!=1.0 for logarithmic sliders.
|
|
// Adjust display_format to decorate the value with a prefix or a suffix.
|
|
// "%.3f" 1.234
|
|
// "%5.2f secs" 01.23 secs
|
|
// "Gold: %.0f" Gold: 1
|
|
bool ImGui::SliderFloat(const char* label, float* v, float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, float power)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label);
|
|
const float w = CalcItemWidth();
|
|
|
|
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
|
|
const ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(w, label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y*2.0f));
|
|
const ImRect total_bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max + ImVec2(label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f, 0.0f));
|
|
|
|
// NB- we don't call ItemSize() yet because we may turn into a text edit box below
|
|
if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, id))
|
|
{
|
|
ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y);
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
const bool hovered = ItemHoverable(frame_bb, id);
|
|
|
|
if (!display_format)
|
|
display_format = "%.3f";
|
|
int decimal_precision = ParseFormatPrecision(display_format, 3);
|
|
|
|
// Tabbing or CTRL-clicking on Slider turns it into an input box
|
|
bool start_text_input = false;
|
|
const bool tab_focus_requested = FocusableItemRegister(window, id);
|
|
if (tab_focus_requested || (hovered && g.IO.MouseClicked[0]))
|
|
{
|
|
SetActiveID(id, window);
|
|
FocusWindow(window);
|
|
if (tab_focus_requested || g.IO.KeyCtrl)
|
|
{
|
|
start_text_input = true;
|
|
g.ScalarAsInputTextId = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if (start_text_input || (g.ActiveId == id && g.ScalarAsInputTextId == id))
|
|
return InputScalarAsWidgetReplacement(frame_bb, label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, id, decimal_precision);
|
|
|
|
// Actual slider behavior + render grab
|
|
ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y);
|
|
const bool value_changed = SliderBehavior(frame_bb, id, v, v_min, v_max, power, decimal_precision);
|
|
|
|
// Display value using user-provided display format so user can add prefix/suffix/decorations to the value.
|
|
char value_buf[64];
|
|
const char* value_buf_end = value_buf + ImFormatString(value_buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(value_buf), display_format, *v);
|
|
RenderTextClipped(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, value_buf, value_buf_end, NULL, ImVec2(0.5f,0.5f));
|
|
|
|
if (label_size.x > 0.0f)
|
|
RenderText(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label);
|
|
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::VSliderFloat(const char* label, const ImVec2& size, float* v, float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, float power)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label);
|
|
|
|
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
|
|
const ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size);
|
|
const ImRect bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max + ImVec2(label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f, 0.0f));
|
|
|
|
ItemSize(bb, style.FramePadding.y);
|
|
if (!ItemAdd(frame_bb, id))
|
|
return false;
|
|
const bool hovered = ItemHoverable(frame_bb, id);
|
|
|
|
if (!display_format)
|
|
display_format = "%.3f";
|
|
int decimal_precision = ParseFormatPrecision(display_format, 3);
|
|
|
|
if (hovered && g.IO.MouseClicked[0])
|
|
{
|
|
SetActiveID(id, window);
|
|
FocusWindow(window);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Actual slider behavior + render grab
|
|
bool value_changed = SliderBehavior(frame_bb, id, v, v_min, v_max, power, decimal_precision, ImGuiSliderFlags_Vertical);
|
|
|
|
// Display value using user-provided display format so user can add prefix/suffix/decorations to the value.
|
|
// For the vertical slider we allow centered text to overlap the frame padding
|
|
char value_buf[64];
|
|
char* value_buf_end = value_buf + ImFormatString(value_buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(value_buf), display_format, *v);
|
|
RenderTextClipped(ImVec2(frame_bb.Min.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), frame_bb.Max, value_buf, value_buf_end, NULL, ImVec2(0.5f,0.0f));
|
|
if (label_size.x > 0.0f)
|
|
RenderText(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label);
|
|
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::SliderAngle(const char* label, float* v_rad, float v_degrees_min, float v_degrees_max)
|
|
{
|
|
float v_deg = (*v_rad) * 360.0f / (2*IM_PI);
|
|
bool value_changed = SliderFloat(label, &v_deg, v_degrees_min, v_degrees_max, "%.0f deg", 1.0f);
|
|
*v_rad = v_deg * (2*IM_PI) / 360.0f;
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::SliderInt(const char* label, int* v, int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!display_format)
|
|
display_format = "%.0f";
|
|
float v_f = (float)*v;
|
|
bool value_changed = SliderFloat(label, &v_f, (float)v_min, (float)v_max, display_format, 1.0f);
|
|
*v = (int)v_f;
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::VSliderInt(const char* label, const ImVec2& size, int* v, int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!display_format)
|
|
display_format = "%.0f";
|
|
float v_f = (float)*v;
|
|
bool value_changed = VSliderFloat(label, size, &v_f, (float)v_min, (float)v_max, display_format, 1.0f);
|
|
*v = (int)v_f;
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Add multiple sliders on 1 line for compact edition of multiple components
|
|
bool ImGui::SliderFloatN(const char* label, float* v, int components, float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, float power)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
bool value_changed = false;
|
|
BeginGroup();
|
|
PushID(label);
|
|
PushMultiItemsWidths(components);
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < components; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
PushID(i);
|
|
value_changed |= SliderFloat("##v", &v[i], v_min, v_max, display_format, power);
|
|
SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
|
|
PopID();
|
|
PopItemWidth();
|
|
}
|
|
PopID();
|
|
|
|
TextUnformatted(label, FindRenderedTextEnd(label));
|
|
EndGroup();
|
|
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::SliderFloat2(const char* label, float v[2], float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, float power)
|
|
{
|
|
return SliderFloatN(label, v, 2, v_min, v_max, display_format, power);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::SliderFloat3(const char* label, float v[3], float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, float power)
|
|
{
|
|
return SliderFloatN(label, v, 3, v_min, v_max, display_format, power);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::SliderFloat4(const char* label, float v[4], float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, float power)
|
|
{
|
|
return SliderFloatN(label, v, 4, v_min, v_max, display_format, power);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::SliderIntN(const char* label, int* v, int components, int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
bool value_changed = false;
|
|
BeginGroup();
|
|
PushID(label);
|
|
PushMultiItemsWidths(components);
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < components; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
PushID(i);
|
|
value_changed |= SliderInt("##v", &v[i], v_min, v_max, display_format);
|
|
SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
|
|
PopID();
|
|
PopItemWidth();
|
|
}
|
|
PopID();
|
|
|
|
TextUnformatted(label, FindRenderedTextEnd(label));
|
|
EndGroup();
|
|
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::SliderInt2(const char* label, int v[2], int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format)
|
|
{
|
|
return SliderIntN(label, v, 2, v_min, v_max, display_format);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::SliderInt3(const char* label, int v[3], int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format)
|
|
{
|
|
return SliderIntN(label, v, 3, v_min, v_max, display_format);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::SliderInt4(const char* label, int v[4], int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format)
|
|
{
|
|
return SliderIntN(label, v, 4, v_min, v_max, display_format);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::DragBehavior(const ImRect& frame_bb, ImGuiID id, float* v, float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, int decimal_precision, float power)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
|
|
// Draw frame
|
|
const ImU32 frame_col = GetColorU32(g.ActiveId == id ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive : g.HoveredId == id ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered : ImGuiCol_FrameBg);
|
|
RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, frame_col, true, style.FrameRounding);
|
|
|
|
bool value_changed = false;
|
|
|
|
// Process clicking on the drag
|
|
if (g.ActiveId == id)
|
|
{
|
|
if (g.IO.MouseDown[0])
|
|
{
|
|
if (g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated)
|
|
{
|
|
// Lock current value on click
|
|
g.DragCurrentValue = *v;
|
|
g.DragLastMouseDelta = ImVec2(0.f, 0.f);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (v_speed == 0.0f && (v_max - v_min) != 0.0f && (v_max - v_min) < FLT_MAX)
|
|
v_speed = (v_max - v_min) * g.DragSpeedDefaultRatio;
|
|
|
|
float v_cur = g.DragCurrentValue;
|
|
const ImVec2 mouse_drag_delta = GetMouseDragDelta(0, 1.0f);
|
|
float adjust_delta = 0.0f;
|
|
//if (g.ActiveIdSource == ImGuiInputSource_Mouse)
|
|
{
|
|
adjust_delta = mouse_drag_delta.x - g.DragLastMouseDelta.x;
|
|
if (g.IO.KeyShift && g.DragSpeedScaleFast >= 0.0f)
|
|
adjust_delta *= g.DragSpeedScaleFast;
|
|
if (g.IO.KeyAlt && g.DragSpeedScaleSlow >= 0.0f)
|
|
adjust_delta *= g.DragSpeedScaleSlow;
|
|
}
|
|
adjust_delta *= v_speed;
|
|
g.DragLastMouseDelta.x = mouse_drag_delta.x;
|
|
|
|
if (fabsf(adjust_delta) > 0.0f)
|
|
{
|
|
if (fabsf(power - 1.0f) > 0.001f)
|
|
{
|
|
// Logarithmic curve on both side of 0.0
|
|
float v0_abs = v_cur >= 0.0f ? v_cur : -v_cur;
|
|
float v0_sign = v_cur >= 0.0f ? 1.0f : -1.0f;
|
|
float v1 = powf(v0_abs, 1.0f / power) + (adjust_delta * v0_sign);
|
|
float v1_abs = v1 >= 0.0f ? v1 : -v1;
|
|
float v1_sign = v1 >= 0.0f ? 1.0f : -1.0f; // Crossed sign line
|
|
v_cur = powf(v1_abs, power) * v0_sign * v1_sign; // Reapply sign
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
v_cur += adjust_delta;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Clamp
|
|
if (v_min < v_max)
|
|
v_cur = ImClamp(v_cur, v_min, v_max);
|
|
g.DragCurrentValue = v_cur;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Round to user desired precision, then apply
|
|
v_cur = RoundScalar(v_cur, decimal_precision);
|
|
if (*v != v_cur)
|
|
{
|
|
*v = v_cur;
|
|
value_changed = true;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
ClearActiveID();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::DragFloat(const char* label, float* v, float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, float power)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label);
|
|
const float w = CalcItemWidth();
|
|
|
|
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
|
|
const ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(w, label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y*2.0f));
|
|
const ImRect inner_bb(frame_bb.Min + style.FramePadding, frame_bb.Max - style.FramePadding);
|
|
const ImRect total_bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max + ImVec2(label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f, 0.0f));
|
|
|
|
// NB- we don't call ItemSize() yet because we may turn into a text edit box below
|
|
if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, id))
|
|
{
|
|
ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y);
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
const bool hovered = ItemHoverable(frame_bb, id);
|
|
|
|
if (!display_format)
|
|
display_format = "%.3f";
|
|
int decimal_precision = ParseFormatPrecision(display_format, 3);
|
|
|
|
// Tabbing or CTRL-clicking on Drag turns it into an input box
|
|
bool start_text_input = false;
|
|
const bool tab_focus_requested = FocusableItemRegister(window, id);
|
|
if (tab_focus_requested || (hovered && (g.IO.MouseClicked[0] || g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[0])))
|
|
{
|
|
SetActiveID(id, window);
|
|
FocusWindow(window);
|
|
if (tab_focus_requested || g.IO.KeyCtrl || g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[0])
|
|
{
|
|
start_text_input = true;
|
|
g.ScalarAsInputTextId = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if (start_text_input || (g.ActiveId == id && g.ScalarAsInputTextId == id))
|
|
return InputScalarAsWidgetReplacement(frame_bb, label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, id, decimal_precision);
|
|
|
|
// Actual drag behavior
|
|
ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y);
|
|
const bool value_changed = DragBehavior(frame_bb, id, v, v_speed, v_min, v_max, decimal_precision, power);
|
|
|
|
// Display value using user-provided display format so user can add prefix/suffix/decorations to the value.
|
|
char value_buf[64];
|
|
const char* value_buf_end = value_buf + ImFormatString(value_buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(value_buf), display_format, *v);
|
|
RenderTextClipped(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, value_buf, value_buf_end, NULL, ImVec2(0.5f,0.5f));
|
|
|
|
if (label_size.x > 0.0f)
|
|
RenderText(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, inner_bb.Min.y), label);
|
|
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::DragFloatN(const char* label, float* v, int components, float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, float power)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
bool value_changed = false;
|
|
BeginGroup();
|
|
PushID(label);
|
|
PushMultiItemsWidths(components);
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < components; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
PushID(i);
|
|
value_changed |= DragFloat("##v", &v[i], v_speed, v_min, v_max, display_format, power);
|
|
SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
|
|
PopID();
|
|
PopItemWidth();
|
|
}
|
|
PopID();
|
|
|
|
TextUnformatted(label, FindRenderedTextEnd(label));
|
|
EndGroup();
|
|
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::DragFloat2(const char* label, float v[2], float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, float power)
|
|
{
|
|
return DragFloatN(label, v, 2, v_speed, v_min, v_max, display_format, power);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::DragFloat3(const char* label, float v[3], float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, float power)
|
|
{
|
|
return DragFloatN(label, v, 3, v_speed, v_min, v_max, display_format, power);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::DragFloat4(const char* label, float v[4], float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, float power)
|
|
{
|
|
return DragFloatN(label, v, 4, v_speed, v_min, v_max, display_format, power);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::DragFloatRange2(const char* label, float* v_current_min, float* v_current_max, float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, const char* display_format_max, float power)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
PushID(label);
|
|
BeginGroup();
|
|
PushMultiItemsWidths(2);
|
|
|
|
bool value_changed = DragFloat("##min", v_current_min, v_speed, (v_min >= v_max) ? -FLT_MAX : v_min, (v_min >= v_max) ? *v_current_max : ImMin(v_max, *v_current_max), display_format, power);
|
|
PopItemWidth();
|
|
SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
|
|
value_changed |= DragFloat("##max", v_current_max, v_speed, (v_min >= v_max) ? *v_current_min : ImMax(v_min, *v_current_min), (v_min >= v_max) ? FLT_MAX : v_max, display_format_max ? display_format_max : display_format, power);
|
|
PopItemWidth();
|
|
SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
|
|
|
|
TextUnformatted(label, FindRenderedTextEnd(label));
|
|
EndGroup();
|
|
PopID();
|
|
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// NB: v_speed is float to allow adjusting the drag speed with more precision
|
|
bool ImGui::DragInt(const char* label, int* v, float v_speed, int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!display_format)
|
|
display_format = "%.0f";
|
|
float v_f = (float)*v;
|
|
bool value_changed = DragFloat(label, &v_f, v_speed, (float)v_min, (float)v_max, display_format);
|
|
*v = (int)v_f;
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::DragIntN(const char* label, int* v, int components, float v_speed, int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
bool value_changed = false;
|
|
BeginGroup();
|
|
PushID(label);
|
|
PushMultiItemsWidths(components);
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < components; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
PushID(i);
|
|
value_changed |= DragInt("##v", &v[i], v_speed, v_min, v_max, display_format);
|
|
SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
|
|
PopID();
|
|
PopItemWidth();
|
|
}
|
|
PopID();
|
|
|
|
TextUnformatted(label, FindRenderedTextEnd(label));
|
|
EndGroup();
|
|
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::DragInt2(const char* label, int v[2], float v_speed, int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format)
|
|
{
|
|
return DragIntN(label, v, 2, v_speed, v_min, v_max, display_format);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::DragInt3(const char* label, int v[3], float v_speed, int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format)
|
|
{
|
|
return DragIntN(label, v, 3, v_speed, v_min, v_max, display_format);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::DragInt4(const char* label, int v[4], float v_speed, int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format)
|
|
{
|
|
return DragIntN(label, v, 4, v_speed, v_min, v_max, display_format);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::DragIntRange2(const char* label, int* v_current_min, int* v_current_max, float v_speed, int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format, const char* display_format_max)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
PushID(label);
|
|
BeginGroup();
|
|
PushMultiItemsWidths(2);
|
|
|
|
bool value_changed = DragInt("##min", v_current_min, v_speed, (v_min >= v_max) ? INT_MIN : v_min, (v_min >= v_max) ? *v_current_max : ImMin(v_max, *v_current_max), display_format);
|
|
PopItemWidth();
|
|
SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
|
|
value_changed |= DragInt("##max", v_current_max, v_speed, (v_min >= v_max) ? *v_current_min : ImMax(v_min, *v_current_min), (v_min >= v_max) ? INT_MAX : v_max, display_format_max ? display_format_max : display_format);
|
|
PopItemWidth();
|
|
SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
|
|
|
|
TextUnformatted(label, FindRenderedTextEnd(label));
|
|
EndGroup();
|
|
PopID();
|
|
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PlotEx(ImGuiPlotType plot_type, const char* label, float (*values_getter)(void* data, int idx), void* data, int values_count, int values_offset, const char* overlay_text, float scale_min, float scale_max, ImVec2 graph_size)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
|
|
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
|
|
if (graph_size.x == 0.0f)
|
|
graph_size.x = CalcItemWidth();
|
|
if (graph_size.y == 0.0f)
|
|
graph_size.y = label_size.y + (style.FramePadding.y * 2);
|
|
|
|
const ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(graph_size.x, graph_size.y));
|
|
const ImRect inner_bb(frame_bb.Min + style.FramePadding, frame_bb.Max - style.FramePadding);
|
|
const ImRect total_bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max + ImVec2(label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f, 0));
|
|
ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y);
|
|
if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, 0))
|
|
return;
|
|
const bool hovered = ItemHoverable(inner_bb, 0);
|
|
|
|
// Determine scale from values if not specified
|
|
if (scale_min == FLT_MAX || scale_max == FLT_MAX)
|
|
{
|
|
float v_min = FLT_MAX;
|
|
float v_max = -FLT_MAX;
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < values_count; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
const float v = values_getter(data, i);
|
|
v_min = ImMin(v_min, v);
|
|
v_max = ImMax(v_max, v);
|
|
}
|
|
if (scale_min == FLT_MAX)
|
|
scale_min = v_min;
|
|
if (scale_max == FLT_MAX)
|
|
scale_max = v_max;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_FrameBg), true, style.FrameRounding);
|
|
|
|
if (values_count > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
int res_w = ImMin((int)graph_size.x, values_count) + ((plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines) ? -1 : 0);
|
|
int item_count = values_count + ((plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines) ? -1 : 0);
|
|
|
|
// Tooltip on hover
|
|
int v_hovered = -1;
|
|
if (hovered)
|
|
{
|
|
const float t = ImClamp((g.IO.MousePos.x - inner_bb.Min.x) / (inner_bb.Max.x - inner_bb.Min.x), 0.0f, 0.9999f);
|
|
const int v_idx = (int)(t * item_count);
|
|
IM_ASSERT(v_idx >= 0 && v_idx < values_count);
|
|
|
|
const float v0 = values_getter(data, (v_idx + values_offset) % values_count);
|
|
const float v1 = values_getter(data, (v_idx + 1 + values_offset) % values_count);
|
|
if (plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines)
|
|
SetTooltip("%d: %8.4g\n%d: %8.4g", v_idx, v0, v_idx+1, v1);
|
|
else if (plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Histogram)
|
|
SetTooltip("%d: %8.4g", v_idx, v0);
|
|
v_hovered = v_idx;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const float t_step = 1.0f / (float)res_w;
|
|
|
|
float v0 = values_getter(data, (0 + values_offset) % values_count);
|
|
float t0 = 0.0f;
|
|
ImVec2 tp0 = ImVec2( t0, 1.0f - ImSaturate((v0 - scale_min) / (scale_max - scale_min)) ); // Point in the normalized space of our target rectangle
|
|
float histogram_zero_line_t = (scale_min * scale_max < 0.0f) ? (-scale_min / (scale_max - scale_min)) : (scale_min < 0.0f ? 0.0f : 1.0f); // Where does the zero line stands
|
|
|
|
const ImU32 col_base = GetColorU32((plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines) ? ImGuiCol_PlotLines : ImGuiCol_PlotHistogram);
|
|
const ImU32 col_hovered = GetColorU32((plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines) ? ImGuiCol_PlotLinesHovered : ImGuiCol_PlotHistogramHovered);
|
|
|
|
for (int n = 0; n < res_w; n++)
|
|
{
|
|
const float t1 = t0 + t_step;
|
|
const int v1_idx = (int)(t0 * item_count + 0.5f);
|
|
IM_ASSERT(v1_idx >= 0 && v1_idx < values_count);
|
|
const float v1 = values_getter(data, (v1_idx + values_offset + 1) % values_count);
|
|
const ImVec2 tp1 = ImVec2( t1, 1.0f - ImSaturate((v1 - scale_min) / (scale_max - scale_min)) );
|
|
|
|
// NB: Draw calls are merged together by the DrawList system. Still, we should render our batch are lower level to save a bit of CPU.
|
|
ImVec2 pos0 = ImLerp(inner_bb.Min, inner_bb.Max, tp0);
|
|
ImVec2 pos1 = ImLerp(inner_bb.Min, inner_bb.Max, (plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines) ? tp1 : ImVec2(tp1.x, histogram_zero_line_t));
|
|
if (plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines)
|
|
{
|
|
window->DrawList->AddLine(pos0, pos1, v_hovered == v1_idx ? col_hovered : col_base);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Histogram)
|
|
{
|
|
if (pos1.x >= pos0.x + 2.0f)
|
|
pos1.x -= 1.0f;
|
|
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(pos0, pos1, v_hovered == v1_idx ? col_hovered : col_base);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
t0 = t1;
|
|
tp0 = tp1;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Text overlay
|
|
if (overlay_text)
|
|
RenderTextClipped(ImVec2(frame_bb.Min.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), frame_bb.Max, overlay_text, NULL, NULL, ImVec2(0.5f,0.0f));
|
|
|
|
if (label_size.x > 0.0f)
|
|
RenderText(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, inner_bb.Min.y), label);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
struct ImGuiPlotArrayGetterData
|
|
{
|
|
const float* Values;
|
|
int Stride;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiPlotArrayGetterData(const float* values, int stride) { Values = values; Stride = stride; }
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
static float Plot_ArrayGetter(void* data, int idx)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiPlotArrayGetterData* plot_data = (ImGuiPlotArrayGetterData*)data;
|
|
const float v = *(float*)(void*)((unsigned char*)plot_data->Values + (size_t)idx * plot_data->Stride);
|
|
return v;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PlotLines(const char* label, const float* values, int values_count, int values_offset, const char* overlay_text, float scale_min, float scale_max, ImVec2 graph_size, int stride)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiPlotArrayGetterData data(values, stride);
|
|
PlotEx(ImGuiPlotType_Lines, label, &Plot_ArrayGetter, (void*)&data, values_count, values_offset, overlay_text, scale_min, scale_max, graph_size);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PlotLines(const char* label, float (*values_getter)(void* data, int idx), void* data, int values_count, int values_offset, const char* overlay_text, float scale_min, float scale_max, ImVec2 graph_size)
|
|
{
|
|
PlotEx(ImGuiPlotType_Lines, label, values_getter, data, values_count, values_offset, overlay_text, scale_min, scale_max, graph_size);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PlotHistogram(const char* label, const float* values, int values_count, int values_offset, const char* overlay_text, float scale_min, float scale_max, ImVec2 graph_size, int stride)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiPlotArrayGetterData data(values, stride);
|
|
PlotEx(ImGuiPlotType_Histogram, label, &Plot_ArrayGetter, (void*)&data, values_count, values_offset, overlay_text, scale_min, scale_max, graph_size);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PlotHistogram(const char* label, float (*values_getter)(void* data, int idx), void* data, int values_count, int values_offset, const char* overlay_text, float scale_min, float scale_max, ImVec2 graph_size)
|
|
{
|
|
PlotEx(ImGuiPlotType_Histogram, label, values_getter, data, values_count, values_offset, overlay_text, scale_min, scale_max, graph_size);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// size_arg (for each axis) < 0.0f: align to end, 0.0f: auto, > 0.0f: specified size
|
|
void ImGui::ProgressBar(float fraction, const ImVec2& size_arg, const char* overlay)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
|
|
ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos;
|
|
ImRect bb(pos, pos + CalcItemSize(size_arg, CalcItemWidth(), g.FontSize + style.FramePadding.y*2.0f));
|
|
ItemSize(bb, style.FramePadding.y);
|
|
if (!ItemAdd(bb, 0))
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
// Render
|
|
fraction = ImSaturate(fraction);
|
|
RenderFrame(bb.Min, bb.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_FrameBg), true, style.FrameRounding);
|
|
bb.Expand(ImVec2(-style.FrameBorderSize, -style.FrameBorderSize));
|
|
const ImVec2 fill_br = ImVec2(ImLerp(bb.Min.x, bb.Max.x, fraction), bb.Max.y);
|
|
RenderRectFilledRangeH(window->DrawList, bb, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_PlotHistogram), 0.0f, fraction, style.FrameRounding);
|
|
|
|
// Default displaying the fraction as percentage string, but user can override it
|
|
char overlay_buf[32];
|
|
if (!overlay)
|
|
{
|
|
ImFormatString(overlay_buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(overlay_buf), "%.0f%%", fraction*100+0.01f);
|
|
overlay = overlay_buf;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImVec2 overlay_size = CalcTextSize(overlay, NULL);
|
|
if (overlay_size.x > 0.0f)
|
|
RenderTextClipped(ImVec2(ImClamp(fill_br.x + style.ItemSpacing.x, bb.Min.x, bb.Max.x - overlay_size.x - style.ItemInnerSpacing.x), bb.Min.y), bb.Max, overlay, NULL, &overlay_size, ImVec2(0.0f,0.5f), &bb);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::Checkbox(const char* label, bool* v)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label);
|
|
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
|
|
|
|
const ImRect check_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y*2, label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y*2)); // We want a square shape to we use Y twice
|
|
ItemSize(check_bb, style.FramePadding.y);
|
|
|
|
ImRect total_bb = check_bb;
|
|
if (label_size.x > 0)
|
|
SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
|
|
const ImRect text_bb(window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(0,style.FramePadding.y), window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(0,style.FramePadding.y) + label_size);
|
|
if (label_size.x > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
ItemSize(ImVec2(text_bb.GetWidth(), check_bb.GetHeight()), style.FramePadding.y);
|
|
total_bb = ImRect(ImMin(check_bb.Min, text_bb.Min), ImMax(check_bb.Max, text_bb.Max));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, id))
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
bool hovered, held;
|
|
bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(total_bb, id, &hovered, &held);
|
|
if (pressed)
|
|
*v = !(*v);
|
|
|
|
RenderFrame(check_bb.Min, check_bb.Max, GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered : ImGuiCol_FrameBg), true, style.FrameRounding);
|
|
if (*v)
|
|
{
|
|
const float check_sz = ImMin(check_bb.GetWidth(), check_bb.GetHeight());
|
|
const float pad = ImMax(1.0f, (float)(int)(check_sz / 6.0f));
|
|
RenderCheckMark(check_bb.Min + ImVec2(pad,pad), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_CheckMark), check_bb.GetWidth() - pad*2.0f);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (g.LogEnabled)
|
|
LogRenderedText(&text_bb.Min, *v ? "[x]" : "[ ]");
|
|
if (label_size.x > 0.0f)
|
|
RenderText(text_bb.Min, label);
|
|
|
|
return pressed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::CheckboxFlags(const char* label, unsigned int* flags, unsigned int flags_value)
|
|
{
|
|
bool v = ((*flags & flags_value) == flags_value);
|
|
bool pressed = Checkbox(label, &v);
|
|
if (pressed)
|
|
{
|
|
if (v)
|
|
*flags |= flags_value;
|
|
else
|
|
*flags &= ~flags_value;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return pressed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::RadioButton(const char* label, bool active)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label);
|
|
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
|
|
|
|
const ImRect check_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y*2-1, label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y*2-1));
|
|
ItemSize(check_bb, style.FramePadding.y);
|
|
|
|
ImRect total_bb = check_bb;
|
|
if (label_size.x > 0)
|
|
SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
|
|
const ImRect text_bb(window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(0, style.FramePadding.y), window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(0, style.FramePadding.y) + label_size);
|
|
if (label_size.x > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
ItemSize(ImVec2(text_bb.GetWidth(), check_bb.GetHeight()), style.FramePadding.y);
|
|
total_bb.Add(text_bb);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, id))
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImVec2 center = check_bb.GetCenter();
|
|
center.x = (float)(int)center.x + 0.5f;
|
|
center.y = (float)(int)center.y + 0.5f;
|
|
const float radius = check_bb.GetHeight() * 0.5f;
|
|
|
|
bool hovered, held;
|
|
bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(total_bb, id, &hovered, &held);
|
|
|
|
window->DrawList->AddCircleFilled(center, radius, GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered : ImGuiCol_FrameBg), 16);
|
|
if (active)
|
|
{
|
|
const float check_sz = ImMin(check_bb.GetWidth(), check_bb.GetHeight());
|
|
const float pad = ImMax(1.0f, (float)(int)(check_sz / 6.0f));
|
|
window->DrawList->AddCircleFilled(center, radius-pad, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_CheckMark), 16);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (style.FrameBorderSize > 0.0f)
|
|
{
|
|
window->DrawList->AddCircle(center+ImVec2(1,1), radius, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_BorderShadow), 16, style.FrameBorderSize);
|
|
window->DrawList->AddCircle(center, radius, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Border), 16, style.FrameBorderSize);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (g.LogEnabled)
|
|
LogRenderedText(&text_bb.Min, active ? "(x)" : "( )");
|
|
if (label_size.x > 0.0f)
|
|
RenderText(text_bb.Min, label);
|
|
|
|
return pressed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::RadioButton(const char* label, int* v, int v_button)
|
|
{
|
|
const bool pressed = RadioButton(label, *v == v_button);
|
|
if (pressed)
|
|
{
|
|
*v = v_button;
|
|
}
|
|
return pressed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static int InputTextCalcTextLenAndLineCount(const char* text_begin, const char** out_text_end)
|
|
{
|
|
int line_count = 0;
|
|
const char* s = text_begin;
|
|
while (char c = *s++) // We are only matching for \n so we can ignore UTF-8 decoding
|
|
if (c == '\n')
|
|
line_count++;
|
|
s--;
|
|
if (s[0] != '\n' && s[0] != '\r')
|
|
line_count++;
|
|
*out_text_end = s;
|
|
return line_count;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static ImVec2 InputTextCalcTextSizeW(const ImWchar* text_begin, const ImWchar* text_end, const ImWchar** remaining, ImVec2* out_offset, bool stop_on_new_line)
|
|
{
|
|
ImFont* font = GImGui->Font;
|
|
const float line_height = GImGui->FontSize;
|
|
const float scale = line_height / font->FontSize;
|
|
|
|
ImVec2 text_size = ImVec2(0,0);
|
|
float line_width = 0.0f;
|
|
|
|
const ImWchar* s = text_begin;
|
|
while (s < text_end)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int c = (unsigned int)(*s++);
|
|
if (c == '\n')
|
|
{
|
|
text_size.x = ImMax(text_size.x, line_width);
|
|
text_size.y += line_height;
|
|
line_width = 0.0f;
|
|
if (stop_on_new_line)
|
|
break;
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
if (c == '\r')
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
const float char_width = font->GetCharAdvance((unsigned short)c) * scale;
|
|
line_width += char_width;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (text_size.x < line_width)
|
|
text_size.x = line_width;
|
|
|
|
if (out_offset)
|
|
*out_offset = ImVec2(line_width, text_size.y + line_height); // offset allow for the possibility of sitting after a trailing \n
|
|
|
|
if (line_width > 0 || text_size.y == 0.0f) // whereas size.y will ignore the trailing \n
|
|
text_size.y += line_height;
|
|
|
|
if (remaining)
|
|
*remaining = s;
|
|
|
|
return text_size;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Wrapper for stb_textedit.h to edit text (our wrapper is for: statically sized buffer, single-line, wchar characters. InputText converts between UTF-8 and wchar)
|
|
namespace ImGuiStb
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
static int STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(const STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj) { return obj->CurLenW; }
|
|
static ImWchar STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(const STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int idx) { return obj->Text[idx]; }
|
|
static float STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int line_start_idx, int char_idx) { ImWchar c = obj->Text[line_start_idx+char_idx]; if (c == '\n') return STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH_NEWLINE; return GImGui->Font->GetCharAdvance(c) * (GImGui->FontSize / GImGui->Font->FontSize); }
|
|
static int STB_TEXTEDIT_KEYTOTEXT(int key) { return key >= 0x10000 ? 0 : key; }
|
|
static ImWchar STB_TEXTEDIT_NEWLINE = '\n';
|
|
static void STB_TEXTEDIT_LAYOUTROW(StbTexteditRow* r, STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int line_start_idx)
|
|
{
|
|
const ImWchar* text = obj->Text.Data;
|
|
const ImWchar* text_remaining = NULL;
|
|
const ImVec2 size = InputTextCalcTextSizeW(text + line_start_idx, text + obj->CurLenW, &text_remaining, NULL, true);
|
|
r->x0 = 0.0f;
|
|
r->x1 = size.x;
|
|
r->baseline_y_delta = size.y;
|
|
r->ymin = 0.0f;
|
|
r->ymax = size.y;
|
|
r->num_chars = (int)(text_remaining - (text + line_start_idx));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static bool is_separator(unsigned int c) { return ImCharIsSpace(c) || c==',' || c==';' || c=='(' || c==')' || c=='{' || c=='}' || c=='[' || c==']' || c=='|'; }
|
|
static int is_word_boundary_from_right(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int idx) { return idx > 0 ? (is_separator( obj->Text[idx-1] ) && !is_separator( obj->Text[idx] ) ) : 1; }
|
|
static int STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDLEFT_IMPL(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int idx) { idx--; while (idx >= 0 && !is_word_boundary_from_right(obj, idx)) idx--; return idx < 0 ? 0 : idx; }
|
|
#ifdef __APPLE__ // FIXME: Move setting to IO structure
|
|
static int is_word_boundary_from_left(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int idx) { return idx > 0 ? (!is_separator( obj->Text[idx-1] ) && is_separator( obj->Text[idx] ) ) : 1; }
|
|
static int STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT_IMPL(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int idx) { idx++; int len = obj->CurLenW; while (idx < len && !is_word_boundary_from_left(obj, idx)) idx++; return idx > len ? len : idx; }
|
|
#else
|
|
static int STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT_IMPL(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int idx) { idx++; int len = obj->CurLenW; while (idx < len && !is_word_boundary_from_right(obj, idx)) idx++; return idx > len ? len : idx; }
|
|
#endif
|
|
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDLEFT STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDLEFT_IMPL // They need to be #define for stb_textedit.h
|
|
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT_IMPL
|
|
|
|
static void STB_TEXTEDIT_DELETECHARS(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int pos, int n)
|
|
{
|
|
ImWchar* dst = obj->Text.Data + pos;
|
|
|
|
// We maintain our buffer length in both UTF-8 and wchar formats
|
|
obj->CurLenA -= ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(dst, dst + n);
|
|
obj->CurLenW -= n;
|
|
|
|
// Offset remaining text
|
|
const ImWchar* src = obj->Text.Data + pos + n;
|
|
while (ImWchar c = *src++)
|
|
*dst++ = c;
|
|
*dst = '\0';
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static bool STB_TEXTEDIT_INSERTCHARS(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int pos, const ImWchar* new_text, int new_text_len)
|
|
{
|
|
const int text_len = obj->CurLenW;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(pos <= text_len);
|
|
if (new_text_len + text_len + 1 > obj->Text.Size)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
const int new_text_len_utf8 = ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(new_text, new_text + new_text_len);
|
|
if (new_text_len_utf8 + obj->CurLenA + 1 > obj->BufSizeA)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImWchar* text = obj->Text.Data;
|
|
if (pos != text_len)
|
|
memmove(text + pos + new_text_len, text + pos, (size_t)(text_len - pos) * sizeof(ImWchar));
|
|
memcpy(text + pos, new_text, (size_t)new_text_len * sizeof(ImWchar));
|
|
|
|
obj->CurLenW += new_text_len;
|
|
obj->CurLenA += new_text_len_utf8;
|
|
obj->Text[obj->CurLenW] = '\0';
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// We don't use an enum so we can build even with conflicting symbols (if another user of stb_textedit.h leak their STB_TEXTEDIT_K_* symbols)
|
|
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LEFT 0x10000 // keyboard input to move cursor left
|
|
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_RIGHT 0x10001 // keyboard input to move cursor right
|
|
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_UP 0x10002 // keyboard input to move cursor up
|
|
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DOWN 0x10003 // keyboard input to move cursor down
|
|
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART 0x10004 // keyboard input to move cursor to start of line
|
|
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND 0x10005 // keyboard input to move cursor to end of line
|
|
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART 0x10006 // keyboard input to move cursor to start of text
|
|
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND 0x10007 // keyboard input to move cursor to end of text
|
|
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DELETE 0x10008 // keyboard input to delete selection or character under cursor
|
|
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_BACKSPACE 0x10009 // keyboard input to delete selection or character left of cursor
|
|
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_UNDO 0x1000A // keyboard input to perform undo
|
|
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_REDO 0x1000B // keyboard input to perform redo
|
|
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDLEFT 0x1000C // keyboard input to move cursor left one word
|
|
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDRIGHT 0x1000D // keyboard input to move cursor right one word
|
|
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT 0x20000
|
|
|
|
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_IMPLEMENTATION
|
|
#include "stb_textedit.h"
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGuiTextEditState::OnKeyPressed(int key)
|
|
{
|
|
stb_textedit_key(this, &StbState, key);
|
|
CursorFollow = true;
|
|
CursorAnimReset();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Public API to manipulate UTF-8 text
|
|
// We expose UTF-8 to the user (unlike the STB_TEXTEDIT_* functions which are manipulating wchar)
|
|
// FIXME: The existence of this rarely exercised code path is a bit of a nuisance.
|
|
void ImGuiTextEditCallbackData::DeleteChars(int pos, int bytes_count)
|
|
{
|
|
IM_ASSERT(pos + bytes_count <= BufTextLen);
|
|
char* dst = Buf + pos;
|
|
const char* src = Buf + pos + bytes_count;
|
|
while (char c = *src++)
|
|
*dst++ = c;
|
|
*dst = '\0';
|
|
|
|
if (CursorPos + bytes_count >= pos)
|
|
CursorPos -= bytes_count;
|
|
else if (CursorPos >= pos)
|
|
CursorPos = pos;
|
|
SelectionStart = SelectionEnd = CursorPos;
|
|
BufDirty = true;
|
|
BufTextLen -= bytes_count;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGuiTextEditCallbackData::InsertChars(int pos, const char* new_text, const char* new_text_end)
|
|
{
|
|
const int new_text_len = new_text_end ? (int)(new_text_end - new_text) : (int)strlen(new_text);
|
|
if (new_text_len + BufTextLen + 1 >= BufSize)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
if (BufTextLen != pos)
|
|
memmove(Buf + pos + new_text_len, Buf + pos, (size_t)(BufTextLen - pos));
|
|
memcpy(Buf + pos, new_text, (size_t)new_text_len * sizeof(char));
|
|
Buf[BufTextLen + new_text_len] = '\0';
|
|
|
|
if (CursorPos >= pos)
|
|
CursorPos += new_text_len;
|
|
SelectionStart = SelectionEnd = CursorPos;
|
|
BufDirty = true;
|
|
BufTextLen += new_text_len;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Return false to discard a character.
|
|
static bool InputTextFilterCharacter(unsigned int* p_char, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags, ImGuiTextEditCallback callback, void* user_data)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int c = *p_char;
|
|
|
|
if (c < 128 && c != ' ' && !isprint((int)(c & 0xFF)))
|
|
{
|
|
bool pass = false;
|
|
pass |= (c == '\n' && (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_Multiline));
|
|
pass |= (c == '\t' && (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_AllowTabInput));
|
|
if (!pass)
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (c >= 0xE000 && c <= 0xF8FF) // Filter private Unicode range. I don't imagine anybody would want to input them. GLFW on OSX seems to send private characters for special keys like arrow keys.
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
if (flags & (ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsDecimal | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsUppercase | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsNoBlank))
|
|
{
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsDecimal)
|
|
if (!(c >= '0' && c <= '9') && (c != '.') && (c != '-') && (c != '+') && (c != '*') && (c != '/'))
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal)
|
|
if (!(c >= '0' && c <= '9') && !(c >= 'a' && c <= 'f') && !(c >= 'A' && c <= 'F'))
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsUppercase)
|
|
if (c >= 'a' && c <= 'z')
|
|
*p_char = (c += (unsigned int)('A'-'a'));
|
|
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsNoBlank)
|
|
if (ImCharIsSpace(c))
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCharFilter)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiTextEditCallbackData callback_data;
|
|
memset(&callback_data, 0, sizeof(ImGuiTextEditCallbackData));
|
|
callback_data.EventFlag = ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCharFilter;
|
|
callback_data.EventChar = (ImWchar)c;
|
|
callback_data.Flags = flags;
|
|
callback_data.UserData = user_data;
|
|
if (callback(&callback_data) != 0)
|
|
return false;
|
|
*p_char = callback_data.EventChar;
|
|
if (!callback_data.EventChar)
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Edit a string of text
|
|
// NB: when active, hold on a privately held copy of the text (and apply back to 'buf'). So changing 'buf' while active has no effect.
|
|
// FIXME: Rather messy function partly because we are doing UTF8 > u16 > UTF8 conversions on the go to more easily handle stb_textedit calls. Ideally we should stay in UTF-8 all the time. See https://github.com/nothings/stb/issues/188
|
|
bool ImGui::InputTextEx(const char* label, char* buf, int buf_size, const ImVec2& size_arg, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags, ImGuiTextEditCallback callback, void* user_data)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
IM_ASSERT(!((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory) && (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_Multiline))); // Can't use both together (they both use up/down keys)
|
|
IM_ASSERT(!((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion) && (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_AllowTabInput))); // Can't use both together (they both use tab key)
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const ImGuiIO& io = g.IO;
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
|
|
const bool is_multiline = (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_Multiline) != 0;
|
|
const bool is_editable = (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_ReadOnly) == 0;
|
|
const bool is_password = (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_Password) != 0;
|
|
|
|
if (is_multiline) // Open group before calling GetID() because groups tracks id created during their spawn
|
|
BeginGroup();
|
|
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label);
|
|
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
|
|
ImVec2 size = CalcItemSize(size_arg, CalcItemWidth(), (is_multiline ? GetTextLineHeight() * 8.0f : label_size.y) + style.FramePadding.y*2.0f); // Arbitrary default of 8 lines high for multi-line
|
|
const ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size);
|
|
const ImRect total_bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max + ImVec2(label_size.x > 0.0f ? (style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x) : 0.0f, 0.0f));
|
|
|
|
ImGuiWindow* draw_window = window;
|
|
if (is_multiline)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!BeginChildFrame(id, frame_bb.GetSize()))
|
|
{
|
|
EndChildFrame();
|
|
EndGroup();
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
draw_window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
size.x -= draw_window->ScrollbarSizes.x;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y);
|
|
if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, id))
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
const bool hovered = ItemHoverable(frame_bb, id);
|
|
if (hovered)
|
|
g.MouseCursor = ImGuiMouseCursor_TextInput;
|
|
|
|
// Password pushes a temporary font with only a fallback glyph
|
|
if (is_password)
|
|
{
|
|
const ImFontGlyph* glyph = g.Font->FindGlyph('*');
|
|
ImFont* password_font = &g.InputTextPasswordFont;
|
|
password_font->FontSize = g.Font->FontSize;
|
|
password_font->Scale = g.Font->Scale;
|
|
password_font->DisplayOffset = g.Font->DisplayOffset;
|
|
password_font->Ascent = g.Font->Ascent;
|
|
password_font->Descent = g.Font->Descent;
|
|
password_font->ContainerAtlas = g.Font->ContainerAtlas;
|
|
password_font->FallbackGlyph = glyph;
|
|
password_font->FallbackAdvanceX = glyph->AdvanceX;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(password_font->Glyphs.empty() && password_font->IndexAdvanceX.empty() && password_font->IndexLookup.empty());
|
|
PushFont(password_font);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// NB: we are only allowed to access 'edit_state' if we are the active widget.
|
|
ImGuiTextEditState& edit_state = g.InputTextState;
|
|
|
|
const bool focus_requested = FocusableItemRegister(window, id, (flags & (ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion|ImGuiInputTextFlags_AllowTabInput)) == 0); // Using completion callback disable keyboard tabbing
|
|
const bool focus_requested_by_code = focus_requested && (window->FocusIdxAllCounter == window->FocusIdxAllRequestCurrent);
|
|
const bool focus_requested_by_tab = focus_requested && !focus_requested_by_code;
|
|
|
|
const bool user_clicked = hovered && io.MouseClicked[0];
|
|
const bool user_scrolled = is_multiline && g.ActiveId == 0 && edit_state.Id == id && g.ActiveIdPreviousFrame == draw_window->GetIDNoKeepAlive("#SCROLLY");
|
|
|
|
bool clear_active_id = false;
|
|
|
|
bool select_all = (g.ActiveId != id) && (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_AutoSelectAll) != 0;
|
|
if (focus_requested || user_clicked || user_scrolled)
|
|
{
|
|
if (g.ActiveId != id)
|
|
{
|
|
// Start edition
|
|
// Take a copy of the initial buffer value (both in original UTF-8 format and converted to wchar)
|
|
// From the moment we focused we are ignoring the content of 'buf' (unless we are in read-only mode)
|
|
const int prev_len_w = edit_state.CurLenW;
|
|
edit_state.Text.resize(buf_size+1); // wchar count <= UTF-8 count. we use +1 to make sure that .Data isn't NULL so it doesn't crash.
|
|
edit_state.InitialText.resize(buf_size+1); // UTF-8. we use +1 to make sure that .Data isn't NULL so it doesn't crash.
|
|
ImStrncpy(edit_state.InitialText.Data, buf, edit_state.InitialText.Size);
|
|
const char* buf_end = NULL;
|
|
edit_state.CurLenW = ImTextStrFromUtf8(edit_state.Text.Data, edit_state.Text.Size, buf, NULL, &buf_end);
|
|
edit_state.CurLenA = (int)(buf_end - buf); // We can't get the result from ImFormatString() above because it is not UTF-8 aware. Here we'll cut off malformed UTF-8.
|
|
edit_state.CursorAnimReset();
|
|
|
|
// Preserve cursor position and undo/redo stack if we come back to same widget
|
|
// FIXME: We should probably compare the whole buffer to be on the safety side. Comparing buf (utf8) and edit_state.Text (wchar).
|
|
const bool recycle_state = (edit_state.Id == id) && (prev_len_w == edit_state.CurLenW);
|
|
if (recycle_state)
|
|
{
|
|
// Recycle existing cursor/selection/undo stack but clamp position
|
|
// Note a single mouse click will override the cursor/position immediately by calling stb_textedit_click handler.
|
|
edit_state.CursorClamp();
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
edit_state.Id = id;
|
|
edit_state.ScrollX = 0.0f;
|
|
stb_textedit_initialize_state(&edit_state.StbState, !is_multiline);
|
|
if (!is_multiline && focus_requested_by_code)
|
|
select_all = true;
|
|
}
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_AlwaysInsertMode)
|
|
edit_state.StbState.insert_mode = true;
|
|
if (!is_multiline && (focus_requested_by_tab || (user_clicked && io.KeyCtrl)))
|
|
select_all = true;
|
|
}
|
|
SetActiveID(id, window);
|
|
FocusWindow(window);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (io.MouseClicked[0])
|
|
{
|
|
// Release focus when we click outside
|
|
clear_active_id = true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool value_changed = false;
|
|
bool enter_pressed = false;
|
|
|
|
if (g.ActiveId == id)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!is_editable && !g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated)
|
|
{
|
|
// When read-only we always use the live data passed to the function
|
|
edit_state.Text.resize(buf_size+1);
|
|
const char* buf_end = NULL;
|
|
edit_state.CurLenW = ImTextStrFromUtf8(edit_state.Text.Data, edit_state.Text.Size, buf, NULL, &buf_end);
|
|
edit_state.CurLenA = (int)(buf_end - buf);
|
|
edit_state.CursorClamp();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
edit_state.BufSizeA = buf_size;
|
|
|
|
// Although we are active we don't prevent mouse from hovering other elements unless we are interacting right now with the widget.
|
|
// Down the line we should have a cleaner library-wide concept of Selected vs Active.
|
|
g.ActiveIdAllowOverlap = !io.MouseDown[0];
|
|
g.WantTextInputNextFrame = 1;
|
|
|
|
// Edit in progress
|
|
const float mouse_x = (io.MousePos.x - frame_bb.Min.x - style.FramePadding.x) + edit_state.ScrollX;
|
|
const float mouse_y = (is_multiline ? (io.MousePos.y - draw_window->DC.CursorPos.y - style.FramePadding.y) : (g.FontSize*0.5f));
|
|
|
|
const bool osx_double_click_selects_words = io.OptMacOSXBehaviors; // OS X style: Double click selects by word instead of selecting whole text
|
|
if (select_all || (hovered && !osx_double_click_selects_words && io.MouseDoubleClicked[0]))
|
|
{
|
|
edit_state.SelectAll();
|
|
edit_state.SelectedAllMouseLock = true;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (hovered && osx_double_click_selects_words && io.MouseDoubleClicked[0])
|
|
{
|
|
// Select a word only, OS X style (by simulating keystrokes)
|
|
edit_state.OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDLEFT);
|
|
edit_state.OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDRIGHT | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (io.MouseClicked[0] && !edit_state.SelectedAllMouseLock)
|
|
{
|
|
stb_textedit_click(&edit_state, &edit_state.StbState, mouse_x, mouse_y);
|
|
edit_state.CursorAnimReset();
|
|
}
|
|
else if (io.MouseDown[0] && !edit_state.SelectedAllMouseLock && (io.MouseDelta.x != 0.0f || io.MouseDelta.y != 0.0f))
|
|
{
|
|
stb_textedit_drag(&edit_state, &edit_state.StbState, mouse_x, mouse_y);
|
|
edit_state.CursorAnimReset();
|
|
edit_state.CursorFollow = true;
|
|
}
|
|
if (edit_state.SelectedAllMouseLock && !io.MouseDown[0])
|
|
edit_state.SelectedAllMouseLock = false;
|
|
|
|
if (io.InputCharacters[0])
|
|
{
|
|
// Process text input (before we check for Return because using some IME will effectively send a Return?)
|
|
// We ignore CTRL inputs, but need to allow CTRL+ALT as some keyboards (e.g. German) use AltGR - which is Alt+Ctrl - to input certain characters.
|
|
if (!(io.KeyCtrl && !io.KeyAlt) && is_editable)
|
|
{
|
|
for (int n = 0; n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(io.InputCharacters) && io.InputCharacters[n]; n++)
|
|
if (unsigned int c = (unsigned int)io.InputCharacters[n])
|
|
{
|
|
// Insert character if they pass filtering
|
|
if (!InputTextFilterCharacter(&c, flags, callback, user_data))
|
|
continue;
|
|
edit_state.OnKeyPressed((int)c);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Consume characters
|
|
memset(g.IO.InputCharacters, 0, sizeof(g.IO.InputCharacters));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool cancel_edit = false;
|
|
if (g.ActiveId == id && !g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated && !clear_active_id)
|
|
{
|
|
// Handle key-presses
|
|
const int k_mask = (io.KeyShift ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT : 0);
|
|
const bool is_shortcut_key_only = (io.OptMacOSXBehaviors ? (io.KeySuper && !io.KeyCtrl) : (io.KeyCtrl && !io.KeySuper)) && !io.KeyAlt && !io.KeyShift; // OS X style: Shortcuts using Cmd/Super instead of Ctrl
|
|
const bool is_wordmove_key_down = io.OptMacOSXBehaviors ? io.KeyAlt : io.KeyCtrl; // OS X style: Text editing cursor movement using Alt instead of Ctrl
|
|
const bool is_startend_key_down = io.OptMacOSXBehaviors && io.KeySuper && !io.KeyCtrl && !io.KeyAlt; // OS X style: Line/Text Start and End using Cmd+Arrows instead of Home/End
|
|
|
|
if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_LeftArrow)) { edit_state.OnKeyPressed((is_startend_key_down ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART : is_wordmove_key_down ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDLEFT : STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LEFT) | k_mask); }
|
|
else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_RightArrow)) { edit_state.OnKeyPressed((is_startend_key_down ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND : is_wordmove_key_down ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDRIGHT : STB_TEXTEDIT_K_RIGHT) | k_mask); }
|
|
else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_UpArrow) && is_multiline) { if (io.KeyCtrl) SetWindowScrollY(draw_window, ImMax(draw_window->Scroll.y - g.FontSize, 0.0f)); else edit_state.OnKeyPressed((is_startend_key_down ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART : STB_TEXTEDIT_K_UP) | k_mask); }
|
|
else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_DownArrow) && is_multiline) { if (io.KeyCtrl) SetWindowScrollY(draw_window, ImMin(draw_window->Scroll.y + g.FontSize, GetScrollMaxY())); else edit_state.OnKeyPressed((is_startend_key_down ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND : STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DOWN) | k_mask); }
|
|
else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Home)) { edit_state.OnKeyPressed(io.KeyCtrl ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART | k_mask : STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART | k_mask); }
|
|
else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_End)) { edit_state.OnKeyPressed(io.KeyCtrl ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND | k_mask : STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND | k_mask); }
|
|
else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Delete) && is_editable) { edit_state.OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DELETE | k_mask); }
|
|
else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Backspace) && is_editable)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!edit_state.HasSelection())
|
|
{
|
|
if (is_wordmove_key_down) edit_state.OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDLEFT|STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT);
|
|
else if (io.OptMacOSXBehaviors && io.KeySuper && !io.KeyAlt && !io.KeyCtrl) edit_state.OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART|STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT);
|
|
}
|
|
edit_state.OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_BACKSPACE | k_mask);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Enter))
|
|
{
|
|
bool ctrl_enter_for_new_line = (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CtrlEnterForNewLine) != 0;
|
|
if (!is_multiline || (ctrl_enter_for_new_line && !io.KeyCtrl) || (!ctrl_enter_for_new_line && io.KeyCtrl))
|
|
{
|
|
enter_pressed = clear_active_id = true;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (is_editable)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int c = '\n'; // Insert new line
|
|
if (InputTextFilterCharacter(&c, flags, callback, user_data))
|
|
edit_state.OnKeyPressed((int)c);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else if ((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_AllowTabInput) && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Tab) && !io.KeyCtrl && !io.KeyShift && !io.KeyAlt && is_editable)
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int c = '\t'; // Insert TAB
|
|
if (InputTextFilterCharacter(&c, flags, callback, user_data))
|
|
edit_state.OnKeyPressed((int)c);
|
|
}
|
|
else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Escape)) { clear_active_id = cancel_edit = true; }
|
|
else if (is_shortcut_key_only && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Z) && is_editable) { edit_state.OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_UNDO); edit_state.ClearSelection(); }
|
|
else if (is_shortcut_key_only && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Y) && is_editable) { edit_state.OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_REDO); edit_state.ClearSelection(); }
|
|
else if (is_shortcut_key_only && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_A)) { edit_state.SelectAll(); edit_state.CursorFollow = true; }
|
|
else if (is_shortcut_key_only && !is_password && ((IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_X) && is_editable) || IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_C)) && (!is_multiline || edit_state.HasSelection()))
|
|
{
|
|
// Cut, Copy
|
|
const bool cut = IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_X);
|
|
if (cut && !edit_state.HasSelection())
|
|
edit_state.SelectAll();
|
|
|
|
if (io.SetClipboardTextFn)
|
|
{
|
|
const int ib = edit_state.HasSelection() ? ImMin(edit_state.StbState.select_start, edit_state.StbState.select_end) : 0;
|
|
const int ie = edit_state.HasSelection() ? ImMax(edit_state.StbState.select_start, edit_state.StbState.select_end) : edit_state.CurLenW;
|
|
edit_state.TempTextBuffer.resize((ie-ib) * 4 + 1);
|
|
ImTextStrToUtf8(edit_state.TempTextBuffer.Data, edit_state.TempTextBuffer.Size, edit_state.Text.Data+ib, edit_state.Text.Data+ie);
|
|
SetClipboardText(edit_state.TempTextBuffer.Data);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (cut)
|
|
{
|
|
edit_state.CursorFollow = true;
|
|
stb_textedit_cut(&edit_state, &edit_state.StbState);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else if (is_shortcut_key_only && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_V) && is_editable)
|
|
{
|
|
// Paste
|
|
if (const char* clipboard = GetClipboardText())
|
|
{
|
|
// Filter pasted buffer
|
|
const int clipboard_len = (int)strlen(clipboard);
|
|
ImWchar* clipboard_filtered = (ImWchar*)ImGui::MemAlloc((clipboard_len+1) * sizeof(ImWchar));
|
|
int clipboard_filtered_len = 0;
|
|
for (const char* s = clipboard; *s; )
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned int c;
|
|
s += ImTextCharFromUtf8(&c, s, NULL);
|
|
if (c == 0)
|
|
break;
|
|
if (c >= 0x10000 || !InputTextFilterCharacter(&c, flags, callback, user_data))
|
|
continue;
|
|
clipboard_filtered[clipboard_filtered_len++] = (ImWchar)c;
|
|
}
|
|
clipboard_filtered[clipboard_filtered_len] = 0;
|
|
if (clipboard_filtered_len > 0) // If everything was filtered, ignore the pasting operation
|
|
{
|
|
stb_textedit_paste(&edit_state, &edit_state.StbState, clipboard_filtered, clipboard_filtered_len);
|
|
edit_state.CursorFollow = true;
|
|
}
|
|
ImGui::MemFree(clipboard_filtered);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (g.ActiveId == id)
|
|
{
|
|
if (cancel_edit)
|
|
{
|
|
// Restore initial value
|
|
if (is_editable)
|
|
{
|
|
ImStrncpy(buf, edit_state.InitialText.Data, buf_size);
|
|
value_changed = true;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// When using 'ImGuiInputTextFlags_EnterReturnsTrue' as a special case we reapply the live buffer back to the input buffer before clearing ActiveId, even though strictly speaking it wasn't modified on this frame.
|
|
// If we didn't do that, code like InputInt() with ImGuiInputTextFlags_EnterReturnsTrue would fail. Also this allows the user to use InputText() with ImGuiInputTextFlags_EnterReturnsTrue without maintaining any user-side storage.
|
|
bool apply_edit_back_to_user_buffer = !cancel_edit || (enter_pressed && (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_EnterReturnsTrue) != 0);
|
|
if (apply_edit_back_to_user_buffer)
|
|
{
|
|
// Apply new value immediately - copy modified buffer back
|
|
// Note that as soon as the input box is active, the in-widget value gets priority over any underlying modification of the input buffer
|
|
// FIXME: We actually always render 'buf' when calling DrawList->AddText, making the comment above incorrect.
|
|
// FIXME-OPT: CPU waste to do this every time the widget is active, should mark dirty state from the stb_textedit callbacks.
|
|
if (is_editable)
|
|
{
|
|
edit_state.TempTextBuffer.resize(edit_state.Text.Size * 4);
|
|
ImTextStrToUtf8(edit_state.TempTextBuffer.Data, edit_state.TempTextBuffer.Size, edit_state.Text.Data, NULL);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// User callback
|
|
if ((flags & (ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackAlways)) != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
IM_ASSERT(callback != NULL);
|
|
|
|
// The reason we specify the usage semantic (Completion/History) is that Completion needs to disable keyboard TABBING at the moment.
|
|
ImGuiInputTextFlags event_flag = 0;
|
|
ImGuiKey event_key = ImGuiKey_COUNT;
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion) != 0 && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Tab))
|
|
{
|
|
event_flag = ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion;
|
|
event_key = ImGuiKey_Tab;
|
|
}
|
|
else if ((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory) != 0 && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_UpArrow))
|
|
{
|
|
event_flag = ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory;
|
|
event_key = ImGuiKey_UpArrow;
|
|
}
|
|
else if ((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory) != 0 && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_DownArrow))
|
|
{
|
|
event_flag = ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory;
|
|
event_key = ImGuiKey_DownArrow;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackAlways)
|
|
event_flag = ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackAlways;
|
|
|
|
if (event_flag)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiTextEditCallbackData callback_data;
|
|
memset(&callback_data, 0, sizeof(ImGuiTextEditCallbackData));
|
|
callback_data.EventFlag = event_flag;
|
|
callback_data.Flags = flags;
|
|
callback_data.UserData = user_data;
|
|
callback_data.ReadOnly = !is_editable;
|
|
|
|
callback_data.EventKey = event_key;
|
|
callback_data.Buf = edit_state.TempTextBuffer.Data;
|
|
callback_data.BufTextLen = edit_state.CurLenA;
|
|
callback_data.BufSize = edit_state.BufSizeA;
|
|
callback_data.BufDirty = false;
|
|
|
|
// We have to convert from wchar-positions to UTF-8-positions, which can be pretty slow (an incentive to ditch the ImWchar buffer, see https://github.com/nothings/stb/issues/188)
|
|
ImWchar* text = edit_state.Text.Data;
|
|
const int utf8_cursor_pos = callback_data.CursorPos = ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(text, text + edit_state.StbState.cursor);
|
|
const int utf8_selection_start = callback_data.SelectionStart = ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(text, text + edit_state.StbState.select_start);
|
|
const int utf8_selection_end = callback_data.SelectionEnd = ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(text, text + edit_state.StbState.select_end);
|
|
|
|
// Call user code
|
|
callback(&callback_data);
|
|
|
|
// Read back what user may have modified
|
|
IM_ASSERT(callback_data.Buf == edit_state.TempTextBuffer.Data); // Invalid to modify those fields
|
|
IM_ASSERT(callback_data.BufSize == edit_state.BufSizeA);
|
|
IM_ASSERT(callback_data.Flags == flags);
|
|
if (callback_data.CursorPos != utf8_cursor_pos) edit_state.StbState.cursor = ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8(callback_data.Buf, callback_data.Buf + callback_data.CursorPos);
|
|
if (callback_data.SelectionStart != utf8_selection_start) edit_state.StbState.select_start = ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8(callback_data.Buf, callback_data.Buf + callback_data.SelectionStart);
|
|
if (callback_data.SelectionEnd != utf8_selection_end) edit_state.StbState.select_end = ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8(callback_data.Buf, callback_data.Buf + callback_data.SelectionEnd);
|
|
if (callback_data.BufDirty)
|
|
{
|
|
IM_ASSERT(callback_data.BufTextLen == (int)strlen(callback_data.Buf)); // You need to maintain BufTextLen if you change the text!
|
|
edit_state.CurLenW = ImTextStrFromUtf8(edit_state.Text.Data, edit_state.Text.Size, callback_data.Buf, NULL);
|
|
edit_state.CurLenA = callback_data.BufTextLen; // Assume correct length and valid UTF-8 from user, saves us an extra strlen()
|
|
edit_state.CursorAnimReset();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Copy back to user buffer
|
|
if (is_editable && strcmp(edit_state.TempTextBuffer.Data, buf) != 0)
|
|
{
|
|
ImStrncpy(buf, edit_state.TempTextBuffer.Data, buf_size);
|
|
value_changed = true;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Release active ID at the end of the function (so e.g. pressing Return still does a final application of the value)
|
|
if (clear_active_id && g.ActiveId == id)
|
|
ClearActiveID();
|
|
|
|
// Render
|
|
// Select which buffer we are going to display. When ImGuiInputTextFlags_NoLiveEdit is set 'buf' might still be the old value. We set buf to NULL to prevent accidental usage from now on.
|
|
const char* buf_display = (g.ActiveId == id && is_editable) ? edit_state.TempTextBuffer.Data : buf; buf = NULL;
|
|
|
|
if (!is_multiline)
|
|
RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_FrameBg), true, style.FrameRounding);
|
|
|
|
const ImVec4 clip_rect(frame_bb.Min.x, frame_bb.Min.y, frame_bb.Min.x + size.x, frame_bb.Min.y + size.y); // Not using frame_bb.Max because we have adjusted size
|
|
ImVec2 render_pos = is_multiline ? draw_window->DC.CursorPos : frame_bb.Min + style.FramePadding;
|
|
ImVec2 text_size(0.f, 0.f);
|
|
const bool is_currently_scrolling = (edit_state.Id == id && is_multiline && g.ActiveId == draw_window->GetIDNoKeepAlive("#SCROLLY"));
|
|
if (g.ActiveId == id || is_currently_scrolling)
|
|
{
|
|
edit_state.CursorAnim += io.DeltaTime;
|
|
|
|
// This is going to be messy. We need to:
|
|
// - Display the text (this alone can be more easily clipped)
|
|
// - Handle scrolling, highlight selection, display cursor (those all requires some form of 1d->2d cursor position calculation)
|
|
// - Measure text height (for scrollbar)
|
|
// We are attempting to do most of that in **one main pass** to minimize the computation cost (non-negligible for large amount of text) + 2nd pass for selection rendering (we could merge them by an extra refactoring effort)
|
|
// FIXME: This should occur on buf_display but we'd need to maintain cursor/select_start/select_end for UTF-8.
|
|
const ImWchar* text_begin = edit_state.Text.Data;
|
|
ImVec2 cursor_offset, select_start_offset;
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
// Count lines + find lines numbers straddling 'cursor' and 'select_start' position.
|
|
const ImWchar* searches_input_ptr[2];
|
|
searches_input_ptr[0] = text_begin + edit_state.StbState.cursor;
|
|
searches_input_ptr[1] = NULL;
|
|
int searches_remaining = 1;
|
|
int searches_result_line_number[2] = { -1, -999 };
|
|
if (edit_state.StbState.select_start != edit_state.StbState.select_end)
|
|
{
|
|
searches_input_ptr[1] = text_begin + ImMin(edit_state.StbState.select_start, edit_state.StbState.select_end);
|
|
searches_result_line_number[1] = -1;
|
|
searches_remaining++;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Iterate all lines to find our line numbers
|
|
// In multi-line mode, we never exit the loop until all lines are counted, so add one extra to the searches_remaining counter.
|
|
searches_remaining += is_multiline ? 1 : 0;
|
|
int line_count = 0;
|
|
for (const ImWchar* s = text_begin; *s != 0; s++)
|
|
if (*s == '\n')
|
|
{
|
|
line_count++;
|
|
if (searches_result_line_number[0] == -1 && s >= searches_input_ptr[0]) { searches_result_line_number[0] = line_count; if (--searches_remaining <= 0) break; }
|
|
if (searches_result_line_number[1] == -1 && s >= searches_input_ptr[1]) { searches_result_line_number[1] = line_count; if (--searches_remaining <= 0) break; }
|
|
}
|
|
line_count++;
|
|
if (searches_result_line_number[0] == -1) searches_result_line_number[0] = line_count;
|
|
if (searches_result_line_number[1] == -1) searches_result_line_number[1] = line_count;
|
|
|
|
// Calculate 2d position by finding the beginning of the line and measuring distance
|
|
cursor_offset.x = InputTextCalcTextSizeW(ImStrbolW(searches_input_ptr[0], text_begin), searches_input_ptr[0]).x;
|
|
cursor_offset.y = searches_result_line_number[0] * g.FontSize;
|
|
if (searches_result_line_number[1] >= 0)
|
|
{
|
|
select_start_offset.x = InputTextCalcTextSizeW(ImStrbolW(searches_input_ptr[1], text_begin), searches_input_ptr[1]).x;
|
|
select_start_offset.y = searches_result_line_number[1] * g.FontSize;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Store text height (note that we haven't calculated text width at all, see GitHub issues #383, #1224)
|
|
if (is_multiline)
|
|
text_size = ImVec2(size.x, line_count * g.FontSize);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Scroll
|
|
if (edit_state.CursorFollow)
|
|
{
|
|
// Horizontal scroll in chunks of quarter width
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_NoHorizontalScroll))
|
|
{
|
|
const float scroll_increment_x = size.x * 0.25f;
|
|
if (cursor_offset.x < edit_state.ScrollX)
|
|
edit_state.ScrollX = (float)(int)ImMax(0.0f, cursor_offset.x - scroll_increment_x);
|
|
else if (cursor_offset.x - size.x >= edit_state.ScrollX)
|
|
edit_state.ScrollX = (float)(int)(cursor_offset.x - size.x + scroll_increment_x);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
edit_state.ScrollX = 0.0f;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Vertical scroll
|
|
if (is_multiline)
|
|
{
|
|
float scroll_y = draw_window->Scroll.y;
|
|
if (cursor_offset.y - g.FontSize < scroll_y)
|
|
scroll_y = ImMax(0.0f, cursor_offset.y - g.FontSize);
|
|
else if (cursor_offset.y - size.y >= scroll_y)
|
|
scroll_y = cursor_offset.y - size.y;
|
|
draw_window->DC.CursorPos.y += (draw_window->Scroll.y - scroll_y); // To avoid a frame of lag
|
|
draw_window->Scroll.y = scroll_y;
|
|
render_pos.y = draw_window->DC.CursorPos.y;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
edit_state.CursorFollow = false;
|
|
const ImVec2 render_scroll = ImVec2(edit_state.ScrollX, 0.0f);
|
|
|
|
// Draw selection
|
|
if (edit_state.StbState.select_start != edit_state.StbState.select_end)
|
|
{
|
|
const ImWchar* text_selected_begin = text_begin + ImMin(edit_state.StbState.select_start, edit_state.StbState.select_end);
|
|
const ImWchar* text_selected_end = text_begin + ImMax(edit_state.StbState.select_start, edit_state.StbState.select_end);
|
|
|
|
float bg_offy_up = is_multiline ? 0.0f : -1.0f; // FIXME: those offsets should be part of the style? they don't play so well with multi-line selection.
|
|
float bg_offy_dn = is_multiline ? 0.0f : 2.0f;
|
|
ImU32 bg_color = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_TextSelectedBg);
|
|
ImVec2 rect_pos = render_pos + select_start_offset - render_scroll;
|
|
for (const ImWchar* p = text_selected_begin; p < text_selected_end; )
|
|
{
|
|
if (rect_pos.y > clip_rect.w + g.FontSize)
|
|
break;
|
|
if (rect_pos.y < clip_rect.y)
|
|
{
|
|
while (p < text_selected_end)
|
|
if (*p++ == '\n')
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
ImVec2 rect_size = InputTextCalcTextSizeW(p, text_selected_end, &p, NULL, true);
|
|
if (rect_size.x <= 0.0f) rect_size.x = (float)(int)(g.Font->GetCharAdvance((unsigned short)' ') * 0.50f); // So we can see selected empty lines
|
|
ImRect rect(rect_pos + ImVec2(0.0f, bg_offy_up - g.FontSize), rect_pos +ImVec2(rect_size.x, bg_offy_dn));
|
|
rect.ClipWith(clip_rect);
|
|
if (rect.Overlaps(clip_rect))
|
|
draw_window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(rect.Min, rect.Max, bg_color);
|
|
}
|
|
rect_pos.x = render_pos.x - render_scroll.x;
|
|
rect_pos.y += g.FontSize;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
draw_window->DrawList->AddText(g.Font, g.FontSize, render_pos - render_scroll, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text), buf_display, buf_display + edit_state.CurLenA, 0.0f, is_multiline ? NULL : &clip_rect);
|
|
|
|
// Draw blinking cursor
|
|
bool cursor_is_visible = (!g.IO.OptCursorBlink) || (g.InputTextState.CursorAnim <= 0.0f) || fmodf(g.InputTextState.CursorAnim, 1.20f) <= 0.80f;
|
|
ImVec2 cursor_screen_pos = render_pos + cursor_offset - render_scroll;
|
|
ImRect cursor_screen_rect(cursor_screen_pos.x, cursor_screen_pos.y-g.FontSize+0.5f, cursor_screen_pos.x+1.0f, cursor_screen_pos.y-1.5f);
|
|
if (cursor_is_visible && cursor_screen_rect.Overlaps(clip_rect))
|
|
draw_window->DrawList->AddLine(cursor_screen_rect.Min, cursor_screen_rect.GetBL(), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text));
|
|
|
|
// Notify OS of text input position for advanced IME (-1 x offset so that Windows IME can cover our cursor. Bit of an extra nicety.)
|
|
if (is_editable)
|
|
g.OsImePosRequest = ImVec2(cursor_screen_pos.x - 1, cursor_screen_pos.y - g.FontSize);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// Render text only
|
|
const char* buf_end = NULL;
|
|
if (is_multiline)
|
|
text_size = ImVec2(size.x, InputTextCalcTextLenAndLineCount(buf_display, &buf_end) * g.FontSize); // We don't need width
|
|
draw_window->DrawList->AddText(g.Font, g.FontSize, render_pos, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text), buf_display, buf_end, 0.0f, is_multiline ? NULL : &clip_rect);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (is_multiline)
|
|
{
|
|
Dummy(text_size + ImVec2(0.0f, g.FontSize)); // Always add room to scroll an extra line
|
|
EndChildFrame();
|
|
EndGroup();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (is_password)
|
|
PopFont();
|
|
|
|
// Log as text
|
|
if (g.LogEnabled && !is_password)
|
|
LogRenderedText(&render_pos, buf_display, NULL);
|
|
|
|
if (label_size.x > 0)
|
|
RenderText(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label);
|
|
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_EnterReturnsTrue) != 0)
|
|
return enter_pressed;
|
|
else
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::InputText(const char* label, char* buf, size_t buf_size, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags, ImGuiTextEditCallback callback, void* user_data)
|
|
{
|
|
IM_ASSERT(!(flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_Multiline)); // call InputTextMultiline()
|
|
return InputTextEx(label, buf, (int)buf_size, ImVec2(0,0), flags, callback, user_data);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::InputTextMultiline(const char* label, char* buf, size_t buf_size, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags, ImGuiTextEditCallback callback, void* user_data)
|
|
{
|
|
return InputTextEx(label, buf, (int)buf_size, size, flags | ImGuiInputTextFlags_Multiline, callback, user_data);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static inline float SmallSquareSize()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
return g.FontSize + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// NB: scalar_format here must be a simple "%xx" format string with no prefix/suffix (unlike the Drag/Slider functions "display_format" argument)
|
|
bool ImGui::InputScalarEx(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* data_ptr, void* step_ptr, void* step_fast_ptr, const char* scalar_format, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
|
|
|
|
BeginGroup();
|
|
PushID(label);
|
|
const ImVec2 button_sz = ImVec2(SmallSquareSize(), SmallSquareSize());
|
|
if (step_ptr)
|
|
PushItemWidth(ImMax(1.0f, CalcItemWidth() - (button_sz.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x)*2));
|
|
|
|
char buf[64];
|
|
DataTypeFormatString(data_type, data_ptr, scalar_format, buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf));
|
|
|
|
bool value_changed = false;
|
|
if (!(extra_flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal))
|
|
extra_flags |= ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsDecimal;
|
|
extra_flags |= ImGuiInputTextFlags_AutoSelectAll;
|
|
if (InputText("", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), extra_flags)) // PushId(label) + "" gives us the expected ID from outside point of view
|
|
value_changed = DataTypeApplyOpFromText(buf, GImGui->InputTextState.InitialText.begin(), data_type, data_ptr, scalar_format);
|
|
|
|
// Step buttons
|
|
if (step_ptr)
|
|
{
|
|
PopItemWidth();
|
|
SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
|
|
if (ButtonEx("-", button_sz, ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat | ImGuiButtonFlags_DontClosePopups))
|
|
{
|
|
DataTypeApplyOp(data_type, '-', data_ptr, g.IO.KeyCtrl && step_fast_ptr ? step_fast_ptr : step_ptr);
|
|
value_changed = true;
|
|
}
|
|
SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
|
|
if (ButtonEx("+", button_sz, ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat | ImGuiButtonFlags_DontClosePopups))
|
|
{
|
|
DataTypeApplyOp(data_type, '+', data_ptr, g.IO.KeyCtrl && step_fast_ptr ? step_fast_ptr : step_ptr);
|
|
value_changed = true;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
PopID();
|
|
|
|
if (label_size.x > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
|
|
RenderText(ImVec2(window->DC.CursorPos.x, window->DC.CursorPos.y + style.FramePadding.y), label);
|
|
ItemSize(label_size, style.FramePadding.y);
|
|
}
|
|
EndGroup();
|
|
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::InputFloat(const char* label, float* v, float step, float step_fast, int decimal_precision, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags)
|
|
{
|
|
char display_format[16];
|
|
if (decimal_precision < 0)
|
|
strcpy(display_format, "%f"); // Ideally we'd have a minimum decimal precision of 1 to visually denote that this is a float, while hiding non-significant digits? %f doesn't have a minimum of 1
|
|
else
|
|
ImFormatString(display_format, IM_ARRAYSIZE(display_format), "%%.%df", decimal_precision);
|
|
return InputScalarEx(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, (void*)v, (void*)(step>0.0f ? &step : NULL), (void*)(step_fast>0.0f ? &step_fast : NULL), display_format, extra_flags);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::InputInt(const char* label, int* v, int step, int step_fast, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags)
|
|
{
|
|
// Hexadecimal input provided as a convenience but the flag name is awkward. Typically you'd use InputText() to parse your own data, if you want to handle prefixes.
|
|
const char* scalar_format = (extra_flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal) ? "%08X" : "%d";
|
|
return InputScalarEx(label, ImGuiDataType_Int, (void*)v, (void*)(step>0.0f ? &step : NULL), (void*)(step_fast>0.0f ? &step_fast : NULL), scalar_format, extra_flags);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::InputFloatN(const char* label, float* v, int components, int decimal_precision, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
bool value_changed = false;
|
|
BeginGroup();
|
|
PushID(label);
|
|
PushMultiItemsWidths(components);
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < components; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
PushID(i);
|
|
value_changed |= InputFloat("##v", &v[i], 0, 0, decimal_precision, extra_flags);
|
|
SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
|
|
PopID();
|
|
PopItemWidth();
|
|
}
|
|
PopID();
|
|
|
|
TextUnformatted(label, FindRenderedTextEnd(label));
|
|
EndGroup();
|
|
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::InputFloat2(const char* label, float v[2], int decimal_precision, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags)
|
|
{
|
|
return InputFloatN(label, v, 2, decimal_precision, extra_flags);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::InputFloat3(const char* label, float v[3], int decimal_precision, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags)
|
|
{
|
|
return InputFloatN(label, v, 3, decimal_precision, extra_flags);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::InputFloat4(const char* label, float v[4], int decimal_precision, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags)
|
|
{
|
|
return InputFloatN(label, v, 4, decimal_precision, extra_flags);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::InputIntN(const char* label, int* v, int components, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
bool value_changed = false;
|
|
BeginGroup();
|
|
PushID(label);
|
|
PushMultiItemsWidths(components);
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < components; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
PushID(i);
|
|
value_changed |= InputInt("##v", &v[i], 0, 0, extra_flags);
|
|
SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
|
|
PopID();
|
|
PopItemWidth();
|
|
}
|
|
PopID();
|
|
|
|
TextUnformatted(label, FindRenderedTextEnd(label));
|
|
EndGroup();
|
|
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::InputInt2(const char* label, int v[2], ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags)
|
|
{
|
|
return InputIntN(label, v, 2, extra_flags);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::InputInt3(const char* label, int v[3], ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags)
|
|
{
|
|
return InputIntN(label, v, 3, extra_flags);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::InputInt4(const char* label, int v[4], ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags)
|
|
{
|
|
return InputIntN(label, v, 4, extra_flags);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static float CalcMaxPopupHeightFromItemCount(int items_count)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (items_count <= 0)
|
|
return FLT_MAX;
|
|
return (g.FontSize + g.Style.ItemSpacing.y) * items_count - g.Style.ItemSpacing.y + (g.Style.WindowPadding.y * 2);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::BeginCombo(const char* label, const char* preview_value, ImGuiComboFlags flags)
|
|
{
|
|
// Always consume the SetNextWindowSizeConstraint() call in our early return paths
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
bool backup_has_next_window_size_constraint = g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraint;
|
|
g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraint = false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label);
|
|
const float w = CalcItemWidth();
|
|
|
|
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
|
|
const ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(w, label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y*2.0f));
|
|
const ImRect total_bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max + ImVec2(label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f, 0.0f));
|
|
ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y);
|
|
if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, id))
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
const float arrow_size = SmallSquareSize();
|
|
|
|
bool hovered, held;
|
|
bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(frame_bb, id, &hovered, &held);
|
|
|
|
bool popup_open = IsPopupOpen(id);
|
|
|
|
const ImRect value_bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max - ImVec2(arrow_size, 0.0f));
|
|
RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_FrameBg), true, style.FrameRounding);
|
|
RenderFrame(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x-arrow_size, frame_bb.Min.y), frame_bb.Max, GetColorU32(popup_open || hovered ? ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered : ImGuiCol_Button), true, style.FrameRounding); // FIXME-ROUNDING
|
|
RenderTriangle(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x - arrow_size + style.FramePadding.y, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), ImGuiDir_Down);
|
|
|
|
if (preview_value != NULL)
|
|
RenderTextClipped(frame_bb.Min + style.FramePadding, value_bb.Max, preview_value, NULL, NULL, ImVec2(0.0f,0.0f));
|
|
|
|
if (label_size.x > 0)
|
|
RenderText(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label);
|
|
|
|
if (pressed && !popup_open)
|
|
{
|
|
OpenPopupEx(id, false);
|
|
popup_open = true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!popup_open)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
if (backup_has_next_window_size_constraint)
|
|
{
|
|
g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraint = true;
|
|
g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraintRect.Min.x = ImMax(g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraintRect.Min.x, w);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiComboFlags_HeightMask_) == 0)
|
|
flags |= ImGuiComboFlags_HeightRegular;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo(flags & ImGuiComboFlags_HeightMask_)); // Only one
|
|
int popup_max_height_in_items = -1;
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiComboFlags_HeightRegular) popup_max_height_in_items = 8;
|
|
else if (flags & ImGuiComboFlags_HeightSmall) popup_max_height_in_items = 4;
|
|
else if (flags & ImGuiComboFlags_HeightLarge) popup_max_height_in_items = 20;
|
|
SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(ImVec2(w, 0.0f), ImVec2(FLT_MAX, CalcMaxPopupHeightFromItemCount(popup_max_height_in_items)));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
char name[16];
|
|
ImFormatString(name, IM_ARRAYSIZE(name), "##combo_%d", g.CurrentPopupStack.Size); // Recycle windows based on depth
|
|
|
|
// Peak into expected window size so we can position it
|
|
if (ImGuiWindow* popup_window = FindWindowByName(name))
|
|
{
|
|
ImVec2 size_contents = CalcSizeContents(popup_window);
|
|
ImVec2 size_expected = CalcSizeAfterConstraint(popup_window, CalcSizeAutoFit(popup_window, size_contents));
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiComboFlags_PopupAlignLeft)
|
|
popup_window->AutoPosLastDirection = ImGuiDir_Left;
|
|
ImVec2 pos = FindBestWindowPosForPopup(frame_bb.GetBL(), size_expected, &popup_window->AutoPosLastDirection, frame_bb, ImGuiWindowFlags_ComboBox);
|
|
SetNextWindowPos(pos);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImGuiWindowFlags window_flags = ImGuiWindowFlags_ComboBox | ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize | ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings;
|
|
if (!Begin(name, NULL, window_flags))
|
|
{
|
|
EndPopup();
|
|
IM_ASSERT(0); // This should never happen as we tested for IsPopupOpen() above
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Horizontally align ourselves with the framed text
|
|
if (style.FramePadding.x != style.WindowPadding.x)
|
|
Indent(style.FramePadding.x - style.WindowPadding.x);
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::EndCombo()
|
|
{
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = GImGui->Style;
|
|
if (style.FramePadding.x != style.WindowPadding.x)
|
|
Unindent(style.FramePadding.x - style.WindowPadding.x);
|
|
EndPopup();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Combo box function.
|
|
bool ImGui::Combo(const char* label, int* current_item, bool (*items_getter)(void*, int, const char**), void* data, int items_count, int popup_max_height_in_items)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
|
|
const char* preview_text = NULL;
|
|
if (*current_item >= 0 && *current_item < items_count)
|
|
items_getter(data, *current_item, &preview_text);
|
|
|
|
if (popup_max_height_in_items != -1 && !g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraint)
|
|
{
|
|
float popup_max_height = CalcMaxPopupHeightFromItemCount(popup_max_height_in_items);
|
|
SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(ImVec2(0,0), ImVec2(FLT_MAX, popup_max_height));
|
|
}
|
|
if (!BeginCombo(label, preview_text, 0))
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
// Display items
|
|
// FIXME-OPT: Use clipper
|
|
bool value_changed = false;
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < items_count; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
PushID((void*)(intptr_t)i);
|
|
const bool item_selected = (i == *current_item);
|
|
const char* item_text;
|
|
if (!items_getter(data, i, &item_text))
|
|
item_text = "*Unknown item*";
|
|
if (Selectable(item_text, item_selected))
|
|
{
|
|
value_changed = true;
|
|
*current_item = i;
|
|
}
|
|
if (item_selected && IsWindowAppearing())
|
|
SetScrollHere();
|
|
PopID();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
EndCombo();
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static bool Items_ArrayGetter(void* data, int idx, const char** out_text)
|
|
{
|
|
const char* const* items = (const char* const*)data;
|
|
if (out_text)
|
|
*out_text = items[idx];
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static bool Items_SingleStringGetter(void* data, int idx, const char** out_text)
|
|
{
|
|
// FIXME-OPT: we could pre-compute the indices to fasten this. But only 1 active combo means the waste is limited.
|
|
const char* items_separated_by_zeros = (const char*)data;
|
|
int items_count = 0;
|
|
const char* p = items_separated_by_zeros;
|
|
while (*p)
|
|
{
|
|
if (idx == items_count)
|
|
break;
|
|
p += strlen(p) + 1;
|
|
items_count++;
|
|
}
|
|
if (!*p)
|
|
return false;
|
|
if (out_text)
|
|
*out_text = p;
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Combo box helper allowing to pass an array of strings.
|
|
bool ImGui::Combo(const char* label, int* current_item, const char* const* items, int items_count, int height_in_items)
|
|
{
|
|
const bool value_changed = Combo(label, current_item, Items_ArrayGetter, (void*)items, items_count, height_in_items);
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Combo box helper allowing to pass all items in a single string.
|
|
bool ImGui::Combo(const char* label, int* current_item, const char* items_separated_by_zeros, int height_in_items)
|
|
{
|
|
int items_count = 0;
|
|
const char* p = items_separated_by_zeros; // FIXME-OPT: Avoid computing this, or at least only when combo is open
|
|
while (*p)
|
|
{
|
|
p += strlen(p) + 1;
|
|
items_count++;
|
|
}
|
|
bool value_changed = Combo(label, current_item, Items_SingleStringGetter, (void*)items_separated_by_zeros, items_count, height_in_items);
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Tip: pass an empty label (e.g. "##dummy") then you can use the space to draw other text or image.
|
|
// But you need to make sure the ID is unique, e.g. enclose calls in PushID/PopID.
|
|
bool ImGui::Selectable(const char* label, bool selected, ImGuiSelectableFlags flags, const ImVec2& size_arg)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAllColumns) && window->DC.ColumnsCount > 1) // FIXME-OPT: Avoid if vertically clipped.
|
|
PopClipRect();
|
|
|
|
ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label);
|
|
ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
|
|
ImVec2 size(size_arg.x != 0.0f ? size_arg.x : label_size.x, size_arg.y != 0.0f ? size_arg.y : label_size.y);
|
|
ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos;
|
|
pos.y += window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset;
|
|
ImRect bb(pos, pos + size);
|
|
ItemSize(bb);
|
|
|
|
// Fill horizontal space.
|
|
ImVec2 window_padding = window->WindowPadding;
|
|
float max_x = (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAllColumns) ? GetWindowContentRegionMax().x : GetContentRegionMax().x;
|
|
float w_draw = ImMax(label_size.x, window->Pos.x + max_x - window_padding.x - window->DC.CursorPos.x);
|
|
ImVec2 size_draw((size_arg.x != 0 && !(flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_DrawFillAvailWidth)) ? size_arg.x : w_draw, size_arg.y != 0.0f ? size_arg.y : size.y);
|
|
ImRect bb_with_spacing(pos, pos + size_draw);
|
|
if (size_arg.x == 0.0f || (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_DrawFillAvailWidth))
|
|
bb_with_spacing.Max.x += window_padding.x;
|
|
|
|
// Selectables are tightly packed together, we extend the box to cover spacing between selectable.
|
|
float spacing_L = (float)(int)(style.ItemSpacing.x * 0.5f);
|
|
float spacing_U = (float)(int)(style.ItemSpacing.y * 0.5f);
|
|
float spacing_R = style.ItemSpacing.x - spacing_L;
|
|
float spacing_D = style.ItemSpacing.y - spacing_U;
|
|
bb_with_spacing.Min.x -= spacing_L;
|
|
bb_with_spacing.Min.y -= spacing_U;
|
|
bb_with_spacing.Max.x += spacing_R;
|
|
bb_with_spacing.Max.y += spacing_D;
|
|
if (!ItemAdd(bb_with_spacing, id))
|
|
{
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAllColumns) && window->DC.ColumnsCount > 1)
|
|
PushColumnClipRect();
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImGuiButtonFlags button_flags = 0;
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_Menu) button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick | ImGuiButtonFlags_NoHoldingActiveID;
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_MenuItem) button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnRelease;
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled) button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_Disabled;
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_AllowDoubleClick) button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease | ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDoubleClick;
|
|
bool hovered, held;
|
|
bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb_with_spacing, id, &hovered, &held, button_flags);
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled)
|
|
selected = false;
|
|
|
|
// Render
|
|
if (hovered || selected)
|
|
{
|
|
const ImU32 col = GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_HeaderActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered : ImGuiCol_Header);
|
|
RenderFrame(bb_with_spacing.Min, bb_with_spacing.Max, col, false, 0.0f);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAllColumns) && window->DC.ColumnsCount > 1)
|
|
{
|
|
PushColumnClipRect();
|
|
bb_with_spacing.Max.x -= (GetContentRegionMax().x - max_x);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled) PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, g.Style.Colors[ImGuiCol_TextDisabled]);
|
|
RenderTextClipped(bb.Min, bb_with_spacing.Max, label, NULL, &label_size, ImVec2(0.0f,0.0f));
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled) PopStyleColor();
|
|
|
|
// Automatically close popups
|
|
if (pressed && (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) && !(flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_DontClosePopups) && !(window->DC.ItemFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_SelectableDontClosePopup))
|
|
CloseCurrentPopup();
|
|
return pressed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::Selectable(const char* label, bool* p_selected, ImGuiSelectableFlags flags, const ImVec2& size_arg)
|
|
{
|
|
if (Selectable(label, *p_selected, flags, size_arg))
|
|
{
|
|
*p_selected = !*p_selected;
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Helper to calculate the size of a listbox and display a label on the right.
|
|
// Tip: To have a list filling the entire window width, PushItemWidth(-1) and pass an empty label "##empty"
|
|
bool ImGui::ListBoxHeader(const char* label, const ImVec2& size_arg)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = GetStyle();
|
|
const ImGuiID id = GetID(label);
|
|
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
|
|
|
|
// Size default to hold ~7 items. Fractional number of items helps seeing that we can scroll down/up without looking at scrollbar.
|
|
ImVec2 size = CalcItemSize(size_arg, CalcItemWidth(), GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing() * 7.4f + style.ItemSpacing.y);
|
|
ImVec2 frame_size = ImVec2(size.x, ImMax(size.y, label_size.y));
|
|
ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + frame_size);
|
|
ImRect bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max + ImVec2(label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f, 0.0f));
|
|
window->DC.LastItemRect = bb;
|
|
|
|
BeginGroup();
|
|
if (label_size.x > 0)
|
|
RenderText(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label);
|
|
|
|
BeginChildFrame(id, frame_bb.GetSize());
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::ListBoxHeader(const char* label, int items_count, int height_in_items)
|
|
{
|
|
// Size default to hold ~7 items. Fractional number of items helps seeing that we can scroll down/up without looking at scrollbar.
|
|
// However we don't add +0.40f if items_count <= height_in_items. It is slightly dodgy, because it means a dynamic list of items will make the widget resize occasionally when it crosses that size.
|
|
// I am expecting that someone will come and complain about this behavior in a remote future, then we can advise on a better solution.
|
|
if (height_in_items < 0)
|
|
height_in_items = ImMin(items_count, 7);
|
|
float height_in_items_f = height_in_items < items_count ? (height_in_items + 0.40f) : (height_in_items + 0.00f);
|
|
|
|
// We include ItemSpacing.y so that a list sized for the exact number of items doesn't make a scrollbar appears. We could also enforce that by passing a flag to BeginChild().
|
|
ImVec2 size;
|
|
size.x = 0.0f;
|
|
size.y = GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing() * height_in_items_f + GetStyle().ItemSpacing.y;
|
|
return ListBoxHeader(label, size);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::ListBoxFooter()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* parent_window = GetParentWindow();
|
|
const ImRect bb = parent_window->DC.LastItemRect;
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = GetStyle();
|
|
|
|
EndChildFrame();
|
|
|
|
// Redeclare item size so that it includes the label (we have stored the full size in LastItemRect)
|
|
// We call SameLine() to restore DC.CurrentLine* data
|
|
SameLine();
|
|
parent_window->DC.CursorPos = bb.Min;
|
|
ItemSize(bb, style.FramePadding.y);
|
|
EndGroup();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::ListBox(const char* label, int* current_item, const char* const* items, int items_count, int height_items)
|
|
{
|
|
const bool value_changed = ListBox(label, current_item, Items_ArrayGetter, (void*)items, items_count, height_items);
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::ListBox(const char* label, int* current_item, bool (*items_getter)(void*, int, const char**), void* data, int items_count, int height_in_items)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!ListBoxHeader(label, items_count, height_in_items))
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
// Assume all items have even height (= 1 line of text). If you need items of different or variable sizes you can create a custom version of ListBox() in your code without using the clipper.
|
|
bool value_changed = false;
|
|
ImGuiListClipper clipper(items_count, GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing()); // We know exactly our line height here so we pass it as a minor optimization, but generally you don't need to.
|
|
while (clipper.Step())
|
|
for (int i = clipper.DisplayStart; i < clipper.DisplayEnd; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
const bool item_selected = (i == *current_item);
|
|
const char* item_text;
|
|
if (!items_getter(data, i, &item_text))
|
|
item_text = "*Unknown item*";
|
|
|
|
PushID(i);
|
|
if (Selectable(item_text, item_selected))
|
|
{
|
|
*current_item = i;
|
|
value_changed = true;
|
|
}
|
|
PopID();
|
|
}
|
|
ListBoxFooter();
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::MenuItem(const char* label, const char* shortcut, bool selected, bool enabled)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos;
|
|
ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
|
|
|
|
ImGuiSelectableFlags flags = ImGuiSelectableFlags_MenuItem | (enabled ? 0 : ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled);
|
|
bool pressed;
|
|
if (window->DC.LayoutType == ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal)
|
|
{
|
|
// Mimic the exact layout spacing of BeginMenu() to allow MenuItem() inside a menu bar, which is a little misleading but may be useful
|
|
// Note that in this situation we render neither the shortcut neither the selected tick mark
|
|
float w = label_size.x;
|
|
window->DC.CursorPos.x += (float)(int)(style.ItemSpacing.x * 0.5f);
|
|
PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing, style.ItemSpacing * 2.0f);
|
|
pressed = Selectable(label, false, flags, ImVec2(w, 0.0f));
|
|
PopStyleVar();
|
|
window->DC.CursorPos.x += (float)(int)(style.ItemSpacing.x * (-1.0f + 0.5f)); // -1 spacing to compensate the spacing added when Selectable() did a SameLine(). It would also work to call SameLine() ourselves after the PopStyleVar().
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
ImVec2 shortcut_size = shortcut ? CalcTextSize(shortcut, NULL) : ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f);
|
|
float w = window->MenuColumns.DeclColumns(label_size.x, shortcut_size.x, (float)(int)(g.FontSize * 1.20f)); // Feedback for next frame
|
|
float extra_w = ImMax(0.0f, GetContentRegionAvail().x - w);
|
|
pressed = Selectable(label, false, flags | ImGuiSelectableFlags_DrawFillAvailWidth, ImVec2(w, 0.0f));
|
|
if (shortcut_size.x > 0.0f)
|
|
{
|
|
PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, g.Style.Colors[ImGuiCol_TextDisabled]);
|
|
RenderText(pos + ImVec2(window->MenuColumns.Pos[1] + extra_w, 0.0f), shortcut, NULL, false);
|
|
PopStyleColor();
|
|
}
|
|
if (selected)
|
|
RenderCheckMark(pos + ImVec2(window->MenuColumns.Pos[2] + extra_w + g.FontSize * 0.40f, g.FontSize * 0.134f * 0.5f), GetColorU32(enabled ? ImGuiCol_Text : ImGuiCol_TextDisabled), g.FontSize * 0.866f);
|
|
}
|
|
return pressed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::MenuItem(const char* label, const char* shortcut, bool* p_selected, bool enabled)
|
|
{
|
|
if (MenuItem(label, shortcut, p_selected ? *p_selected : false, enabled))
|
|
{
|
|
if (p_selected)
|
|
*p_selected = !*p_selected;
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::BeginMainMenuBar()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
SetNextWindowPos(ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f));
|
|
SetNextWindowSize(ImVec2(g.IO.DisplaySize.x, g.FontBaseSize + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f));
|
|
PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_WindowRounding, 0.0f);
|
|
PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_WindowMinSize, ImVec2(0,0));
|
|
if (!Begin("##MainMenuBar", NULL, ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings|ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar)
|
|
|| !BeginMenuBar())
|
|
{
|
|
End();
|
|
PopStyleVar(2);
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
g.CurrentWindow->DC.MenuBarOffsetX += g.Style.DisplaySafeAreaPadding.x;
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::EndMainMenuBar()
|
|
{
|
|
EndMenuBar();
|
|
End();
|
|
PopStyleVar(2);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::BeginMenuBar()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
if (!(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar))
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
IM_ASSERT(!window->DC.MenuBarAppending);
|
|
BeginGroup(); // Save position
|
|
PushID("##menubar");
|
|
|
|
// We don't clip with regular window clipping rectangle as it is already set to the area below. However we clip with window full rect.
|
|
// We remove 1 worth of rounding to Max.x to that text in long menus don't tend to display over the lower-right rounded area, which looks particularly glitchy.
|
|
ImRect bar_rect = window->MenuBarRect();
|
|
ImRect clip_rect(ImFloor(bar_rect.Min.x + 0.5f), ImFloor(bar_rect.Min.y + window->WindowBorderSize + 0.5f), ImFloor(ImMax(bar_rect.Min.x, bar_rect.Max.x - window->WindowRounding) + 0.5f), ImFloor(bar_rect.Max.y + 0.5f));
|
|
clip_rect.ClipWith(window->Rect());
|
|
PushClipRect(clip_rect.Min, clip_rect.Max, false);
|
|
|
|
window->DC.CursorPos = ImVec2(bar_rect.Min.x + window->DC.MenuBarOffsetX, bar_rect.Min.y);// + g.Style.FramePadding.y);
|
|
window->DC.LayoutType = ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal;
|
|
window->DC.MenuBarAppending = true;
|
|
AlignTextToFramePadding();
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::EndMenuBar()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
IM_ASSERT(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar);
|
|
IM_ASSERT(window->DC.MenuBarAppending);
|
|
PopClipRect();
|
|
PopID();
|
|
window->DC.MenuBarOffsetX = window->DC.CursorPos.x - window->MenuBarRect().Min.x;
|
|
window->DC.GroupStack.back().AdvanceCursor = false;
|
|
EndGroup();
|
|
window->DC.LayoutType = ImGuiLayoutType_Vertical;
|
|
window->DC.MenuBarAppending = false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::BeginMenu(const char* label, bool enabled)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label);
|
|
|
|
ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
|
|
|
|
bool pressed;
|
|
bool menu_is_open = IsPopupOpen(id);
|
|
bool menuset_is_open = !(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) && (g.OpenPopupStack.Size > g.CurrentPopupStack.Size && g.OpenPopupStack[g.CurrentPopupStack.Size].ParentMenuSet == window->GetID("##menus"));
|
|
ImGuiWindow* backed_nav_window = g.NavWindow;
|
|
if (menuset_is_open)
|
|
g.NavWindow = window; // Odd hack to allow hovering across menus of a same menu-set (otherwise we wouldn't be able to hover parent)
|
|
|
|
// The reference position stored in popup_pos will be used by Begin() to find a suitable position for the child menu (using FindBestPopupWindowPos).
|
|
ImVec2 popup_pos, pos = window->DC.CursorPos;
|
|
if (window->DC.LayoutType == ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal)
|
|
{
|
|
// Menu inside an horizontal menu bar
|
|
// Selectable extend their highlight by half ItemSpacing in each direction.
|
|
// For ChildMenu, the popup position will be overwritten by the call to FindBestPopupWindowPos() in Begin()
|
|
popup_pos = ImVec2(pos.x - window->WindowPadding.x, pos.y - style.FramePadding.y + window->MenuBarHeight());
|
|
window->DC.CursorPos.x += (float)(int)(style.ItemSpacing.x * 0.5f);
|
|
PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing, style.ItemSpacing * 2.0f);
|
|
float w = label_size.x;
|
|
pressed = Selectable(label, menu_is_open, ImGuiSelectableFlags_Menu | ImGuiSelectableFlags_DontClosePopups | (!enabled ? ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled : 0), ImVec2(w, 0.0f));
|
|
PopStyleVar();
|
|
window->DC.CursorPos.x += (float)(int)(style.ItemSpacing.x * (-1.0f + 0.5f)); // -1 spacing to compensate the spacing added when Selectable() did a SameLine(). It would also work to call SameLine() ourselves after the PopStyleVar().
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// Menu inside a menu
|
|
popup_pos = ImVec2(pos.x, pos.y - style.WindowPadding.y);
|
|
float w = window->MenuColumns.DeclColumns(label_size.x, 0.0f, (float)(int)(g.FontSize * 1.20f)); // Feedback to next frame
|
|
float extra_w = ImMax(0.0f, GetContentRegionAvail().x - w);
|
|
pressed = Selectable(label, menu_is_open, ImGuiSelectableFlags_Menu | ImGuiSelectableFlags_DontClosePopups | ImGuiSelectableFlags_DrawFillAvailWidth | (!enabled ? ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled : 0), ImVec2(w, 0.0f));
|
|
if (!enabled) PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, g.Style.Colors[ImGuiCol_TextDisabled]);
|
|
RenderTriangle(pos + ImVec2(window->MenuColumns.Pos[2] + extra_w + g.FontSize * 0.30f, 0.0f), ImGuiDir_Right);
|
|
if (!enabled) PopStyleColor();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const bool hovered = enabled && ItemHoverable(window->DC.LastItemRect, id);
|
|
if (menuset_is_open)
|
|
g.NavWindow = backed_nav_window;
|
|
|
|
bool want_open = false, want_close = false;
|
|
if (window->DC.LayoutType != ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal) // (window->Flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup|ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu))
|
|
{
|
|
// Implement http://bjk5.com/post/44698559168/breaking-down-amazons-mega-dropdown to avoid using timers, so menus feels more reactive.
|
|
bool moving_within_opened_triangle = false;
|
|
if (g.HoveredWindow == window && g.OpenPopupStack.Size > g.CurrentPopupStack.Size && g.OpenPopupStack[g.CurrentPopupStack.Size].ParentWindow == window)
|
|
{
|
|
if (ImGuiWindow* next_window = g.OpenPopupStack[g.CurrentPopupStack.Size].Window)
|
|
{
|
|
ImRect next_window_rect = next_window->Rect();
|
|
ImVec2 ta = g.IO.MousePos - g.IO.MouseDelta;
|
|
ImVec2 tb = (window->Pos.x < next_window->Pos.x) ? next_window_rect.GetTL() : next_window_rect.GetTR();
|
|
ImVec2 tc = (window->Pos.x < next_window->Pos.x) ? next_window_rect.GetBL() : next_window_rect.GetBR();
|
|
float extra = ImClamp(fabsf(ta.x - tb.x) * 0.30f, 5.0f, 30.0f); // add a bit of extra slack.
|
|
ta.x += (window->Pos.x < next_window->Pos.x) ? -0.5f : +0.5f; // to avoid numerical issues
|
|
tb.y = ta.y + ImMax((tb.y - extra) - ta.y, -100.0f); // triangle is maximum 200 high to limit the slope and the bias toward large sub-menus // FIXME: Multiply by fb_scale?
|
|
tc.y = ta.y + ImMin((tc.y + extra) - ta.y, +100.0f);
|
|
moving_within_opened_triangle = ImTriangleContainsPoint(ta, tb, tc, g.IO.MousePos);
|
|
//window->DrawList->PushClipRectFullScreen(); window->DrawList->AddTriangleFilled(ta, tb, tc, moving_within_opened_triangle ? IM_COL32(0,128,0,128) : IM_COL32(128,0,0,128)); window->DrawList->PopClipRect(); // Debug
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
want_close = (menu_is_open && !hovered && g.HoveredWindow == window && g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame != 0 && g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame != id && !moving_within_opened_triangle);
|
|
want_open = (!menu_is_open && hovered && !moving_within_opened_triangle) || (!menu_is_open && hovered && pressed);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// Menu bar
|
|
if (menu_is_open && pressed && menuset_is_open) // Click an open menu again to close it
|
|
{
|
|
want_close = true;
|
|
want_open = menu_is_open = false;
|
|
}
|
|
else if (pressed || (hovered && menuset_is_open && !menu_is_open)) // First click to open, then hover to open others
|
|
{
|
|
want_open = true;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!enabled) // explicitly close if an open menu becomes disabled, facilitate users code a lot in pattern such as 'if (BeginMenu("options", has_object)) { ..use object.. }'
|
|
want_close = true;
|
|
if (want_close && IsPopupOpen(id))
|
|
ClosePopupToLevel(GImGui->CurrentPopupStack.Size);
|
|
|
|
if (!menu_is_open && want_open && g.OpenPopupStack.Size > g.CurrentPopupStack.Size)
|
|
{
|
|
// Don't recycle same menu level in the same frame, first close the other menu and yield for a frame.
|
|
OpenPopup(label);
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
menu_is_open |= want_open;
|
|
if (want_open)
|
|
OpenPopup(label);
|
|
|
|
if (menu_is_open)
|
|
{
|
|
SetNextWindowPos(popup_pos, ImGuiCond_Always);
|
|
ImGuiWindowFlags flags = ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize | ((window->Flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup|ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu)) ? ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu|ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow : ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu);
|
|
menu_is_open = BeginPopupEx(id, flags); // menu_is_open can be 'false' when the popup is completely clipped (e.g. zero size display)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return menu_is_open;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::EndMenu()
|
|
{
|
|
EndPopup();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Note: only access 3 floats if ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha flag is set.
|
|
void ImGui::ColorTooltip(const char* text, const float* col, ImGuiColorEditFlags flags)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
|
|
int cr = IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[0]), cg = IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[1]), cb = IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[2]), ca = (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) ? 255 : IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[3]);
|
|
BeginTooltipEx(0, true);
|
|
|
|
const char* text_end = text ? FindRenderedTextEnd(text, NULL) : text;
|
|
if (text_end > text)
|
|
{
|
|
TextUnformatted(text, text_end);
|
|
Separator();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImVec2 sz(g.FontSize * 3 + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2, g.FontSize * 3 + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2);
|
|
ColorButton("##preview", ImVec4(col[0], col[1], col[2], col[3]), (flags & (ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreview | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf)) | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoTooltip, sz);
|
|
SameLine();
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha)
|
|
Text("#%02X%02X%02X\nR: %d, G: %d, B: %d\n(%.3f, %.3f, %.3f)", cr, cg, cb, cr, cg, cb, col[0], col[1], col[2]);
|
|
else
|
|
Text("#%02X%02X%02X%02X\nR:%d, G:%d, B:%d, A:%d\n(%.3f, %.3f, %.3f, %.3f)", cr, cg, cb, ca, cr, cg, cb, ca, col[0], col[1], col[2], col[3]);
|
|
EndTooltip();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static inline ImU32 ImAlphaBlendColor(ImU32 col_a, ImU32 col_b)
|
|
{
|
|
float t = ((col_b >> IM_COL32_A_SHIFT) & 0xFF) / 255.f;
|
|
int r = ImLerp((int)(col_a >> IM_COL32_R_SHIFT) & 0xFF, (int)(col_b >> IM_COL32_R_SHIFT) & 0xFF, t);
|
|
int g = ImLerp((int)(col_a >> IM_COL32_G_SHIFT) & 0xFF, (int)(col_b >> IM_COL32_G_SHIFT) & 0xFF, t);
|
|
int b = ImLerp((int)(col_a >> IM_COL32_B_SHIFT) & 0xFF, (int)(col_b >> IM_COL32_B_SHIFT) & 0xFF, t);
|
|
return IM_COL32(r, g, b, 0xFF);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// NB: This is rather brittle and will show artifact when rounding this enabled if rounded corners overlap multiple cells. Caller currently responsible for avoiding that.
|
|
// I spent a non reasonable amount of time trying to getting this right for ColorButton with rounding+anti-aliasing+ImGuiColorEditFlags_HalfAlphaPreview flag + various grid sizes and offsets, and eventually gave up... probably more reasonable to disable rounding alltogether.
|
|
void ImGui::RenderColorRectWithAlphaCheckerboard(ImVec2 p_min, ImVec2 p_max, ImU32 col, float grid_step, ImVec2 grid_off, float rounding, int rounding_corners_flags)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) >> IM_COL32_A_SHIFT) < 0xFF)
|
|
{
|
|
ImU32 col_bg1 = GetColorU32(ImAlphaBlendColor(IM_COL32(204,204,204,255), col));
|
|
ImU32 col_bg2 = GetColorU32(ImAlphaBlendColor(IM_COL32(128,128,128,255), col));
|
|
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(p_min, p_max, col_bg1, rounding, rounding_corners_flags);
|
|
|
|
int yi = 0;
|
|
for (float y = p_min.y + grid_off.y; y < p_max.y; y += grid_step, yi++)
|
|
{
|
|
float y1 = ImClamp(y, p_min.y, p_max.y), y2 = ImMin(y + grid_step, p_max.y);
|
|
if (y2 <= y1)
|
|
continue;
|
|
for (float x = p_min.x + grid_off.x + (yi & 1) * grid_step; x < p_max.x; x += grid_step * 2.0f)
|
|
{
|
|
float x1 = ImClamp(x, p_min.x, p_max.x), x2 = ImMin(x + grid_step, p_max.x);
|
|
if (x2 <= x1)
|
|
continue;
|
|
int rounding_corners_flags_cell = 0;
|
|
if (y1 <= p_min.y) { if (x1 <= p_min.x) rounding_corners_flags_cell |= ImDrawCornerFlags_TopLeft; if (x2 >= p_max.x) rounding_corners_flags_cell |= ImDrawCornerFlags_TopRight; }
|
|
if (y2 >= p_max.y) { if (x1 <= p_min.x) rounding_corners_flags_cell |= ImDrawCornerFlags_BotLeft; if (x2 >= p_max.x) rounding_corners_flags_cell |= ImDrawCornerFlags_BotRight; }
|
|
rounding_corners_flags_cell &= rounding_corners_flags;
|
|
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(ImVec2(x1,y1), ImVec2(x2,y2), col_bg2, rounding_corners_flags_cell ? rounding : 0.0f, rounding_corners_flags_cell);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(p_min, p_max, col, rounding, rounding_corners_flags);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetColorEditOptions(ImGuiColorEditFlags flags)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputsMask) == 0)
|
|
flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags__OptionsDefault & ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputsMask;
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__DataTypeMask) == 0)
|
|
flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags__OptionsDefault & ImGuiColorEditFlags__DataTypeMask;
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask) == 0)
|
|
flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags__OptionsDefault & ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo((int)(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputsMask))); // Check only 1 option is selected
|
|
IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo((int)(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__DataTypeMask))); // Check only 1 option is selected
|
|
IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo((int)(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask))); // Check only 1 option is selected
|
|
g.ColorEditOptions = flags;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A little colored square. Return true when clicked.
|
|
// FIXME: May want to display/ignore the alpha component in the color display? Yet show it in the tooltip.
|
|
// 'desc_id' is not called 'label' because we don't display it next to the button, but only in the tooltip.
|
|
bool ImGui::ColorButton(const char* desc_id, const ImVec4& col, ImGuiColorEditFlags flags, ImVec2 size)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(desc_id);
|
|
float default_size = SmallSquareSize();
|
|
if (size.x == 0.0f)
|
|
size.x = default_size;
|
|
if (size.y == 0.0f)
|
|
size.y = default_size;
|
|
const ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size);
|
|
ItemSize(bb, (size.y >= default_size) ? g.Style.FramePadding.y : 0.0f);
|
|
if (!ItemAdd(bb, id))
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
bool hovered, held;
|
|
bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held);
|
|
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha)
|
|
flags &= ~(ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreview | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf);
|
|
|
|
ImVec4 col_without_alpha(col.x, col.y, col.z, 1.0f);
|
|
float grid_step = ImMin(size.x, size.y) / 2.99f;
|
|
float rounding = ImMin(g.Style.FrameRounding, grid_step * 0.5f);
|
|
ImRect bb_inner = bb;
|
|
float off = -0.75f; // The border (using Col_FrameBg) tends to look off when color is near-opaque and rounding is enabled. This offset seemed like a good middle ground to reduce those artifacts.
|
|
bb_inner.Expand(off);
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf) && col.w < 1.0f)
|
|
{
|
|
float mid_x = (float)(int)((bb_inner.Min.x + bb_inner.Max.x) * 0.5f + 0.5f);
|
|
RenderColorRectWithAlphaCheckerboard(ImVec2(bb_inner.Min.x + grid_step, bb_inner.Min.y), bb_inner.Max, GetColorU32(col), grid_step, ImVec2(-grid_step + off, off), rounding, ImDrawCornerFlags_TopRight| ImDrawCornerFlags_BotRight);
|
|
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(bb_inner.Min, ImVec2(mid_x, bb_inner.Max.y), GetColorU32(col_without_alpha), rounding, ImDrawCornerFlags_TopLeft|ImDrawCornerFlags_BotLeft);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// Because GetColorU32() multiplies by the global style Alpha and we don't want to display a checkerboard if the source code had no alpha
|
|
ImVec4 col_source = (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreview) ? col : col_without_alpha;
|
|
if (col_source.w < 1.0f)
|
|
RenderColorRectWithAlphaCheckerboard(bb_inner.Min, bb_inner.Max, GetColorU32(col_source), grid_step, ImVec2(off, off), rounding);
|
|
else
|
|
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(bb_inner.Min, bb_inner.Max, GetColorU32(col_source), rounding, ImDrawCornerFlags_All);
|
|
}
|
|
if (g.Style.FrameBorderSize > 0.0f)
|
|
RenderFrameBorder(bb.Min, bb.Max, rounding);
|
|
else
|
|
window->DrawList->AddRect(bb.Min, bb.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_FrameBg), rounding); // Color button are often in need of some sort of border
|
|
|
|
if (hovered && !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoTooltip))
|
|
ColorTooltip(desc_id, &col.x, flags & (ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreview | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf));
|
|
|
|
return pressed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::ColorEdit3(const char* label, float col[3], ImGuiColorEditFlags flags)
|
|
{
|
|
return ColorEdit4(label, col, flags | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::ColorEditOptionsPopup(const float* col, ImGuiColorEditFlags flags)
|
|
{
|
|
bool allow_opt_inputs = !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputsMask);
|
|
bool allow_opt_datatype = !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__DataTypeMask);
|
|
if ((!allow_opt_inputs && !allow_opt_datatype) || !BeginPopup("context"))
|
|
return;
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiColorEditFlags opts = g.ColorEditOptions;
|
|
if (allow_opt_inputs)
|
|
{
|
|
if (RadioButton("RGB", (opts & ImGuiColorEditFlags_RGB) ? 1 : 0)) opts = (opts & ~ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputsMask) | ImGuiColorEditFlags_RGB;
|
|
if (RadioButton("HSV", (opts & ImGuiColorEditFlags_HSV) ? 1 : 0)) opts = (opts & ~ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputsMask) | ImGuiColorEditFlags_HSV;
|
|
if (RadioButton("HEX", (opts & ImGuiColorEditFlags_HEX) ? 1 : 0)) opts = (opts & ~ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputsMask) | ImGuiColorEditFlags_HEX;
|
|
}
|
|
if (allow_opt_datatype)
|
|
{
|
|
if (allow_opt_inputs) Separator();
|
|
if (RadioButton("0..255", (opts & ImGuiColorEditFlags_Uint8) ? 1 : 0)) opts = (opts & ~ImGuiColorEditFlags__DataTypeMask) | ImGuiColorEditFlags_Uint8;
|
|
if (RadioButton("0.00..1.00", (opts & ImGuiColorEditFlags_Float) ? 1 : 0)) opts = (opts & ~ImGuiColorEditFlags__DataTypeMask) | ImGuiColorEditFlags_Float;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (allow_opt_inputs || allow_opt_datatype)
|
|
Separator();
|
|
if (Button("Copy as..", ImVec2(-1,0)))
|
|
OpenPopup("Copy");
|
|
if (BeginPopup("Copy"))
|
|
{
|
|
int cr = IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[0]), cg = IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[1]), cb = IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[2]), ca = (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) ? 255 : IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[3]);
|
|
char buf[64];
|
|
ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "(%.3ff, %.3ff, %.3ff, %.3ff)", col[0], col[1], col[2], (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) ? 1.0f : col[3]);
|
|
if (Selectable(buf))
|
|
SetClipboardText(buf);
|
|
ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "(%d,%d,%d,%d)", cr, cg, cb, ca);
|
|
if (Selectable(buf))
|
|
SetClipboardText(buf);
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha)
|
|
ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "0x%02X%02X%02X", cr, cg, cb);
|
|
else
|
|
ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "0x%02X%02X%02X%02X", cr, cg, cb, ca);
|
|
if (Selectable(buf))
|
|
SetClipboardText(buf);
|
|
EndPopup();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
g.ColorEditOptions = opts;
|
|
EndPopup();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void ColorPickerOptionsPopup(ImGuiColorEditFlags flags, float* ref_col)
|
|
{
|
|
bool allow_opt_picker = !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask);
|
|
bool allow_opt_alpha_bar = !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) && !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaBar);
|
|
if ((!allow_opt_picker && !allow_opt_alpha_bar) || !ImGui::BeginPopup("context"))
|
|
return;
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (allow_opt_picker)
|
|
{
|
|
ImVec2 picker_size(g.FontSize * 8, ImMax(g.FontSize * 8 - (SmallSquareSize() + g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x), 1.0f)); // FIXME: Picker size copied from main picker function
|
|
ImGui::PushItemWidth(picker_size.x);
|
|
for (int picker_type = 0; picker_type < 2; picker_type++)
|
|
{
|
|
// Draw small/thumbnail version of each picker type (over an invisible button for selection)
|
|
if (picker_type > 0) ImGui::Separator();
|
|
ImGui::PushID(picker_type);
|
|
ImGuiColorEditFlags picker_flags = ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoInputs|ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions|ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoLabel|ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSidePreview|(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha);
|
|
if (picker_type == 0) picker_flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueBar;
|
|
if (picker_type == 1) picker_flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueWheel;
|
|
ImVec2 backup_pos = ImGui::GetCursorScreenPos();
|
|
if (ImGui::Selectable("##selectable", false, 0, picker_size)) // By default, Selectable() is closing popup
|
|
g.ColorEditOptions = (g.ColorEditOptions & ~ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask) | (picker_flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask);
|
|
ImGui::SetCursorScreenPos(backup_pos);
|
|
ImVec4 dummy_ref_col;
|
|
memcpy(&dummy_ref_col.x, ref_col, sizeof(float) * (picker_flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha ? 3 : 4));
|
|
ImGui::ColorPicker4("##dummypicker", &dummy_ref_col.x, picker_flags);
|
|
ImGui::PopID();
|
|
}
|
|
ImGui::PopItemWidth();
|
|
}
|
|
if (allow_opt_alpha_bar)
|
|
{
|
|
if (allow_opt_picker) ImGui::Separator();
|
|
ImGui::CheckboxFlags("Alpha Bar", (unsigned int*)&g.ColorEditOptions, ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaBar);
|
|
}
|
|
ImGui::EndPopup();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Edit colors components (each component in 0.0f..1.0f range).
|
|
// See enum ImGuiColorEditFlags_ for available options. e.g. Only access 3 floats if ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha flag is set.
|
|
// With typical options: Left-click on colored square to open color picker. Right-click to open option menu. CTRL-Click over input fields to edit them and TAB to go to next item.
|
|
bool ImGui::ColorEdit4(const char* label, float col[4], ImGuiColorEditFlags flags)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
const float square_sz = SmallSquareSize();
|
|
const float w_extra = (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSmallPreview) ? 0.0f : (square_sz + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
|
|
const float w_items_all = CalcItemWidth() - w_extra;
|
|
const char* label_display_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(label);
|
|
|
|
const bool alpha = (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) == 0;
|
|
const bool hdr = (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_HDR) != 0;
|
|
const int components = alpha ? 4 : 3;
|
|
const ImGuiColorEditFlags flags_untouched = flags;
|
|
|
|
BeginGroup();
|
|
PushID(label);
|
|
|
|
// If we're not showing any slider there's no point in doing any HSV conversions
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoInputs)
|
|
flags = (flags & (~ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputsMask)) | ImGuiColorEditFlags_RGB | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions;
|
|
|
|
// Context menu: display and modify options (before defaults are applied)
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions))
|
|
ColorEditOptionsPopup(col, flags);
|
|
|
|
// Read stored options
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputsMask))
|
|
flags |= (g.ColorEditOptions & ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputsMask);
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__DataTypeMask))
|
|
flags |= (g.ColorEditOptions & ImGuiColorEditFlags__DataTypeMask);
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask))
|
|
flags |= (g.ColorEditOptions & ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask);
|
|
flags |= (g.ColorEditOptions & ~(ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputsMask | ImGuiColorEditFlags__DataTypeMask | ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask));
|
|
|
|
// Convert to the formats we need
|
|
float f[4] = { col[0], col[1], col[2], alpha ? col[3] : 1.0f };
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_HSV)
|
|
ColorConvertRGBtoHSV(f[0], f[1], f[2], f[0], f[1], f[2]);
|
|
int i[4] = { IM_F32_TO_INT8_UNBOUND(f[0]), IM_F32_TO_INT8_UNBOUND(f[1]), IM_F32_TO_INT8_UNBOUND(f[2]), IM_F32_TO_INT8_UNBOUND(f[3]) };
|
|
|
|
bool value_changed = false;
|
|
bool value_changed_as_float = false;
|
|
|
|
if ((flags & (ImGuiColorEditFlags_RGB | ImGuiColorEditFlags_HSV)) != 0 && (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoInputs) == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
// RGB/HSV 0..255 Sliders
|
|
const float w_item_one = ImMax(1.0f, (float)(int)((w_items_all - (style.ItemInnerSpacing.x) * (components-1)) / (float)components));
|
|
const float w_item_last = ImMax(1.0f, (float)(int)(w_items_all - (w_item_one + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x) * (components-1)));
|
|
|
|
const bool hide_prefix = (w_item_one <= CalcTextSize((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_Float) ? "M:0.000" : "M:000").x);
|
|
const char* ids[4] = { "##X", "##Y", "##Z", "##W" };
|
|
const char* fmt_table_int[3][4] =
|
|
{
|
|
{ "%3.0f", "%3.0f", "%3.0f", "%3.0f" }, // Short display
|
|
{ "R:%3.0f", "G:%3.0f", "B:%3.0f", "A:%3.0f" }, // Long display for RGBA
|
|
{ "H:%3.0f", "S:%3.0f", "V:%3.0f", "A:%3.0f" } // Long display for HSVA
|
|
};
|
|
const char* fmt_table_float[3][4] =
|
|
{
|
|
{ "%0.3f", "%0.3f", "%0.3f", "%0.3f" }, // Short display
|
|
{ "R:%0.3f", "G:%0.3f", "B:%0.3f", "A:%0.3f" }, // Long display for RGBA
|
|
{ "H:%0.3f", "S:%0.3f", "V:%0.3f", "A:%0.3f" } // Long display for HSVA
|
|
};
|
|
const int fmt_idx = hide_prefix ? 0 : (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_HSV) ? 2 : 1;
|
|
|
|
PushItemWidth(w_item_one);
|
|
for (int n = 0; n < components; n++)
|
|
{
|
|
if (n > 0)
|
|
SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
|
|
if (n + 1 == components)
|
|
PushItemWidth(w_item_last);
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_Float)
|
|
value_changed = value_changed_as_float = value_changed | DragFloat(ids[n], &f[n], 1.0f/255.0f, 0.0f, hdr ? 0.0f : 1.0f, fmt_table_float[fmt_idx][n]);
|
|
else
|
|
value_changed |= DragInt(ids[n], &i[n], 1.0f, 0, hdr ? 0 : 255, fmt_table_int[fmt_idx][n]);
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions))
|
|
OpenPopupOnItemClick("context");
|
|
}
|
|
PopItemWidth();
|
|
PopItemWidth();
|
|
}
|
|
else if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_HEX) != 0 && (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoInputs) == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
// RGB Hexadecimal Input
|
|
char buf[64];
|
|
if (alpha)
|
|
ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "#%02X%02X%02X%02X", ImClamp(i[0],0,255), ImClamp(i[1],0,255), ImClamp(i[2],0,255), ImClamp(i[3],0,255));
|
|
else
|
|
ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "#%02X%02X%02X", ImClamp(i[0],0,255), ImClamp(i[1],0,255), ImClamp(i[2],0,255));
|
|
PushItemWidth(w_items_all);
|
|
if (InputText("##Text", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsUppercase))
|
|
{
|
|
value_changed = true;
|
|
char* p = buf;
|
|
while (*p == '#' || ImCharIsSpace(*p))
|
|
p++;
|
|
i[0] = i[1] = i[2] = i[3] = 0;
|
|
if (alpha)
|
|
sscanf(p, "%02X%02X%02X%02X", (unsigned int*)&i[0], (unsigned int*)&i[1], (unsigned int*)&i[2], (unsigned int*)&i[3]); // Treat at unsigned (%X is unsigned)
|
|
else
|
|
sscanf(p, "%02X%02X%02X", (unsigned int*)&i[0], (unsigned int*)&i[1], (unsigned int*)&i[2]);
|
|
}
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions))
|
|
OpenPopupOnItemClick("context");
|
|
PopItemWidth();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool picker_active = false;
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSmallPreview))
|
|
{
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoInputs))
|
|
SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
|
|
|
|
const ImVec4 col_v4(col[0], col[1], col[2], alpha ? col[3] : 1.0f);
|
|
if (ColorButton("##ColorButton", col_v4, flags))
|
|
{
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoPicker))
|
|
{
|
|
// Store current color and open a picker
|
|
g.ColorPickerRef = col_v4;
|
|
OpenPopup("picker");
|
|
SetNextWindowPos(window->DC.LastItemRect.GetBL() + ImVec2(-1,style.ItemSpacing.y));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions))
|
|
OpenPopupOnItemClick("context");
|
|
|
|
if (BeginPopup("picker"))
|
|
{
|
|
picker_active = true;
|
|
if (label != label_display_end)
|
|
{
|
|
TextUnformatted(label, label_display_end);
|
|
Separator();
|
|
}
|
|
ImGuiColorEditFlags picker_flags_to_forward = ImGuiColorEditFlags__DataTypeMask | ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask | ImGuiColorEditFlags_HDR | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaBar;
|
|
ImGuiColorEditFlags picker_flags = (flags_untouched & picker_flags_to_forward) | ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputsMask | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoLabel | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf;
|
|
PushItemWidth(square_sz * 12.0f); // Use 256 + bar sizes?
|
|
value_changed |= ColorPicker4("##picker", col, picker_flags, &g.ColorPickerRef.x);
|
|
PopItemWidth();
|
|
EndPopup();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (label != label_display_end && !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoLabel))
|
|
{
|
|
SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
|
|
TextUnformatted(label, label_display_end);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Convert back
|
|
if (!picker_active)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!value_changed_as_float)
|
|
for (int n = 0; n < 4; n++)
|
|
f[n] = i[n] / 255.0f;
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_HSV)
|
|
ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(f[0], f[1], f[2], f[0], f[1], f[2]);
|
|
if (value_changed)
|
|
{
|
|
col[0] = f[0];
|
|
col[1] = f[1];
|
|
col[2] = f[2];
|
|
if (alpha)
|
|
col[3] = f[3];
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
PopID();
|
|
EndGroup();
|
|
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::ColorPicker3(const char* label, float col[3], ImGuiColorEditFlags flags)
|
|
{
|
|
float col4[4] = { col[0], col[1], col[2], 1.0f };
|
|
if (!ColorPicker4(label, col4, flags | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha))
|
|
return false;
|
|
col[0] = col4[0]; col[1] = col4[1]; col[2] = col4[2];
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// 'pos' is position of the arrow tip. half_sz.x is length from base to tip. half_sz.y is length on each side.
|
|
static void RenderArrow(ImDrawList* draw_list, ImVec2 pos, ImVec2 half_sz, ImGuiDir direction, ImU32 col)
|
|
{
|
|
switch (direction)
|
|
{
|
|
case ImGuiDir_Left: draw_list->AddTriangleFilled(ImVec2(pos.x + half_sz.x, pos.y - half_sz.y), ImVec2(pos.x + half_sz.x, pos.y + half_sz.y), pos, col); return;
|
|
case ImGuiDir_Right: draw_list->AddTriangleFilled(ImVec2(pos.x - half_sz.x, pos.y + half_sz.y), ImVec2(pos.x - half_sz.x, pos.y - half_sz.y), pos, col); return;
|
|
case ImGuiDir_Up: draw_list->AddTriangleFilled(ImVec2(pos.x + half_sz.x, pos.y + half_sz.y), ImVec2(pos.x - half_sz.x, pos.y + half_sz.y), pos, col); return;
|
|
case ImGuiDir_Down: draw_list->AddTriangleFilled(ImVec2(pos.x - half_sz.x, pos.y - half_sz.y), ImVec2(pos.x + half_sz.x, pos.y - half_sz.y), pos, col); return;
|
|
default: return; // Fix warning for ImGuiDir_None
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void RenderArrowsForVerticalBar(ImDrawList* draw_list, ImVec2 pos, ImVec2 half_sz, float bar_w)
|
|
{
|
|
RenderArrow(draw_list, ImVec2(pos.x + half_sz.x + 1, pos.y), ImVec2(half_sz.x + 2, half_sz.y + 1), ImGuiDir_Right, IM_COL32_BLACK);
|
|
RenderArrow(draw_list, ImVec2(pos.x + half_sz.x, pos.y), half_sz, ImGuiDir_Right, IM_COL32_WHITE);
|
|
RenderArrow(draw_list, ImVec2(pos.x + bar_w - half_sz.x - 1, pos.y), ImVec2(half_sz.x + 2, half_sz.y + 1), ImGuiDir_Left, IM_COL32_BLACK);
|
|
RenderArrow(draw_list, ImVec2(pos.x + bar_w - half_sz.x, pos.y), half_sz, ImGuiDir_Left, IM_COL32_WHITE);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ColorPicker
|
|
// Note: only access 3 floats if ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha flag is set.
|
|
// FIXME: we adjust the big color square height based on item width, which may cause a flickering feedback loop (if automatic height makes a vertical scrollbar appears, affecting automatic width..)
|
|
bool ImGui::ColorPicker4(const char* label, float col[4], ImGuiColorEditFlags flags, const float* ref_col)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
ImDrawList* draw_list = window->DrawList;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
|
|
ImGuiIO& io = g.IO;
|
|
|
|
PushID(label);
|
|
BeginGroup();
|
|
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSidePreview))
|
|
flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSmallPreview;
|
|
|
|
// Context menu: display and store options.
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions))
|
|
ColorPickerOptionsPopup(flags, col);
|
|
|
|
// Read stored options
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask))
|
|
flags |= ((g.ColorEditOptions & ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask) ? g.ColorEditOptions : ImGuiColorEditFlags__OptionsDefault) & ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo((int)(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask))); // Check that only 1 is selected
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions))
|
|
flags |= (g.ColorEditOptions & ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaBar);
|
|
|
|
// Setup
|
|
bool alpha_bar = (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaBar) && !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha);
|
|
ImVec2 picker_pos = window->DC.CursorPos;
|
|
float square_sz = SmallSquareSize();
|
|
float bars_width = square_sz; // Arbitrary smallish width of Hue/Alpha picking bars
|
|
float sv_picker_size = ImMax(bars_width * 1, CalcItemWidth() - (alpha_bar ? 2 : 1) * (bars_width + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x)); // Saturation/Value picking box
|
|
float bar0_pos_x = picker_pos.x + sv_picker_size + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x;
|
|
float bar1_pos_x = bar0_pos_x + bars_width + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x;
|
|
float bars_triangles_half_sz = (float)(int)(bars_width * 0.20f);
|
|
|
|
float wheel_thickness = sv_picker_size * 0.08f;
|
|
float wheel_r_outer = sv_picker_size * 0.50f;
|
|
float wheel_r_inner = wheel_r_outer - wheel_thickness;
|
|
ImVec2 wheel_center(picker_pos.x + (sv_picker_size + bars_width)*0.5f, picker_pos.y + sv_picker_size*0.5f);
|
|
|
|
// Note: the triangle is displayed rotated with triangle_pa pointing to Hue, but most coordinates stays unrotated for logic.
|
|
float triangle_r = wheel_r_inner - (int)(sv_picker_size * 0.027f);
|
|
ImVec2 triangle_pa = ImVec2(triangle_r, 0.0f); // Hue point.
|
|
ImVec2 triangle_pb = ImVec2(triangle_r * -0.5f, triangle_r * -0.866025f); // Black point.
|
|
ImVec2 triangle_pc = ImVec2(triangle_r * -0.5f, triangle_r * +0.866025f); // White point.
|
|
|
|
float H,S,V;
|
|
ColorConvertRGBtoHSV(col[0], col[1], col[2], H, S, V);
|
|
|
|
bool value_changed = false, value_changed_h = false, value_changed_sv = false;
|
|
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueWheel)
|
|
{
|
|
// Hue wheel + SV triangle logic
|
|
InvisibleButton("hsv", ImVec2(sv_picker_size + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + bars_width, sv_picker_size));
|
|
if (IsItemActive())
|
|
{
|
|
ImVec2 initial_off = g.IO.MouseClickedPos[0] - wheel_center;
|
|
ImVec2 current_off = g.IO.MousePos - wheel_center;
|
|
float initial_dist2 = ImLengthSqr(initial_off);
|
|
if (initial_dist2 >= (wheel_r_inner-1)*(wheel_r_inner-1) && initial_dist2 <= (wheel_r_outer+1)*(wheel_r_outer+1))
|
|
{
|
|
// Interactive with Hue wheel
|
|
H = atan2f(current_off.y, current_off.x) / IM_PI*0.5f;
|
|
if (H < 0.0f)
|
|
H += 1.0f;
|
|
value_changed = value_changed_h = true;
|
|
}
|
|
float cos_hue_angle = cosf(-H * 2.0f * IM_PI);
|
|
float sin_hue_angle = sinf(-H * 2.0f * IM_PI);
|
|
if (ImTriangleContainsPoint(triangle_pa, triangle_pb, triangle_pc, ImRotate(initial_off, cos_hue_angle, sin_hue_angle)))
|
|
{
|
|
// Interacting with SV triangle
|
|
ImVec2 current_off_unrotated = ImRotate(current_off, cos_hue_angle, sin_hue_angle);
|
|
if (!ImTriangleContainsPoint(triangle_pa, triangle_pb, triangle_pc, current_off_unrotated))
|
|
current_off_unrotated = ImTriangleClosestPoint(triangle_pa, triangle_pb, triangle_pc, current_off_unrotated);
|
|
float uu, vv, ww;
|
|
ImTriangleBarycentricCoords(triangle_pa, triangle_pb, triangle_pc, current_off_unrotated, uu, vv, ww);
|
|
V = ImClamp(1.0f - vv, 0.0001f, 1.0f);
|
|
S = ImClamp(uu / V, 0.0001f, 1.0f);
|
|
value_changed = value_changed_sv = true;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions))
|
|
OpenPopupOnItemClick("context");
|
|
}
|
|
else if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueBar)
|
|
{
|
|
// SV rectangle logic
|
|
InvisibleButton("sv", ImVec2(sv_picker_size, sv_picker_size));
|
|
if (IsItemActive())
|
|
{
|
|
S = ImSaturate((io.MousePos.x - picker_pos.x) / (sv_picker_size-1));
|
|
V = 1.0f - ImSaturate((io.MousePos.y - picker_pos.y) / (sv_picker_size-1));
|
|
value_changed = value_changed_sv = true;
|
|
}
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions))
|
|
OpenPopupOnItemClick("context");
|
|
|
|
// Hue bar logic
|
|
SetCursorScreenPos(ImVec2(bar0_pos_x, picker_pos.y));
|
|
InvisibleButton("hue", ImVec2(bars_width, sv_picker_size));
|
|
if (IsItemActive())
|
|
{
|
|
H = ImSaturate((io.MousePos.y - picker_pos.y) / (sv_picker_size-1));
|
|
value_changed = value_changed_h = true;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Alpha bar logic
|
|
if (alpha_bar)
|
|
{
|
|
SetCursorScreenPos(ImVec2(bar1_pos_x, picker_pos.y));
|
|
InvisibleButton("alpha", ImVec2(bars_width, sv_picker_size));
|
|
if (IsItemActive())
|
|
{
|
|
col[3] = 1.0f - ImSaturate((io.MousePos.y - picker_pos.y) / (sv_picker_size-1));
|
|
value_changed = true;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSidePreview))
|
|
{
|
|
SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
|
|
BeginGroup();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoLabel))
|
|
{
|
|
const char* label_display_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(label);
|
|
if (label != label_display_end)
|
|
{
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSidePreview))
|
|
SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
|
|
TextUnformatted(label, label_display_end);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSidePreview))
|
|
{
|
|
ImVec4 col_v4(col[0], col[1], col[2], (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) ? 1.0f : col[3]);
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoLabel))
|
|
Text("Current");
|
|
ColorButton("##current", col_v4, (flags & (ImGuiColorEditFlags_HDR|ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreview|ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf|ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoTooltip)), ImVec2(square_sz * 3, square_sz * 2));
|
|
if (ref_col != NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
Text("Original");
|
|
ImVec4 ref_col_v4(ref_col[0], ref_col[1], ref_col[2], (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) ? 1.0f : ref_col[3]);
|
|
if (ColorButton("##original", ref_col_v4, (flags & (ImGuiColorEditFlags_HDR|ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreview|ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf|ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoTooltip)), ImVec2(square_sz * 3, square_sz * 2)))
|
|
{
|
|
memcpy(col, ref_col, ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) ? 3 : 4) * sizeof(float));
|
|
value_changed = true;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
EndGroup();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Convert back color to RGB
|
|
if (value_changed_h || value_changed_sv)
|
|
ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(H >= 1.0f ? H - 10 * 1e-6f : H, S > 0.0f ? S : 10*1e-6f, V > 0.0f ? V : 1e-6f, col[0], col[1], col[2]);
|
|
|
|
// R,G,B and H,S,V slider color editor
|
|
if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoInputs) == 0)
|
|
{
|
|
PushItemWidth((alpha_bar ? bar1_pos_x : bar0_pos_x) + bars_width - picker_pos.x);
|
|
ImGuiColorEditFlags sub_flags_to_forward = ImGuiColorEditFlags__DataTypeMask | ImGuiColorEditFlags_HDR | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSmallPreview | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreview | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf;
|
|
ImGuiColorEditFlags sub_flags = (flags & sub_flags_to_forward) | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoPicker;
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_RGB || (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputsMask) == 0)
|
|
value_changed |= ColorEdit4("##rgb", col, sub_flags | ImGuiColorEditFlags_RGB);
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_HSV || (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputsMask) == 0)
|
|
value_changed |= ColorEdit4("##hsv", col, sub_flags | ImGuiColorEditFlags_HSV);
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_HEX || (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputsMask) == 0)
|
|
value_changed |= ColorEdit4("##hex", col, sub_flags | ImGuiColorEditFlags_HEX);
|
|
PopItemWidth();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Try to cancel hue wrap (after ColorEdit), if any
|
|
if (value_changed)
|
|
{
|
|
float new_H, new_S, new_V;
|
|
ColorConvertRGBtoHSV(col[0], col[1], col[2], new_H, new_S, new_V);
|
|
if (new_H <= 0 && H > 0)
|
|
{
|
|
if (new_V <= 0 && V != new_V)
|
|
ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(H, S, new_V <= 0 ? V * 0.5f : new_V, col[0], col[1], col[2]);
|
|
else if (new_S <= 0)
|
|
ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(H, new_S <= 0 ? S * 0.5f : new_S, new_V, col[0], col[1], col[2]);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ImVec4 hue_color_f(1, 1, 1, 1); ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(H, 1, 1, hue_color_f.x, hue_color_f.y, hue_color_f.z);
|
|
ImU32 hue_color32 = ColorConvertFloat4ToU32(hue_color_f);
|
|
ImU32 col32_no_alpha = ColorConvertFloat4ToU32(ImVec4(col[0], col[1], col[2], 1.0f));
|
|
|
|
const ImU32 hue_colors[6+1] = { IM_COL32(255,0,0,255), IM_COL32(255,255,0,255), IM_COL32(0,255,0,255), IM_COL32(0,255,255,255), IM_COL32(0,0,255,255), IM_COL32(255,0,255,255), IM_COL32(255,0,0,255) };
|
|
ImVec2 sv_cursor_pos;
|
|
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueWheel)
|
|
{
|
|
// Render Hue Wheel
|
|
const float aeps = 1.5f / wheel_r_outer; // Half a pixel arc length in radians (2pi cancels out).
|
|
const int segment_per_arc = ImMax(4, (int)wheel_r_outer / 12);
|
|
for (int n = 0; n < 6; n++)
|
|
{
|
|
const float a0 = (n) /6.0f * 2.0f * IM_PI - aeps;
|
|
const float a1 = (n+1.0f)/6.0f * 2.0f * IM_PI + aeps;
|
|
const int vert_start_idx = draw_list->VtxBuffer.Size;
|
|
draw_list->PathArcTo(wheel_center, (wheel_r_inner + wheel_r_outer)*0.5f, a0, a1, segment_per_arc);
|
|
draw_list->PathStroke(IM_COL32_WHITE, false, wheel_thickness);
|
|
const int vert_end_idx = draw_list->VtxBuffer.Size;
|
|
|
|
// Paint colors over existing vertices
|
|
ImVec2 gradient_p0(wheel_center.x + cosf(a0) * wheel_r_inner, wheel_center.y + sinf(a0) * wheel_r_inner);
|
|
ImVec2 gradient_p1(wheel_center.x + cosf(a1) * wheel_r_inner, wheel_center.y + sinf(a1) * wheel_r_inner);
|
|
ShadeVertsLinearColorGradientKeepAlpha(draw_list->VtxBuffer.Data + vert_start_idx, draw_list->VtxBuffer.Data + vert_end_idx, gradient_p0, gradient_p1, hue_colors[n], hue_colors[n+1]);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Render Cursor + preview on Hue Wheel
|
|
float cos_hue_angle = cosf(H * 2.0f * IM_PI);
|
|
float sin_hue_angle = sinf(H * 2.0f * IM_PI);
|
|
ImVec2 hue_cursor_pos(wheel_center.x + cos_hue_angle * (wheel_r_inner+wheel_r_outer)*0.5f, wheel_center.y + sin_hue_angle * (wheel_r_inner+wheel_r_outer)*0.5f);
|
|
float hue_cursor_rad = value_changed_h ? wheel_thickness * 0.65f : wheel_thickness * 0.55f;
|
|
int hue_cursor_segments = ImClamp((int)(hue_cursor_rad / 1.4f), 9, 32);
|
|
draw_list->AddCircleFilled(hue_cursor_pos, hue_cursor_rad, hue_color32, hue_cursor_segments);
|
|
draw_list->AddCircle(hue_cursor_pos, hue_cursor_rad+1, IM_COL32(128,128,128,255), hue_cursor_segments);
|
|
draw_list->AddCircle(hue_cursor_pos, hue_cursor_rad, IM_COL32_WHITE, hue_cursor_segments);
|
|
|
|
// Render SV triangle (rotated according to hue)
|
|
ImVec2 tra = wheel_center + ImRotate(triangle_pa, cos_hue_angle, sin_hue_angle);
|
|
ImVec2 trb = wheel_center + ImRotate(triangle_pb, cos_hue_angle, sin_hue_angle);
|
|
ImVec2 trc = wheel_center + ImRotate(triangle_pc, cos_hue_angle, sin_hue_angle);
|
|
ImVec2 uv_white = g.FontTexUvWhitePixel;
|
|
draw_list->PrimReserve(6, 6);
|
|
draw_list->PrimVtx(tra, uv_white, hue_color32);
|
|
draw_list->PrimVtx(trb, uv_white, hue_color32);
|
|
draw_list->PrimVtx(trc, uv_white, IM_COL32_WHITE);
|
|
draw_list->PrimVtx(tra, uv_white, IM_COL32_BLACK_TRANS);
|
|
draw_list->PrimVtx(trb, uv_white, IM_COL32_BLACK);
|
|
draw_list->PrimVtx(trc, uv_white, IM_COL32_BLACK_TRANS);
|
|
draw_list->AddTriangle(tra, trb, trc, IM_COL32(128,128,128,255), 1.5f);
|
|
sv_cursor_pos = ImLerp(ImLerp(trc, tra, ImSaturate(S)), trb, ImSaturate(1 - V));
|
|
}
|
|
else if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueBar)
|
|
{
|
|
// Render SV Square
|
|
draw_list->AddRectFilledMultiColor(picker_pos, picker_pos + ImVec2(sv_picker_size,sv_picker_size), IM_COL32_WHITE, hue_color32, hue_color32, IM_COL32_WHITE);
|
|
draw_list->AddRectFilledMultiColor(picker_pos, picker_pos + ImVec2(sv_picker_size,sv_picker_size), IM_COL32_BLACK_TRANS, IM_COL32_BLACK_TRANS, IM_COL32_BLACK, IM_COL32_BLACK);
|
|
RenderFrameBorder(picker_pos, picker_pos + ImVec2(sv_picker_size,sv_picker_size), 0.0f);
|
|
sv_cursor_pos.x = ImClamp((float)(int)(picker_pos.x + ImSaturate(S) * sv_picker_size + 0.5f), picker_pos.x + 2, picker_pos.x + sv_picker_size - 2); // Sneakily prevent the circle to stick out too much
|
|
sv_cursor_pos.y = ImClamp((float)(int)(picker_pos.y + ImSaturate(1 - V) * sv_picker_size + 0.5f), picker_pos.y + 2, picker_pos.y + sv_picker_size - 2);
|
|
|
|
// Render Hue Bar
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < 6; ++i)
|
|
draw_list->AddRectFilledMultiColor(ImVec2(bar0_pos_x, picker_pos.y + i * (sv_picker_size / 6)), ImVec2(bar0_pos_x + bars_width, picker_pos.y + (i + 1) * (sv_picker_size / 6)), hue_colors[i], hue_colors[i], hue_colors[i + 1], hue_colors[i + 1]);
|
|
float bar0_line_y = (float)(int)(picker_pos.y + H * sv_picker_size + 0.5f);
|
|
RenderFrameBorder(ImVec2(bar0_pos_x, picker_pos.y), ImVec2(bar0_pos_x + bars_width, picker_pos.y + sv_picker_size), 0.0f);
|
|
RenderArrowsForVerticalBar(draw_list, ImVec2(bar0_pos_x - 1, bar0_line_y), ImVec2(bars_triangles_half_sz + 1, bars_triangles_half_sz), bars_width + 2.0f);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Render cursor/preview circle (clamp S/V within 0..1 range because floating points colors may lead HSV values to be out of range)
|
|
float sv_cursor_rad = value_changed_sv ? 10.0f : 6.0f;
|
|
draw_list->AddCircleFilled(sv_cursor_pos, sv_cursor_rad, col32_no_alpha, 12);
|
|
draw_list->AddCircle(sv_cursor_pos, sv_cursor_rad+1, IM_COL32(128,128,128,255), 12);
|
|
draw_list->AddCircle(sv_cursor_pos, sv_cursor_rad, IM_COL32_WHITE, 12);
|
|
|
|
// Render alpha bar
|
|
if (alpha_bar)
|
|
{
|
|
float alpha = ImSaturate(col[3]);
|
|
ImRect bar1_bb(bar1_pos_x, picker_pos.y, bar1_pos_x + bars_width, picker_pos.y + sv_picker_size);
|
|
RenderColorRectWithAlphaCheckerboard(bar1_bb.Min, bar1_bb.Max, IM_COL32(0,0,0,0), bar1_bb.GetWidth() / 2.0f, ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f));
|
|
draw_list->AddRectFilledMultiColor(bar1_bb.Min, bar1_bb.Max, col32_no_alpha, col32_no_alpha, col32_no_alpha & ~IM_COL32_A_MASK, col32_no_alpha & ~IM_COL32_A_MASK);
|
|
float bar1_line_y = (float)(int)(picker_pos.y + (1.0f - alpha) * sv_picker_size + 0.5f);
|
|
RenderFrameBorder(bar1_bb.Min, bar1_bb.Max, 0.0f);
|
|
RenderArrowsForVerticalBar(draw_list, ImVec2(bar1_pos_x - 1, bar1_line_y), ImVec2(bars_triangles_half_sz + 1, bars_triangles_half_sz), bars_width + 2.0f);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
EndGroup();
|
|
PopID();
|
|
|
|
return value_changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Horizontal separating line.
|
|
void ImGui::Separator()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return;
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiWindowFlags flags = 0;
|
|
if ((flags & (ImGuiSeparatorFlags_Horizontal | ImGuiSeparatorFlags_Vertical)) == 0)
|
|
flags |= (window->DC.LayoutType == ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal) ? ImGuiSeparatorFlags_Vertical : ImGuiSeparatorFlags_Horizontal;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo((int)(flags & (ImGuiSeparatorFlags_Horizontal | ImGuiSeparatorFlags_Vertical)))); // Check that only 1 option is selected
|
|
if (flags & ImGuiSeparatorFlags_Vertical)
|
|
{
|
|
VerticalSeparator();
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Horizontal Separator
|
|
if (window->DC.ColumnsCount > 1)
|
|
PopClipRect();
|
|
|
|
float x1 = window->Pos.x;
|
|
float x2 = window->Pos.x + window->Size.x;
|
|
if (!window->DC.GroupStack.empty())
|
|
x1 += window->DC.IndentX;
|
|
|
|
const ImRect bb(ImVec2(x1, window->DC.CursorPos.y), ImVec2(x2, window->DC.CursorPos.y+1.0f));
|
|
ItemSize(ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f)); // NB: we don't provide our width so that it doesn't get feed back into AutoFit, we don't provide height to not alter layout.
|
|
if (!ItemAdd(bb, 0))
|
|
{
|
|
if (window->DC.ColumnsCount > 1)
|
|
PushColumnClipRect();
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
window->DrawList->AddLine(bb.Min, ImVec2(bb.Max.x,bb.Min.y), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Separator));
|
|
|
|
if (g.LogEnabled)
|
|
LogRenderedText(NULL, IM_NEWLINE "--------------------------------");
|
|
|
|
if (window->DC.ColumnsCount > 1)
|
|
{
|
|
PushColumnClipRect();
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsCellMinY = window->DC.CursorPos.y;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::VerticalSeparator()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return;
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
|
|
float y1 = window->DC.CursorPos.y;
|
|
float y2 = window->DC.CursorPos.y + window->DC.CurrentLineHeight;
|
|
const ImRect bb(ImVec2(window->DC.CursorPos.x, y1), ImVec2(window->DC.CursorPos.x + 1.0f, y2));
|
|
ItemSize(ImVec2(bb.GetWidth(), 0.0f));
|
|
if (!ItemAdd(bb, 0))
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
window->DrawList->AddLine(ImVec2(bb.Min.x, bb.Min.y), ImVec2(bb.Min.x, bb.Max.y), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Separator));
|
|
if (g.LogEnabled)
|
|
LogText(" |");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::SplitterBehavior(ImGuiID id, const ImRect& bb, ImGuiAxis axis, float* size1, float* size2, float min_size1, float min_size2, float hover_extend)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
|
|
const ImGuiItemFlags item_flags_backup = window->DC.ItemFlags;
|
|
#ifdef IMGUI_HAS_NAV
|
|
window->DC.ItemFlags |= ImGuiItemFlags_NoNav | ImGuiItemFlags_NoNavDefaultFocus;
|
|
#endif
|
|
bool add = ItemAdd(bb, id);
|
|
window->DC.ItemFlags = item_flags_backup;
|
|
if (!add)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
bool hovered, held;
|
|
ImRect bb_interact = bb;
|
|
bb_interact.Expand(axis == ImGuiAxis_Y ? ImVec2(0.0f, hover_extend) : ImVec2(hover_extend, 0.0f));
|
|
ButtonBehavior(bb_interact, id, &hovered, &held, ImGuiButtonFlags_FlattenChilds | ImGuiButtonFlags_AllowOverlapMode);
|
|
if (g.ActiveId != id)
|
|
SetItemAllowOverlap();
|
|
|
|
if (held || (g.HoveredId == id && g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame == id))
|
|
SetMouseCursor(axis == ImGuiAxis_Y ? ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNS : ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeEW);
|
|
|
|
ImRect bb_render = bb;
|
|
if (held)
|
|
{
|
|
ImVec2 mouse_delta_2d = g.IO.MousePos - g.ActiveIdClickOffset - bb_interact.Min;
|
|
float mouse_delta = (axis == ImGuiAxis_Y) ? mouse_delta_2d.y : mouse_delta_2d.x;
|
|
|
|
// Minimum pane size
|
|
if (mouse_delta < min_size1 - *size1)
|
|
mouse_delta = min_size1 - *size1;
|
|
if (mouse_delta > *size2 - min_size2)
|
|
mouse_delta = *size2 - min_size2;
|
|
|
|
// Apply resize
|
|
*size1 += mouse_delta;
|
|
*size2 -= mouse_delta;
|
|
bb_render.Translate((axis == ImGuiAxis_X) ? ImVec2(mouse_delta, 0.0f) : ImVec2(0.0f, mouse_delta));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Render
|
|
const ImU32 col = GetColorU32(held ? ImGuiCol_SeparatorActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_SeparatorHovered : ImGuiCol_Separator);
|
|
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(bb_render.Min, bb_render.Max, col, g.Style.FrameRounding);
|
|
|
|
return held;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::Spacing()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return;
|
|
ItemSize(ImVec2(0,0));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::Dummy(const ImVec2& size)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
const ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size);
|
|
ItemSize(bb);
|
|
ItemAdd(bb, 0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::IsRectVisible(const ImVec2& size)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
return window->ClipRect.Overlaps(ImRect(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool ImGui::IsRectVisible(const ImVec2& rect_min, const ImVec2& rect_max)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
return window->ClipRect.Overlaps(ImRect(rect_min, rect_max));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Lock horizontal starting position + capture group bounding box into one "item" (so you can use IsItemHovered() or layout primitives such as SameLine() on whole group, etc.)
|
|
void ImGui::BeginGroup()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
|
|
window->DC.GroupStack.resize(window->DC.GroupStack.Size + 1);
|
|
ImGuiGroupData& group_data = window->DC.GroupStack.back();
|
|
group_data.BackupCursorPos = window->DC.CursorPos;
|
|
group_data.BackupCursorMaxPos = window->DC.CursorMaxPos;
|
|
group_data.BackupIndentX = window->DC.IndentX;
|
|
group_data.BackupGroupOffsetX = window->DC.GroupOffsetX;
|
|
group_data.BackupCurrentLineHeight = window->DC.CurrentLineHeight;
|
|
group_data.BackupCurrentLineTextBaseOffset = window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset;
|
|
group_data.BackupLogLinePosY = window->DC.LogLinePosY;
|
|
group_data.BackupActiveIdIsAlive = GImGui->ActiveIdIsAlive;
|
|
group_data.AdvanceCursor = true;
|
|
|
|
window->DC.GroupOffsetX = window->DC.CursorPos.x - window->Pos.x - window->DC.ColumnsOffsetX;
|
|
window->DC.IndentX = window->DC.GroupOffsetX;
|
|
window->DC.CursorMaxPos = window->DC.CursorPos;
|
|
window->DC.CurrentLineHeight = 0.0f;
|
|
window->DC.LogLinePosY = window->DC.CursorPos.y - 9999.0f;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::EndGroup()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
|
|
IM_ASSERT(!window->DC.GroupStack.empty()); // Mismatched BeginGroup()/EndGroup() calls
|
|
|
|
ImGuiGroupData& group_data = window->DC.GroupStack.back();
|
|
|
|
ImRect group_bb(group_data.BackupCursorPos, window->DC.CursorMaxPos);
|
|
group_bb.Max = ImMax(group_bb.Min, group_bb.Max);
|
|
|
|
window->DC.CursorPos = group_data.BackupCursorPos;
|
|
window->DC.CursorMaxPos = ImMax(group_data.BackupCursorMaxPos, window->DC.CursorMaxPos);
|
|
window->DC.CurrentLineHeight = group_data.BackupCurrentLineHeight;
|
|
window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset = group_data.BackupCurrentLineTextBaseOffset;
|
|
window->DC.IndentX = group_data.BackupIndentX;
|
|
window->DC.GroupOffsetX = group_data.BackupGroupOffsetX;
|
|
window->DC.LogLinePosY = window->DC.CursorPos.y - 9999.0f;
|
|
|
|
if (group_data.AdvanceCursor)
|
|
{
|
|
window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset = ImMax(window->DC.PrevLineTextBaseOffset, group_data.BackupCurrentLineTextBaseOffset); // FIXME: Incorrect, we should grab the base offset from the *first line* of the group but it is hard to obtain now.
|
|
ItemSize(group_bb.GetSize(), group_data.BackupCurrentLineTextBaseOffset);
|
|
ItemAdd(group_bb, 0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If the current ActiveId was declared within the boundary of our group, we copy it to LastItemId so IsItemActive() will be functional on the entire group.
|
|
// It would be be neater if we replaced window.DC.LastItemId by e.g. 'bool LastItemIsActive', but if you search for LastItemId you'll notice it is only used in that context.
|
|
const bool active_id_within_group = (!group_data.BackupActiveIdIsAlive && g.ActiveIdIsAlive && g.ActiveId && g.ActiveIdWindow->RootWindow == window->RootWindow);
|
|
if (active_id_within_group)
|
|
window->DC.LastItemId = g.ActiveId;
|
|
window->DC.LastItemRect = group_bb;
|
|
|
|
window->DC.GroupStack.pop_back();
|
|
|
|
//window->DrawList->AddRect(group_bb.Min, group_bb.Max, IM_COL32(255,0,255,255)); // [Debug]
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Gets back to previous line and continue with horizontal layout
|
|
// pos_x == 0 : follow right after previous item
|
|
// pos_x != 0 : align to specified x position (relative to window/group left)
|
|
// spacing_w < 0 : use default spacing if pos_x == 0, no spacing if pos_x != 0
|
|
// spacing_w >= 0 : enforce spacing amount
|
|
void ImGui::SameLine(float pos_x, float spacing_w)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
if (pos_x != 0.0f)
|
|
{
|
|
if (spacing_w < 0.0f) spacing_w = 0.0f;
|
|
window->DC.CursorPos.x = window->Pos.x - window->Scroll.x + pos_x + spacing_w + window->DC.GroupOffsetX + window->DC.ColumnsOffsetX;
|
|
window->DC.CursorPos.y = window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine.y;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if (spacing_w < 0.0f) spacing_w = g.Style.ItemSpacing.x;
|
|
window->DC.CursorPos.x = window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine.x + spacing_w;
|
|
window->DC.CursorPos.y = window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine.y;
|
|
}
|
|
window->DC.CurrentLineHeight = window->DC.PrevLineHeight;
|
|
window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset = window->DC.PrevLineTextBaseOffset;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::NewLine()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const ImGuiLayoutType backup_layout_type = window->DC.LayoutType;
|
|
window->DC.LayoutType = ImGuiLayoutType_Vertical;
|
|
if (window->DC.CurrentLineHeight > 0.0f) // In the event that we are on a line with items that is smaller that FontSize high, we will preserve its height.
|
|
ItemSize(ImVec2(0,0));
|
|
else
|
|
ItemSize(ImVec2(0.0f, g.FontSize));
|
|
window->DC.LayoutType = backup_layout_type;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::NextColumn()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (window->SkipItems || window->DC.ColumnsCount <= 1)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
PopItemWidth();
|
|
PopClipRect();
|
|
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsCellMaxY = ImMax(window->DC.ColumnsCellMaxY, window->DC.CursorPos.y);
|
|
if (++window->DC.ColumnsCurrent < window->DC.ColumnsCount)
|
|
{
|
|
// Columns 1+ cancel out IndentX
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsOffsetX = GetColumnOffset(window->DC.ColumnsCurrent) - window->DC.IndentX + g.Style.ItemSpacing.x;
|
|
window->DrawList->ChannelsSetCurrent(window->DC.ColumnsCurrent);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsCurrent = 0;
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsOffsetX = 0.0f;
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsCellMinY = window->DC.ColumnsCellMaxY;
|
|
window->DrawList->ChannelsSetCurrent(0);
|
|
}
|
|
window->DC.CursorPos.x = (float)(int)(window->Pos.x + window->DC.IndentX + window->DC.ColumnsOffsetX);
|
|
window->DC.CursorPos.y = window->DC.ColumnsCellMinY;
|
|
window->DC.CurrentLineHeight = 0.0f;
|
|
window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset = 0.0f;
|
|
|
|
PushColumnClipRect();
|
|
PushItemWidth(GetColumnWidth() * 0.65f); // FIXME: Move on columns setup
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
int ImGui::GetColumnIndex()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
return window->DC.ColumnsCurrent;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
int ImGui::GetColumnsCount()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
return window->DC.ColumnsCount;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static float OffsetNormToPixels(ImGuiWindow* window, float offset_norm)
|
|
{
|
|
return offset_norm * (window->DC.ColumnsMaxX - window->DC.ColumnsMinX);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static float PixelsToOffsetNorm(ImGuiWindow* window, float offset)
|
|
{
|
|
return (offset - window->DC.ColumnsMinX) / (window->DC.ColumnsMaxX - window->DC.ColumnsMinX);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static float GetDraggedColumnOffset(int column_index)
|
|
{
|
|
// Active (dragged) column always follow mouse. The reason we need this is that dragging a column to the right edge of an auto-resizing
|
|
// window creates a feedback loop because we store normalized positions. So while dragging we enforce absolute positioning.
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
|
|
IM_ASSERT(column_index > 0); // We cannot drag column 0. If you get this assert you may have a conflict between the ID of your columns and another widgets.
|
|
IM_ASSERT(g.ActiveId == window->DC.ColumnsSetId + ImGuiID(column_index));
|
|
|
|
float x = g.IO.MousePos.x - g.ActiveIdClickOffset.x - window->Pos.x;
|
|
x = ImMax(x, ImGui::GetColumnOffset(column_index-1) + g.Style.ColumnsMinSpacing);
|
|
if ((window->DC.ColumnsFlags & ImGuiColumnsFlags_NoPreserveWidths))
|
|
x = ImMin(x, ImGui::GetColumnOffset(column_index+1) - g.Style.ColumnsMinSpacing);
|
|
|
|
return x;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
float ImGui::GetColumnOffset(int column_index)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
if (column_index < 0)
|
|
column_index = window->DC.ColumnsCurrent;
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
if (g.ActiveId)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
const ImGuiID column_id = window->DC.ColumnsSetId + ImGuiID(column_index);
|
|
if (g.ActiveId == column_id)
|
|
return GetDraggedColumnOffset(column_index);
|
|
}
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
IM_ASSERT(column_index < window->DC.ColumnsData.Size);
|
|
const float t = window->DC.ColumnsData[column_index].OffsetNorm;
|
|
const float x_offset = ImLerp(window->DC.ColumnsMinX, window->DC.ColumnsMaxX, t);
|
|
return x_offset;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetColumnOffset(int column_index, float offset)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
if (column_index < 0)
|
|
column_index = window->DC.ColumnsCurrent;
|
|
|
|
IM_ASSERT(column_index < window->DC.ColumnsData.Size);
|
|
|
|
const bool preserve_width = !(window->DC.ColumnsFlags & ImGuiColumnsFlags_NoPreserveWidths) && (column_index < window->DC.ColumnsCount-1);
|
|
const float width = preserve_width ? GetColumnWidth(column_index) : 0.0f;
|
|
|
|
if (!(window->DC.ColumnsFlags & ImGuiColumnsFlags_NoForceWithinWindow))
|
|
offset = ImMin(offset, window->DC.ColumnsMaxX - g.Style.ColumnsMinSpacing * (window->DC.ColumnsCount - column_index));
|
|
const float offset_norm = PixelsToOffsetNorm(window, offset);
|
|
|
|
const ImGuiID column_id = window->DC.ColumnsSetId + ImGuiID(column_index);
|
|
window->DC.StateStorage->SetFloat(column_id, offset_norm);
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsData[column_index].OffsetNorm = offset_norm;
|
|
|
|
if (preserve_width)
|
|
SetColumnOffset(column_index + 1, offset + ImMax(g.Style.ColumnsMinSpacing, width));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
float ImGui::GetColumnWidth(int column_index)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
if (column_index < 0)
|
|
column_index = window->DC.ColumnsCurrent;
|
|
|
|
return OffsetNormToPixels(window, window->DC.ColumnsData[column_index+1].OffsetNorm - window->DC.ColumnsData[column_index].OffsetNorm);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::SetColumnWidth(int column_index, float width)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
if (column_index < 0)
|
|
column_index = window->DC.ColumnsCurrent;
|
|
|
|
SetColumnOffset(column_index+1, GetColumnOffset(column_index) + width);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::PushColumnClipRect(int column_index)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
|
|
if (column_index < 0)
|
|
column_index = window->DC.ColumnsCurrent;
|
|
|
|
PushClipRect(window->DC.ColumnsData[column_index].ClipRect.Min, window->DC.ColumnsData[column_index].ClipRect.Max, false);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::BeginColumns(const char* id, int columns_count, ImGuiColumnsFlags flags)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
|
|
IM_ASSERT(columns_count > 1);
|
|
IM_ASSERT(window->DC.ColumnsCount == 1); // Nested columns are currently not supported
|
|
|
|
// Differentiate column ID with an arbitrary prefix for cases where users name their columns set the same as another widget.
|
|
// In addition, when an identifier isn't explicitly provided we include the number of columns in the hash to make it uniquer.
|
|
PushID(0x11223347 + (id ? 0 : columns_count));
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsSetId = window->GetID(id ? id : "columns");
|
|
PopID();
|
|
|
|
// Set state for first column
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsCurrent = 0;
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsCount = columns_count;
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsFlags = flags;
|
|
|
|
const float content_region_width = (window->SizeContentsExplicit.x != 0.0f) ? (window->SizeContentsExplicit.x) : (window->Size.x -window->ScrollbarSizes.x);
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsMinX = window->DC.IndentX - g.Style.ItemSpacing.x; // Lock our horizontal range
|
|
//window->DC.ColumnsMaxX = content_region_width - window->Scroll.x -((window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar) ? 0 : g.Style.ScrollbarSize);// - window->WindowPadding().x;
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsMaxX = content_region_width - window->Scroll.x;
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsStartPosY = window->DC.CursorPos.y;
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsStartMaxPosX = window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x;
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsCellMinY = window->DC.ColumnsCellMaxY = window->DC.CursorPos.y;
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsOffsetX = 0.0f;
|
|
window->DC.CursorPos.x = (float)(int)(window->Pos.x + window->DC.IndentX + window->DC.ColumnsOffsetX);
|
|
|
|
// Cache column offsets
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsData.resize(columns_count + 1);
|
|
for (int column_index = 0; column_index < columns_count + 1; column_index++)
|
|
{
|
|
const ImGuiID column_id = window->DC.ColumnsSetId + ImGuiID(column_index);
|
|
KeepAliveID(column_id);
|
|
const float default_t = column_index / (float)window->DC.ColumnsCount;
|
|
float t = window->DC.StateStorage->GetFloat(column_id, default_t);
|
|
if (!(window->DC.ColumnsFlags & ImGuiColumnsFlags_NoForceWithinWindow))
|
|
t = ImMin(t, PixelsToOffsetNorm(window, window->DC.ColumnsMaxX - g.Style.ColumnsMinSpacing * (window->DC.ColumnsCount - column_index)));
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsData[column_index].OffsetNorm = t;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Cache clipping rectangles
|
|
for (int column_index = 0; column_index < columns_count; column_index++)
|
|
{
|
|
float clip_x1 = ImFloor(0.5f + window->Pos.x + GetColumnOffset(column_index) - 1.0f);
|
|
float clip_x2 = ImFloor(0.5f + window->Pos.x + GetColumnOffset(column_index + 1) - 1.0f);
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsData[column_index].ClipRect = ImRect(clip_x1, -FLT_MAX, clip_x2, +FLT_MAX);
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsData[column_index].ClipRect.ClipWith(window->ClipRect);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
window->DrawList->ChannelsSplit(window->DC.ColumnsCount);
|
|
PushColumnClipRect();
|
|
PushItemWidth(GetColumnWidth() * 0.65f);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::EndColumns()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
IM_ASSERT(window->DC.ColumnsCount > 1);
|
|
|
|
PopItemWidth();
|
|
PopClipRect();
|
|
window->DrawList->ChannelsMerge();
|
|
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsCellMaxY = ImMax(window->DC.ColumnsCellMaxY, window->DC.CursorPos.y);
|
|
window->DC.CursorPos.y = window->DC.ColumnsCellMaxY;
|
|
if (!(window->DC.ColumnsFlags & ImGuiColumnsFlags_GrowParentContentsSize))
|
|
window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x = ImMax(window->DC.ColumnsStartMaxPosX, window->DC.ColumnsMaxX); // Restore cursor max pos, as columns don't grow parent
|
|
|
|
// Draw columns borders and handle resize
|
|
if (!(window->DC.ColumnsFlags & ImGuiColumnsFlags_NoBorder) && !window->SkipItems)
|
|
{
|
|
const float y1 = window->DC.ColumnsStartPosY;
|
|
const float y2 = window->DC.CursorPos.y;
|
|
int dragging_column = -1;
|
|
for (int i = 1; i < window->DC.ColumnsCount; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
float x = window->Pos.x + GetColumnOffset(i);
|
|
const ImGuiID column_id = window->DC.ColumnsSetId + ImGuiID(i);
|
|
const float column_hw = 4.0f; // Half-width for interaction
|
|
const ImRect column_rect(ImVec2(x - column_hw, y1), ImVec2(x + column_hw, y2));
|
|
if (IsClippedEx(column_rect, column_id, false))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
bool hovered = false, held = false;
|
|
if (!(window->DC.ColumnsFlags & ImGuiColumnsFlags_NoResize))
|
|
{
|
|
ButtonBehavior(column_rect, column_id, &hovered, &held);
|
|
if (hovered || held)
|
|
g.MouseCursor = ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeEW;
|
|
if (held && g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated)
|
|
g.ActiveIdClickOffset.x -= column_hw; // Store from center of column line (we used a 8 wide rect for columns clicking). This is used by GetDraggedColumnOffset().
|
|
if (held)
|
|
dragging_column = i;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Draw column
|
|
// We clip the Y boundaries CPU side because very long triangles are mishandled by some GPU drivers.
|
|
const ImU32 col = GetColorU32(held ? ImGuiCol_SeparatorActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_SeparatorHovered : ImGuiCol_Separator);
|
|
const float xi = (float)(int)x;
|
|
window->DrawList->AddLine(ImVec2(xi, ImMax(y1 + 1.0f, window->ClipRect.Min.y)), ImVec2(xi, ImMin(y2, window->ClipRect.Max.y)), col);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Apply dragging after drawing the column lines, so our rendered lines are in sync with how items were displayed during the frame.
|
|
if (dragging_column != -1)
|
|
{
|
|
float x = GetDraggedColumnOffset(dragging_column);
|
|
SetColumnOffset(dragging_column, x);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsSetId = 0;
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsCurrent = 0;
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsCount = 1;
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsFlags = 0;
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsData.resize(0);
|
|
window->DC.ColumnsOffsetX = 0.0f;
|
|
window->DC.CursorPos.x = (float)(int)(window->Pos.x + window->DC.IndentX + window->DC.ColumnsOffsetX);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// [2017/08: This is currently the only public API, while we are working on making BeginColumns/EndColumns user-facing]
|
|
void ImGui::Columns(int columns_count, const char* id, bool border)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
IM_ASSERT(columns_count >= 1);
|
|
|
|
if (window->DC.ColumnsCount != columns_count && window->DC.ColumnsCount != 1)
|
|
EndColumns();
|
|
|
|
ImGuiColumnsFlags flags = (border ? 0 : ImGuiColumnsFlags_NoBorder);
|
|
//flags |= ImGuiColumnsFlags_NoPreserveWidths; // NB: Legacy behavior
|
|
if (columns_count != 1)
|
|
BeginColumns(id, columns_count, flags);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::Indent(float indent_w)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
window->DC.IndentX += (indent_w != 0.0f) ? indent_w : g.Style.IndentSpacing;
|
|
window->DC.CursorPos.x = window->Pos.x + window->DC.IndentX + window->DC.ColumnsOffsetX;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::Unindent(float indent_w)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
window->DC.IndentX -= (indent_w != 0.0f) ? indent_w : g.Style.IndentSpacing;
|
|
window->DC.CursorPos.x = window->Pos.x + window->DC.IndentX + window->DC.ColumnsOffsetX;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::TreePush(const char* str_id)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
Indent();
|
|
window->DC.TreeDepth++;
|
|
PushID(str_id ? str_id : "#TreePush");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::TreePush(const void* ptr_id)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
Indent();
|
|
window->DC.TreeDepth++;
|
|
PushID(ptr_id ? ptr_id : (const void*)"#TreePush");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::TreePushRawID(ImGuiID id)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
Indent();
|
|
window->DC.TreeDepth++;
|
|
window->IDStack.push_back(id);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::TreePop()
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
|
|
Unindent();
|
|
window->DC.TreeDepth--;
|
|
PopID();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::Value(const char* prefix, bool b)
|
|
{
|
|
Text("%s: %s", prefix, (b ? "true" : "false"));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::Value(const char* prefix, int v)
|
|
{
|
|
Text("%s: %d", prefix, v);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::Value(const char* prefix, unsigned int v)
|
|
{
|
|
Text("%s: %d", prefix, v);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::Value(const char* prefix, float v, const char* float_format)
|
|
{
|
|
if (float_format)
|
|
{
|
|
char fmt[64];
|
|
ImFormatString(fmt, IM_ARRAYSIZE(fmt), "%%s: %s", float_format);
|
|
Text(fmt, prefix, v);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
Text("%s: %.3f", prefix, v);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
// PLATFORM DEPENDENT HELPERS
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
#if defined(_WIN32) && !defined(_WINDOWS_) && (!defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_CLIPBOARD_FUNCTIONS) || !defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_IME_FUNCTIONS))
|
|
#undef WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN
|
|
#define WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN
|
|
#include <windows.h>
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
// Win32 API clipboard implementation
|
|
#if defined(_WIN32) && !defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_CLIPBOARD_FUNCTIONS)
|
|
|
|
#ifdef _MSC_VER
|
|
#pragma comment(lib, "user32")
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
static const char* GetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl(void*)
|
|
{
|
|
static ImVector<char> buf_local;
|
|
buf_local.clear();
|
|
if (!OpenClipboard(NULL))
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
HANDLE wbuf_handle = GetClipboardData(CF_UNICODETEXT);
|
|
if (wbuf_handle == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
CloseClipboard();
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
if (ImWchar* wbuf_global = (ImWchar*)GlobalLock(wbuf_handle))
|
|
{
|
|
int buf_len = ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(wbuf_global, NULL) + 1;
|
|
buf_local.resize(buf_len);
|
|
ImTextStrToUtf8(buf_local.Data, buf_len, wbuf_global, NULL);
|
|
}
|
|
GlobalUnlock(wbuf_handle);
|
|
CloseClipboard();
|
|
return buf_local.Data;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void SetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl(void*, const char* text)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!OpenClipboard(NULL))
|
|
return;
|
|
const int wbuf_length = ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8(text, NULL) + 1;
|
|
HGLOBAL wbuf_handle = GlobalAlloc(GMEM_MOVEABLE, (SIZE_T)wbuf_length * sizeof(ImWchar));
|
|
if (wbuf_handle == NULL)
|
|
{
|
|
CloseClipboard();
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
ImWchar* wbuf_global = (ImWchar*)GlobalLock(wbuf_handle);
|
|
ImTextStrFromUtf8(wbuf_global, wbuf_length, text, NULL);
|
|
GlobalUnlock(wbuf_handle);
|
|
EmptyClipboard();
|
|
SetClipboardData(CF_UNICODETEXT, wbuf_handle);
|
|
CloseClipboard();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
// Local ImGui-only clipboard implementation, if user hasn't defined better clipboard handlers
|
|
static const char* GetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl(void*)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
return g.PrivateClipboard.empty() ? NULL : g.PrivateClipboard.begin();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Local ImGui-only clipboard implementation, if user hasn't defined better clipboard handlers
|
|
static void SetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl(void*, const char* text)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
|
|
g.PrivateClipboard.clear();
|
|
const char* text_end = text + strlen(text);
|
|
g.PrivateClipboard.resize((int)(text_end - text) + 1);
|
|
memcpy(&g.PrivateClipboard[0], text, (size_t)(text_end - text));
|
|
g.PrivateClipboard[(int)(text_end - text)] = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
// Win32 API IME support (for Asian languages, etc.)
|
|
#if defined(_WIN32) && !defined(__GNUC__) && !defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_IME_FUNCTIONS)
|
|
|
|
#include <imm.h>
|
|
#ifdef _MSC_VER
|
|
#pragma comment(lib, "imm32")
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
static void ImeSetInputScreenPosFn_DefaultImpl(int x, int y)
|
|
{
|
|
// Notify OS Input Method Editor of text input position
|
|
if (HWND hwnd = (HWND)GImGui->IO.ImeWindowHandle)
|
|
if (HIMC himc = ImmGetContext(hwnd))
|
|
{
|
|
COMPOSITIONFORM cf;
|
|
cf.ptCurrentPos.x = x;
|
|
cf.ptCurrentPos.y = y;
|
|
cf.dwStyle = CFS_FORCE_POSITION;
|
|
ImmSetCompositionWindow(himc, &cf);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
static void ImeSetInputScreenPosFn_DefaultImpl(int, int) {}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
// HELP
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
void ImGui::ShowMetricsWindow(bool* p_open)
|
|
{
|
|
if (ImGui::Begin("ImGui Metrics", p_open))
|
|
{
|
|
ImGui::Text("ImGui %s", ImGui::GetVersion());
|
|
ImGui::Text("Application average %.3f ms/frame (%.1f FPS)", 1000.0f / ImGui::GetIO().Framerate, ImGui::GetIO().Framerate);
|
|
ImGui::Text("%d vertices, %d indices (%d triangles)", ImGui::GetIO().MetricsRenderVertices, ImGui::GetIO().MetricsRenderIndices, ImGui::GetIO().MetricsRenderIndices / 3);
|
|
ImGui::Text("%d allocations", ImGui::GetIO().MetricsAllocs);
|
|
static bool show_clip_rects = true;
|
|
ImGui::Checkbox("Show clipping rectangles when hovering an ImDrawCmd", &show_clip_rects);
|
|
ImGui::Separator();
|
|
|
|
struct Funcs
|
|
{
|
|
static void NodeDrawList(ImDrawList* draw_list, const char* label)
|
|
{
|
|
bool node_open = ImGui::TreeNode(draw_list, "%s: '%s' %d vtx, %d indices, %d cmds", label, draw_list->_OwnerName ? draw_list->_OwnerName : "", draw_list->VtxBuffer.Size, draw_list->IdxBuffer.Size, draw_list->CmdBuffer.Size);
|
|
if (draw_list == ImGui::GetWindowDrawList())
|
|
{
|
|
ImGui::SameLine();
|
|
ImGui::TextColored(ImColor(255,100,100), "CURRENTLY APPENDING"); // Can't display stats for active draw list! (we don't have the data double-buffered)
|
|
if (node_open) ImGui::TreePop();
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
if (!node_open)
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
ImDrawList* overlay_draw_list = &GImGui->OverlayDrawList; // Render additional visuals into the top-most draw list
|
|
overlay_draw_list->PushClipRectFullScreen();
|
|
int elem_offset = 0;
|
|
for (const ImDrawCmd* pcmd = draw_list->CmdBuffer.begin(); pcmd < draw_list->CmdBuffer.end(); elem_offset += pcmd->ElemCount, pcmd++)
|
|
{
|
|
if (pcmd->UserCallback == NULL && pcmd->ElemCount == 0)
|
|
continue;
|
|
if (pcmd->UserCallback)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGui::BulletText("Callback %p, user_data %p", pcmd->UserCallback, pcmd->UserCallbackData);
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
ImDrawIdx* idx_buffer = (draw_list->IdxBuffer.Size > 0) ? draw_list->IdxBuffer.Data : NULL;
|
|
bool pcmd_node_open = ImGui::TreeNode((void*)(pcmd - draw_list->CmdBuffer.begin()), "Draw %-4d %s vtx, tex = %p, clip_rect = (%.0f,%.0f)..(%.0f,%.0f)", pcmd->ElemCount, draw_list->IdxBuffer.Size > 0 ? "indexed" : "non-indexed", pcmd->TextureId, pcmd->ClipRect.x, pcmd->ClipRect.y, pcmd->ClipRect.z, pcmd->ClipRect.w);
|
|
if (show_clip_rects && ImGui::IsItemHovered())
|
|
{
|
|
ImRect clip_rect = pcmd->ClipRect;
|
|
ImRect vtxs_rect;
|
|
for (int i = elem_offset; i < elem_offset + (int)pcmd->ElemCount; i++)
|
|
vtxs_rect.Add(draw_list->VtxBuffer[idx_buffer ? idx_buffer[i] : i].pos);
|
|
clip_rect.Floor(); overlay_draw_list->AddRect(clip_rect.Min, clip_rect.Max, IM_COL32(255,255,0,255));
|
|
vtxs_rect.Floor(); overlay_draw_list->AddRect(vtxs_rect.Min, vtxs_rect.Max, IM_COL32(255,0,255,255));
|
|
}
|
|
if (!pcmd_node_open)
|
|
continue;
|
|
ImGuiListClipper clipper(pcmd->ElemCount/3); // Manually coarse clip our print out of individual vertices to save CPU, only items that may be visible.
|
|
while (clipper.Step())
|
|
for (int prim = clipper.DisplayStart, vtx_i = elem_offset + clipper.DisplayStart*3; prim < clipper.DisplayEnd; prim++)
|
|
{
|
|
char buf[300];
|
|
char *buf_p = buf, *buf_end = buf + IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf);
|
|
ImVec2 triangles_pos[3];
|
|
for (int n = 0; n < 3; n++, vtx_i++)
|
|
{
|
|
ImDrawVert& v = draw_list->VtxBuffer[idx_buffer ? idx_buffer[vtx_i] : vtx_i];
|
|
triangles_pos[n] = v.pos;
|
|
buf_p += ImFormatString(buf_p, (int)(buf_end - buf_p), "%s %04d { pos = (%8.2f,%8.2f), uv = (%.6f,%.6f), col = %08X }\n", (n == 0) ? "vtx" : " ", vtx_i, v.pos.x, v.pos.y, v.uv.x, v.uv.y, v.col);
|
|
}
|
|
ImGui::Selectable(buf, false);
|
|
if (ImGui::IsItemHovered())
|
|
overlay_draw_list->AddPolyline(triangles_pos, 3, IM_COL32(255,255,0,255), true, 1.0f, false); // Add triangle without AA, more readable for large-thin triangle
|
|
}
|
|
ImGui::TreePop();
|
|
}
|
|
overlay_draw_list->PopClipRect();
|
|
ImGui::TreePop();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void NodeWindows(ImVector<ImGuiWindow*>& windows, const char* label)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!ImGui::TreeNode(label, "%s (%d)", label, windows.Size))
|
|
return;
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < windows.Size; i++)
|
|
Funcs::NodeWindow(windows[i], "Window");
|
|
ImGui::TreePop();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static void NodeWindow(ImGuiWindow* window, const char* label)
|
|
{
|
|
if (!ImGui::TreeNode(window, "%s '%s', %d @ 0x%p", label, window->Name, window->Active || window->WasActive, window))
|
|
return;
|
|
NodeDrawList(window->DrawList, "DrawList");
|
|
ImGui::BulletText("Pos: (%.1f,%.1f), Size: (%.1f,%.1f), SizeContents (%.1f,%.1f)", window->Pos.x, window->Pos.y, window->Size.x, window->Size.y, window->SizeContents.x, window->SizeContents.y);
|
|
if (ImGui::IsItemHovered())
|
|
GImGui->OverlayDrawList.AddRect(window->Pos, window->Pos + window->Size, IM_COL32(255,255,0,255));
|
|
ImGui::BulletText("Scroll: (%.2f/%.2f,%.2f/%.2f)", window->Scroll.x, GetScrollMaxX(window), window->Scroll.y, GetScrollMaxY(window));
|
|
ImGui::BulletText("Active: %d, WriteAccessed: %d", window->Active, window->WriteAccessed);
|
|
if (window->RootWindow != window) NodeWindow(window->RootWindow, "RootWindow");
|
|
if (window->DC.ChildWindows.Size > 0) NodeWindows(window->DC.ChildWindows, "ChildWindows");
|
|
ImGui::BulletText("Storage: %d bytes", window->StateStorage.Data.Size * (int)sizeof(ImGuiStorage::Pair));
|
|
ImGui::TreePop();
|
|
}
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; // Access private state
|
|
Funcs::NodeWindows(g.Windows, "Windows");
|
|
if (ImGui::TreeNode("DrawList", "Active DrawLists (%d)", g.RenderDrawLists[0].Size))
|
|
{
|
|
for (int layer = 0; layer < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.RenderDrawLists); layer++)
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < g.RenderDrawLists[layer].Size; i++)
|
|
Funcs::NodeDrawList(g.RenderDrawLists[0][i], "DrawList");
|
|
ImGui::TreePop();
|
|
}
|
|
if (ImGui::TreeNode("Popups", "Open Popups Stack (%d)", g.OpenPopupStack.Size))
|
|
{
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < g.OpenPopupStack.Size; i++)
|
|
{
|
|
ImGuiWindow* window = g.OpenPopupStack[i].Window;
|
|
ImGui::BulletText("PopupID: %08x, Window: '%s'%s%s", g.OpenPopupStack[i].PopupId, window ? window->Name : "NULL", window && (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) ? " ChildWindow" : "", window && (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu) ? " ChildMenu" : "");
|
|
}
|
|
ImGui::TreePop();
|
|
}
|
|
if (ImGui::TreeNode("Basic state"))
|
|
{
|
|
ImGui::Text("HoveredWindow: '%s'", g.HoveredWindow ? g.HoveredWindow->Name : "NULL");
|
|
ImGui::Text("HoveredRootWindow: '%s'", g.HoveredRootWindow ? g.HoveredRootWindow->Name : "NULL");
|
|
ImGui::Text("HoveredId: 0x%08X/0x%08X (%.2f sec)", g.HoveredId, g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame, g.HoveredIdTimer); // Data is "in-flight" so depending on when the Metrics window is called we may see current frame information or not
|
|
ImGui::Text("ActiveId: 0x%08X/0x%08X (%.2f sec)", g.ActiveId, g.ActiveIdPreviousFrame, g.ActiveIdTimer);
|
|
ImGui::Text("ActiveIdWindow: '%s'", g.ActiveIdWindow ? g.ActiveIdWindow->Name : "NULL");
|
|
ImGui::Text("NavWindow: '%s'", g.NavWindow ? g.NavWindow->Name : "NULL");
|
|
ImGui::TreePop();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
ImGui::End();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// Include imgui_user.inl at the end of imgui.cpp to access private data/functions that aren't exposed.
|
|
// Prefer just including imgui_internal.h from your code rather than using this define. If a declaration is missing from imgui_internal.h add it or request it on the github.
|
|
#ifdef IMGUI_INCLUDE_IMGUI_USER_INL
|
|
#include "imgui_user.inl"
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|